TLS1.2 and TLS1.1 support with GnuTLS
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
... / ...
CommitLineData
1. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2. This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3. converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4. formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5. The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6.
7. WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8. adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9. unwanted vertical space.
10. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12.include stdflags
13.include stdmacs
14
15. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16. This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19.docbook
20
21. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25. processors.
26. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28.literal xml
29<?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34?>
35.literal off
36
37. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38. This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41.book
42
43. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44. These definitions set some parameters and save some typing. Remember that
45. the <bookinfo> element must also be updated for each new edition.
46. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48.set previousversion "4.75"
49.set version "4.76"
50
51.set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52.set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54
55. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
56. Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
57. provided in the xfpt library.
58. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59
60. --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
61
62.flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
63
64. --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
65. --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
66
67.flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
68.flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
69
70. --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
71. --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
72. --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
73. --- index entry.
74
75.macro option
76.arg 5
77.oindex "&%$5%&"
78.endarg
79.arg -5
80.oindex "&%$1%&"
81.endarg
82.itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
83.row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
84.endtable
85.endmacro
86
87. --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
88. --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
89. --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
90
91.macro table2 196pt 254pt
92.itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
93.endmacro
94
95. --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
96. --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
97. --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
98
99.macro irow
100.arg 4
101.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
102.endarg
103.arg -4
104.arg 3
105.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
106.endarg
107.arg -3
108.row "&I;$1" "$2"
109.endarg
110.endarg
111.endmacro
112
113. --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
114. --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
115. --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
116. --- ID that ties them together.
117
118.macro cindex
119&<indexterm role="concept">&
120&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
121.arg 2
122&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
123.endarg
124&</indexterm>&
125.endmacro
126
127.macro scindex
128&<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
129&<primary>&$2&</primary>&
130.arg 3
131&<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
132.endarg
133&</indexterm>&
134.endmacro
135
136.macro ecindex
137&<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
138.endmacro
139
140.macro oindex
141&<indexterm role="option">&
142&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
143.arg 2
144&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
145.endarg
146&</indexterm>&
147.endmacro
148
149.macro vindex
150&<indexterm role="variable">&
151&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
152.arg 2
153&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
154.endarg
155&</indexterm>&
156.endmacro
157
158.macro index
159.echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
160.endmacro
161. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
162
163
164. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165. The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
166. output formats.
167. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168
169.literal xml
170<bookinfo>
171<title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
172<titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
173<date>06 May 2011</date>
174<author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
175<authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
176<revhistory><revision>
177 <revnumber>4.76</revnumber>
178 <date>06 May 2011</date>
179 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
180</revision></revhistory>
181<copyright><year>2011</year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
182</bookinfo>
183.literal off
184
185
186. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
187. This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
188. "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
189. at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
190. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
191
192.chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
193.literal xml
194
195<indexterm role="variable">
196 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
197 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
198</indexterm>
199<indexterm role="concept">
200 <primary>address</primary>
201 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
202 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
203</indexterm>
204<indexterm role="concept">
205 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
206 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
207</indexterm>
208<indexterm role="concept">
209 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
210 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
211</indexterm>
212<indexterm role="concept">
213 <primary>CR character</primary>
214 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
215</indexterm>
216<indexterm role="concept">
217 <primary>CRL</primary>
218 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
219</indexterm>
220<indexterm role="concept">
221 <primary>delivery</primary>
222 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
223 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
224</indexterm>
225<indexterm role="concept">
226 <primary>dialup</primary>
227 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
228</indexterm>
229<indexterm role="concept">
230 <primary>exiscan</primary>
231 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
232</indexterm>
233<indexterm role="concept">
234 <primary>failover</primary>
235 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
236</indexterm>
237<indexterm role="concept">
238 <primary>fallover</primary>
239 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
240</indexterm>
241<indexterm role="concept">
242 <primary>filter</primary>
243 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
244 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
245</indexterm>
246<indexterm role="concept">
247 <primary>ident</primary>
248 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
249</indexterm>
250<indexterm role="concept">
251 <primary>LF character</primary>
252 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
253</indexterm>
254<indexterm role="concept">
255 <primary>maximum</primary>
256 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
257</indexterm>
258<indexterm role="concept">
259 <primary>monitor</primary>
260 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
261</indexterm>
262<indexterm role="concept">
263 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
264 <see>entry for xxx</see>
265</indexterm>
266<indexterm role="concept">
267 <primary>NUL</primary>
268 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
269</indexterm>
270<indexterm role="concept">
271 <primary>passwd file</primary>
272 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
273</indexterm>
274<indexterm role="concept">
275 <primary>process id</primary>
276 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
277</indexterm>
278<indexterm role="concept">
279 <primary>RBL</primary>
280 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
281</indexterm>
282<indexterm role="concept">
283 <primary>redirection</primary>
284 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
285</indexterm>
286<indexterm role="concept">
287 <primary>return path</primary>
288 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
289</indexterm>
290<indexterm role="concept">
291 <primary>scanning</primary>
292 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
293</indexterm>
294<indexterm role="concept">
295 <primary>SSL</primary>
296 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
297</indexterm>
298<indexterm role="concept">
299 <primary>string</primary>
300 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
301 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
302</indexterm>
303<indexterm role="concept">
304 <primary>top bit</primary>
305 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
306</indexterm>
307<indexterm role="concept">
308 <primary>variables</primary>
309 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
310</indexterm>
311<indexterm role="concept">
312 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
313 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
314</indexterm>
315
316.literal off
317
318
319. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
320. This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
321. we can't have the .chapter line here.
322. chapter "Introduction"
323. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
324
325Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
326Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
327run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
328used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
329
330Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
331BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
332GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
333OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
334Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
335Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
336tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
337
338There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
339that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
340not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
341
342The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
343the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
344Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
345
346The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
347unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
348which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
349of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
350mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
351
352Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
353experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
354contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
355were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
356new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
357
358Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
359development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
360systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
361&_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
362contributors.
363
364
365.section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
366. Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
367
368.new
369.cindex "documentation"
370This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version; of Exim.
371Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
372renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
373capable of showing a change indicator.
374.wen
375
376This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
377is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
378with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
379and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
380it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
381Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
382a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
383very wide interest.
384
385.cindex "books about Exim"
386An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
387introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
388SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
389(&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
390
391This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
392Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
393with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
394published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
395
396.cindex "Debian" "information sources"
397If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
398Debian-specific features in the file
399&_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
400The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
401information.
402
403.cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
404.cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
405.cindex "change log"
406As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
407yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
408digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
409new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
410&_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
411
412Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
413incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
414they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
415can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
416
417All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
418change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
419
420.cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
421This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
422that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
423directory are:
424
425.table2 100pt
426.row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
427.row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
428.row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
429.row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
430.row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
431.row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
432.row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
433.endtable
434
435The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
436available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
437&<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
438
439
440
441.section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
442.cindex "web site"
443.cindex "FTP site"
444The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
445Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
446distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
447&%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
448&%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
449Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
450
451.cindex "wiki"
452.cindex "FAQ"
453As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
454differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
455online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
456which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
457examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
458
459.cindex Bugzilla
460An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
461this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
462first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
463
464
465
466.section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
467.cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
468The following Exim mailing lists exist:
469
470.table2 140pt
471.row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
472.row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
473.row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
474.row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
475.endtable
476
477You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
478or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
479.cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
480If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
481the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
482via this web page:
483.display
484&url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
485.endd
486Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
487lists.
488
489.section "Exim training" "SECID4"
490.cindex "training courses"
491Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
492Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
493further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
494information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
495
496.section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
497.cindex "bug reports"
498.cindex "reporting bugs"
499Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
500via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
501whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
502message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
503
504
505
506.section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
507.cindex "FTP site"
508.cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
509The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
510.display
511&*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
512.endd
513This is mirrored by
514.display
515&*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
516.endd
517The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
518these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
519the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
520
521Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
522previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
523distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
524subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
525.display
526&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
527&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
528.endd
529where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
530files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
531The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
532
533.cindex "distribution" "signing details"
534.cindex "distribution" "public key"
535.cindex "public key for signed distribution"
536The distributions are currently signed with Nigel Metheringham's GPG key. The
537corresponding public key is available from a number of keyservers, and there is
538also a copy in the file &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. The signatures for the tar bundles are
539in:
540.display
541&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
542&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
543.endd
544For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
545separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
546find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
547
548.cindex "documentation" "available formats"
549The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
550documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
551inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
552.display
553&_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
554&_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
555&_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
556&_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
557.endd
558These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
559distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
560
561
562.section "Limitations" "SECID6"
563.ilist
564.cindex "limitations of Exim"
565.cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
566Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
567RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
568simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
569configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
570UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
571.next
572.cindex "domainless addresses"
573.cindex "address" "without domain"
574Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
575local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
576configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
577systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
578arrival.
579.next
580.cindex "transport" "external"
581.cindex "external transports"
582The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
583and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
584transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
585and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
586to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
587handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
588.next
589Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
590such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
591(that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
592other means.
593.next
594Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
595are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
596are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
597compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
598a number of common scanners are provided.
599.endlist
600
601
602.section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
603Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
604into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
605values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
606file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
607distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
608
609
610.section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
611.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
612Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
613can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
614&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
615about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
616Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
617example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
618format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
6193, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
620documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
621made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
622
623Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
624line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
625which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
626interface to Exim's command line administration options.
627
628
629
630.section "Terminology" "SECID9"
631.cindex "terminology definitions"
632.cindex "body of message" "definition of"
633The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
634It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
635below) by a blank line.
636
637.cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
638When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
639delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
640&'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
641called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
642failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
643message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
644rise to further bounce messages.
645
646The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
647value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
648also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
649otherwise.
650
651The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
652destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
653down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
654until a later time.
655
656The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
657host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
658the part of an email address following the @ sign.
659
660.cindex "envelope, definition of"
661.cindex "sender" "definition of"
662A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
663body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
664be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
665sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
666envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
667messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
668
669.cindex "message" "header, definition of"
670.cindex "header section" "definition of"
671The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
672of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
673&'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
674indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
675line.
676
677.cindex "local part" "definition of"
678.cindex "domain" "definition of"
679The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
680part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
681@ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
682
683.cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
684.cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
685The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
686delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
687TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
688host it is running on are &'remote'&.
689
690.cindex "return path" "definition of"
691&'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
692message's envelope.
693
694.cindex "queue" "definition of"
695The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
696because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
697Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
698normally no ordering of waiting messages.
699
700.cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
701The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
702and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
703is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
704the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
705
706.cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
707The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
708messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
709delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
710mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
711the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
712
713
714
715
716
717
718. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
719. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
720
721.chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
722.cindex "incorporated code"
723.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
724.cindex "PCRE"
725A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
726
727.ilist
728Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
729Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
730&copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
731Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
732or obtain and install the full version of the library from
733&url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
734.next
735.cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
736Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
737contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
738Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
739It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
740following statements:
741
742.blockquote
743Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
744
745This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
746the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
747Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
748version.
749This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
750the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
751&url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
752some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
753restrictions applied to it).
754.endblockquote
755.next
756.cindex "SPA authentication"
757.cindex "Samba project"
758.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
759Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
760by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
761Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
762under the Gnu GPL.
763.next
764.cindex "Cyrus"
765.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
766.cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
767Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
768by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
769Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
770conditions expressed therein.
771
772.blockquote
773Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
774
775Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
776modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
777are met:
778
779.olist
780Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
781notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
782.next
783Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
784notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
785the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
786distribution.
787.next
788The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
789endorse or promote products derived from this software without
790prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
791details, please contact
792.display
793 Office of Technology Transfer
794 Carnegie Mellon University
795 5000 Forbes Avenue
796 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
797 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
798 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
799.endd
800.next
801Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
802acknowledgment:
803
804&"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
805at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
806
807CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
808THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
809AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
810FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
811WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
812AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
813OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
814.endlist
815.endblockquote
816
817.next
818.cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
819.cindex "X-windows"
820.cindex "Athena"
821The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
822modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
823This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
824below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
825
826.blockquote
827Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
828and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
829
830All Rights Reserved
831
832Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
833documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
834provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
835both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
836supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
837used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
838software without specific, written prior permission.
839
840DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
841ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
842DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
843ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
844WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
845ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
846SOFTWARE.
847.endblockquote
848
849.next
850Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
851not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
852contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
853.endlist
854
855
856
857
858
859. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
860. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
861
862.chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
863 "Receiving and delivering mail"
864
865
866.section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
867.cindex "design philosophy"
868Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
869to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
870most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
871maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
872it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
873has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
874
875
876.section "Policy control" "SECID11"
877.cindex "policy control" "overview"
878Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
879Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
880&"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
881unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
882facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
883
884.ilist
885.cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
886Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
887incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
888series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
889several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
890host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
891very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
892rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
893two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
894error code.
895.next
896An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
897case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
898.next
899When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
900provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
901spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
902which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
903.next
904When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
905host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
906function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
907whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
908is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
909.next
910Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
911software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
912Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
913.next
914After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
915the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
916runs at the start of every delivery process.
917.endlist
918
919
920
921.section "User filters" "SECID12"
922.cindex "filter" "introduction"
923.cindex "Sieve filter"
924In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
925setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
926chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
927configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
928&'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
929of filtering are available:
930
931.ilist
932Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
933by RFC 3028.
934.next
935Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
936powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
937.endlist
938
939User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
940
941
942
943.section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
944.cindex "message ids" "details of format"
945.cindex "format" "of message id"
946.cindex "id of message"
947.cindex "base62"
948.cindex "base36"
949.cindex "Darwin"
950.cindex "Cygwin"
951Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
952characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
953example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
954normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
955system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
956(avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
957id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
958not always case-sensitive.
959
960.cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
961The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
962Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
963within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
964be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
965the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
966somewhat eccentric:
967
968.ilist
969The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
970started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
971contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
972way of representing the date and time of day).
973.next
974After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
975received the message.
976.next
977There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
978.olist
979.oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
980If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
981time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
982that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
983systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
984.next
985If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
986the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
987(1/100) of a second.
988.endlist
989.endlist
990
991After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
992appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
993received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
994pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
995will already have ticked while the message was being received.
996
997
998.section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
999.cindex "receiving mail"
1000.cindex "message" "reception"
1001The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1002TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1003SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1004there are several possibilities:
1005
1006.ilist
1007If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1008non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1009command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1010.next
1011If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1012non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1013the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1014command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1015but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1016envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1017.next
1018If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1019interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1020passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1021This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1022example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1023.next
1024A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1025(127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1026does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1027in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1028.endlist
1029
1030
1031.cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1032.cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1033In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1034constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1035qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1036option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1037SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1038certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1039unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1040address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1041different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1042users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1043users to change sender addresses.
1044
1045Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1046checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1047(either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1048number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1049individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1050requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1051&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1052
1053Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1054received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1055connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1056queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1057configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1058message is received.
1059
1060
1061
1062
1063
1064.section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1065.cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1066.cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1067When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1068first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1069the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1070the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1071file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1072
1073.cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1074By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1075&_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1076not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1077improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1078used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1079whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1080processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1081overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1082affect file system performance.
1083
1084The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1085the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1086any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1087a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1088first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1089
1090.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1091Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1092(see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1093both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1094If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1095example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1096generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1097rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1098different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1099addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1100delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1101&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1102
1103
1104
1105.section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1106.cindex "message" "life of"
1107.cindex "message" "frozen"
1108A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1109its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1110administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1111cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1112recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1113spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1114
1115.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1116.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1117An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1118corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1119addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1120to be sent.
1121
1122.oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1123.oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1124There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1125&%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1126The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1127
1128.cindex "message" "log file for"
1129.cindex "log" "file for each message"
1130While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1131attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1132delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1133lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1134These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1135deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1136The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1137&%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1138systems.
1139
1140.cindex "journal file"
1141.cindex "file" "journal"
1142All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1143spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1144address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1145message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1146addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1147is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1148Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1149minimize the possibility of data loss.
1150
1151Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1152the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1153time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1154updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1155deliveries caused by crashes.
1156
1157
1158
1159.section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1160.cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1161.cindex "router" "definition of"
1162.cindex "transport" "definition of"
1163The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1164&'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1165number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1166specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1167ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1168
1169.cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1170Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1171of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1172you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1173option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1174instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1175instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1176configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1177the driver's features in general.
1178
1179A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1180its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1181converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1182alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1183to be bounced.
1184
1185A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1186spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1187transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1188&'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1189to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1190several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1191
1192.cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1193An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1194turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1195specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1196detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1197address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1198
1199To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1200routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1201routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1202configuration.
1203
1204The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1205addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1206are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1207is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1208its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1209match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1210find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1211assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1212configured to fail the address.
1213
1214The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1215&"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1216aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1217original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1218router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1219address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1220
1221The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1222address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1223see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1224local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1225the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1226the address is bounced.
1227
1228
1229
1230.section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1231.cindex "router" "for verification"
1232.cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1233As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1234are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1235one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1236sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1237&%-bvs%& command line options.
1238
1239When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1240does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1241detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1242when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1243sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1244previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1245checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1246would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1247
1248
1249
1250
1251.section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1252.cindex "router" "running details"
1253.cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1254.cindex "router" "result of running"
1255As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1256running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1257passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1258the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1259the following:
1260
1261.ilist
1262&'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1263transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1264original address ceases,
1265.oindex "&%unseen%&"
1266unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1267can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1268for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1269passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1270end of routing.
1271
1272Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1273starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1274setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1275child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1276&%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1277.next
1278&'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1279requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1280is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1281&%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1282must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1283.next
1284&'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1285recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1286this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1287set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1288&'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1289.next
1290&'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1291the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1292original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1293.next
1294&'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1295database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1296processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1297next time the message is considered for delivery.
1298.next
1299&'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1300its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1301.endlist
1302
1303If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1304any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1305situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1306making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1307router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1308
1309Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1310met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1311You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1312when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1313facility for this purpose.
1314
1315
1316.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1317.cindex "case of local parts"
1318.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1319.cindex "duplicate addresses"
1320Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1321and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1322check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1323actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1324routed addresses are shown.
1325
1326
1327
1328.section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1329.cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1330.cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1331The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1332order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1333described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1334
1335.ilist
1336The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1337the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1338suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1339skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1340removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1341of any other conditions.
1342.next
1343Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1344only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1345&%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1346address.
1347Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1348&%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1349sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1350you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1351.next
1352If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1353run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1354when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1355makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1356having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1357.next
1358Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1359opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1360.next
1361Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1362check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1363.next
1364If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1365of domains that it defines.
1366.next
1367.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1368.vindex "&$local_part$&"
1369.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1370If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1371the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1372&%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1373part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1374that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1375that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1376&$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1377.next
1378.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1379.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1380.vindex "&$home$&"
1381If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1382an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1383local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1384user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1385remaining preconditions.
1386.next
1387If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1388because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1389later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1390subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1391could lead to confusion.
1392.next
1393If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1394set of addresses that it defines.
1395.next
1396If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1397specified files is tested.
1398.next
1399.cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1400If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1401uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1402Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1403.endlist
1404
1405
1406Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1407it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1408part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1409&%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1410&%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1411going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1412example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1413
1414
1415
1416.section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1417.cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1418When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1419
1420.ilist
1421If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1422filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1423message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1424fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1425files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1426filtering'&.
1427.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1428(&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1429
1430Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1431&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1432filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1433if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1434be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1435condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1436filter.
1437.next
1438Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1439its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1440address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1441can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1442processed entirely independently of each other.
1443.next
1444.cindex "routing" "loops in"
1445.cindex "loop" "while routing"
1446A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1447transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1448is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1449Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1450from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1451process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1452which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1453.next
1454When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1455handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1456doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1457local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1458collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1459addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1460address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1461addresses to the same domain.
1462.next
1463Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1464non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1465deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1466to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1467run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1468one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1469The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1470deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1471.next
1472.cindex "queue runner"
1473When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1474database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1475address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1476Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1477reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1478queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1479follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1480better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1481causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1482.next
1483.cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1484Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1485deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1486retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1487reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1488not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1489.next
1490If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1491appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1492for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1493messages to other addresses.
1494.next
1495.cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1496If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1497the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1498&'deferred'&.
1499.next
1500When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1501handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1502deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1503.endlist
1504
1505
1506
1507
1508.section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1509.cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1510.cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1511.cindex "queue runner"
1512Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1513attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1514uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1515intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1516not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1517first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1518its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1519passed its retry time.
1520You can run several queue runners at once.
1521
1522Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1523address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1524should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1525bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1526error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1527as permanent.
1528
1529
1530
1531.section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1532.cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1533There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1534particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1535connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1536detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1537Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1538is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1539impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1540also apply.
1541
1542If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1543waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1544connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1545deferred,
1546.cindex "hints database"
1547Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1548SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1549for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1550connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1551one connection.
1552
1553
1554
1555.section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1556.cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1557.cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1558When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1559bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1560errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1561delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1562many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1563attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1564message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1565See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1566
1567.cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1568Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1569failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1570automatically.
1571
1572.cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1573A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1574obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1575address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1576forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1577failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1578&<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1579of the list.
1580
1581
1582
1583.section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1584.cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1585If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1586itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1587but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1588that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1589for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1590&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1591
1592
1593
1594
1595
1596. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1597. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1598
1599.chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1600.scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1601
1602.section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1603Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1604creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1605&_exim-&version;_&) into which the following files are placed:
1606
1607.table2 140pt
1608.irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1609.irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1610 documented"
1611.irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1612.irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1613.irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1614.irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1615 instructions"
1616.endtable
1617
1618Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1619following subdirectories are created:
1620
1621.table2 140pt
1622.irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1623.irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1624.irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1625.irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1626.irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1627.irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1628.irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1629.endtable
1630
1631The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1632with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1633that may be useful to some sites.
1634
1635
1636.section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1637.cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1638The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1639a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1640source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1641Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1642system.
1643.cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1644Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1645the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1646architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1647overridden if necessary.
1648
1649
1650.section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1651.cindex "PCRE library"
1652Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1653modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1654to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1655system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1656process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1657headers are in an unusual location you will need to set the PCRE_LIBS
1658and INCLUDE directives appropriately. If your operating system has no
1659PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1660from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1661
1662.section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1663.cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1664.cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1665Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1666DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1667databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1668different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1669
1670.cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1671.cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1672.cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1673.cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1674If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1675Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1676may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1677you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1678
1679.cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1680Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1681via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1682versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1683some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1684distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1685versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1686Berkeley DB library.
1687
1688Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1689use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1690possibilities:
1691
1692.olist
1693A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1694Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1695.next
1696.cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1697The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1698compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1699&_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1700file name is used unmodified.
1701.next
1702.cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1703The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1704operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1705programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1706.next
1707If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1708file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1709the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1710.next
1711To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1712Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
17132.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1714numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1715versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1716&url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1717.next
1718.cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1719Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1720&url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1721operates on a single file.
1722.endlist
1723
1724.cindex "USE_DB"
1725.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1726Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1727to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1728USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1729&_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1730.code
1731USE_DB=yes
1732.endd
1733Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1734error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1735
1736At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1737thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1738configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1739Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1740configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1741&_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1742
1743As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1744necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1745in one of these lines:
1746.code
1747DBMLIB = -ldb
1748DBMLIB = -ltdb
1749.endd
1750Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1751place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1752the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1753file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1754this example:
1755.code
1756INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1757DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1758.endd
1759There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1760file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1761
1762
1763
1764.section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1765.cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1766.cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1767.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1768.cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1769Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1770independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1771&_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1772&_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1773therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1774building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1775&_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1776
1777There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1778without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1779(CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1780(BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1781maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1782a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1783
1784There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1785at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1786machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1787directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1788you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1789detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1790be logged.
1791
1792.cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1793Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1794access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1795facilities, you need to set
1796.code
1797WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1798.endd
1799in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1800chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1801
1802
1803.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1804.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1805If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1806required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1807your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1808happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1809&_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1810
1811This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1812operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1813to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1814configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1815defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1816do this.
1817
1818
1819
1820.section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1821.cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1822.cindex "RFC 2047"
1823The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1824described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1825in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1826character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1827mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1828(default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1829supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1830
1831However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1832very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1833&url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1834systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1835&[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1836.code
1837HAVE_ICONV=yes
1838.endd
1839to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1840
1841
1842
1843.section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1844.cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1845.cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1846.cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1847.cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1848.cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1849Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1850command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1851start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1852&%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1853line option).
1854
1855If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1856OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1857implementing SSL.
1858
1859If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1860.code
1861SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1862TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1863.endd
1864in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1865OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1866.code
1867SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1868TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1869TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1870.endd
1871.cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1872If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1873.code
1874SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1875USE_GNUTLS=yes
1876TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1877.endd
1878in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1879library and include files. For example:
1880.code
1881SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1882USE_GNUTLS=yes
1883TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1884TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1885.endd
1886You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1887specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1888given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1889
1890
1891
1892
1893.section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1894
1895.cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1896.cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1897.cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1898.cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1899Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1900SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1901alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1902already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1903should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1904&_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1905&_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1906EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1907you might have
1908.code
1909USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1910CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1911EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1912.endd
1913in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1914files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1915.code
1916exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1917.endd
1918in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1919the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1920All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1921can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1922in &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1923configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1924further details.
1925
1926
1927.section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1928.cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1929Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1930&`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1931it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1932where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1933library files.
1934
1935Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1936defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1937currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1938as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1939over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. It is not known
1940if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
1941this is included only if you set &`SUPPORT_A6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
1942support has not been tested for some time.
1943
1944
1945
1946.section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1947.cindex "lookup modules"
1948.cindex "dynamic modules"
1949.cindex ".so building"
1950On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
1951the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
1952on demand.
1953This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
1954library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
1955dependencies.
1956Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
1957
1958Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
1959installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
1960measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
1961for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
1962Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
1963see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
1964
1965Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
1966&`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
1967For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
1968on demand:
1969.code
1970LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
1971LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
1972LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
1973.endd
1974
1975
1976.section "The building process" "SECID29"
1977.cindex "build directory"
1978Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
1979created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
1980operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
1981For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
1982&_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
1983.cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
1984Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
1985
1986&*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
1987building process fails if it is set.
1988
1989If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
1990a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
1991&_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
1992&'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
1993then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
1994number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
1995makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
1996directory, should this ever be necessary.
1997
1998If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
1999&_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2000FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2001
2002
2003
2004.section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2005The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2006unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2007output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2008appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2009each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2010get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2011.code
2012FULLECHO='' make -e
2013.endd
2014The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2015command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2016given in addition to the short output.
2017
2018
2019
2020.section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2021.cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2022The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2023consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2024values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2025more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2026convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2027order:
2028.display
2029&_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2030&_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2031&_Local/Makefile_&
2032&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2033&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2034&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2035&_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2036.endd
2037.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2038.cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2039.cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2040where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2041architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2042process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2043and are often not needed.
2044
2045The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2046called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2047the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2048values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2049Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2050fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2051of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2052that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2053to find out what values are being used on your system.
2054
2055
2056&_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2057therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2058needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2059file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2060default values are.
2061
2062
2063.cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2064If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2065or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2066need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2067putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2068.cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2069when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2070formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2071compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2072called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2073Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2074default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2075containing the lines
2076.code
2077CC=cc
2078CFLAGS=-std1
2079.endd
2080If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2081these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2082
2083Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2084files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2085the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2086
2087
2088.cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2089.cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2090.cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2091.cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2092Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2093lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2094not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2095and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2096which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2097case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2098.code
2099LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2100LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2101LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2102.endd
2103and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2104&_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2105libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2106.cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2107However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2108the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2109files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2110binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2111errors.
2112
2113.cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2114Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2115subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2116.code
2117EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2118.endd
2119must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2120chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2121
2122.cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2123The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2124operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2125with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2126monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2127The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2128.code
2129X11=/usr/X11R6
2130XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2131XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2132.endd
2133These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2134example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2135.code
2136X11=/usr/openwin
2137XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2138XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2139.endd
2140If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2141definition of all three of these variables into your
2142&_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2143
2144.cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2145If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2146variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2147default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2148command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2149
2150.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2151There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2152use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2153EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2154binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2155libraries.
2156
2157.cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2158The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2159files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2160necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2161&_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2162
2163
2164.section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2165.cindex "&_os.h_&"
2166.cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2167The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2168&_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2169normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2170recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2171are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2172
2173
2174
2175.section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2176.cindex "building Eximon"
2177A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2178where the files that are involved are
2179.display
2180&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2181&_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2182&_Local/eximon.conf_&
2183&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2184&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2185&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2186.endd
2187.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2188As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2189&_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2190&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2191variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2192EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2193LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2194.ecindex IIDbuex
2195
2196
2197.section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2198.cindex "installing Exim"
2199.cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2200The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2201arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2202whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2203.cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2204The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2205going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2206&'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2207install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2208some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2209it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2210chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2211
2212.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2213Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2214in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2215exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2216by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2217is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2218alternative files, no default is installed.
2219
2220.cindex "system aliases file"
2221.cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2222One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2223default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2224The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2225SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2226If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2227and outputs a comment to the user.
2228
2229The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2230aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2231kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2232&_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2233Exim's configuration if necessary.
2234
2235The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2236and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2237running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2238directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2239other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2240over SMTP.
2241
2242It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2243distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2244command such as
2245.code
2246make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2247.endd
2248This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2249paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2250configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2251For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2252but this usage is deprecated.
2253
2254.cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2255Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2256&'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2257upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2258directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2259INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2260
2261For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2262to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2263installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2264for example &_exim-&version;-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2265called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2266of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2267from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2268
2269.cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2270If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2271real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2272command:
2273.code
2274make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2275.endd
2276The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2277script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2278the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2279directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2280command:
2281.code
2282(cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2283.endd
2284.cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2285There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2286
2287.ilist
2288&%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2289to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2290.next
2291&%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2292installed binary.
2293.endlist
2294
2295INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2296.code
2297make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2298.endd
2299The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2300to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2301without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2302.code
2303make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2304.endd
2305
2306
2307
2308.section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2309.cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2310Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2311reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2312distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2313&<<SECTavail>>&).
2314
2315If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2316source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2317install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2318
2319
2320
2321.section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2322.cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2323When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2324exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2325directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2326necessary.
2327
2328
2329
2330
2331.section "Testing" "SECID34"
2332.cindex "testing" "installation"
2333Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2334syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2335Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2336.code
2337exim -bV
2338.endd
2339If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2340Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2341the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2342other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2343Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2344example,
2345.display
2346&`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2347.endd
2348should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2349.display
2350&`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2351.endd
2352a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2353This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2354user agent. For example:
2355.code
2356exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2357From: user@your.domain.example
2358To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2359Subject: Testing Exim
2360
2361This is a test message.
2362^D
2363.endd
2364The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2365In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2366arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2367
2368.cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2369If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2370&'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2371of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2372&%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2373with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2374.display
2375&`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2376.endd
2377You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2378produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2379For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2380relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2381&<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2382
2383.cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2384.cindex "lock files"
2385One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2386local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2387&"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2388writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2389is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2390directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2391that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2392&(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2393approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2394&[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2395agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2396see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2397
2398One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2399the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2400&%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2401port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2402&'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2403incoming SMTP mail.
2404
2405Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2406be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2407within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2408that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2409production version.
2410
2411
2412.section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2413.cindex "replacing another MTA"
2414Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2415general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2416is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2417operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2418binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2419normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2420or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2421.cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2422a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2423privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2424and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2425
2426.cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2427.cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2428Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2429example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2430&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2431described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2432as follows:
2433.code
2434sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2435send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2436mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2437newaliases /usr/bin/true
2438.endd
2439Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2440your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2441favourite user agent.
2442
2443You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2444have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2445various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2446command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2447use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2448&'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2449
2450
2451
2452.section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2453.cindex "upgrading Exim"
2454If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2455version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2456call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2457to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2458new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2459version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2460configuration file.
2461
2462
2463
2464
2465.section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2466.cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2467The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2468.code
2469/etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2470.endd
2471If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2472fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2473for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2474(that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2475solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2476.code
2477pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2478.endd
2479to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2480
2481Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2482still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2483(the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2484
2485
2486
2487
2488. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2489. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2490
2491.chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2492.scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2493.scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2494Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2495each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2496options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2497some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2498combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2499The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2500
2501
2502.section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2503.cindex "&'mailq'&"
2504If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2505were present before any other options.
2506The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2507standard output.
2508This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2509that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2510&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2511
2512.cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2513If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2514were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2515&%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2516format.
2517
2518.cindex "&'rmail'&"
2519If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2520&%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2521Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2522
2523.cindex "&'runq'&"
2524.cindex "queue runner"
2525If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2526were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2527option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2528
2529.cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2530.cindex "alias file" "building"
2531.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2532If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2533&%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2534This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2535the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2536command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2537
2538
2539.section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2540Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2541available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2542user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2543EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2544&%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2545
2546.ilist
2547.cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2548.cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2549The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2550&%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2551supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2552configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2553
2554.cindex '&"From"& line'
2555.cindex "envelope sender"
2556Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2557&"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2558Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2559See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2560users to set envelope senders.
2561
2562.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2563.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2564For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2565header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2566&'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2567
2568Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2569protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2570locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2571have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2572users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2573that are available to trusted users.
2574.next
2575.cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2576.cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2577The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2578Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2579The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2580
2581Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2582operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2583necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2584the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2585
2586By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2587Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2588However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2589option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2590
2591Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2592is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2593false.
2594.endlist
2595
2596
2597&*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2598edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2599getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2600&<<CHAPconf>>&.
2601
2602
2603
2604
2605.section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2606Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2607of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2608a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2609format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2610on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2611with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2612outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2613
2614. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2615. Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2616. options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2617. creates a man page for the options.
2618. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2619
2620.literal xml
2621<!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2622.literal off
2623
2624
2625.vlist
2626.vitem &%--%&
2627.oindex "--"
2628.cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2629This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2630therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2631rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2632
2633.vitem &%--help%&
2634.oindex "&%--help%&"
2635This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2636The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2637no arguments.
2638
2639.vitem &%--version%&
2640.oindex "&%--version%&"
2641This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2642displayed.
2643
2644.vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2645.oindex "&%-B%&"
2646.cindex "8-bit characters"
2647.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2648This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2649clean; it ignores this option.
2650
2651.vitem &%-bd%&
2652.oindex "&%-bd%&"
2653.cindex "daemon"
2654.cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2655.cindex "queue runner"
2656This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2657the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2658that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2659
2660The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2661(debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2662disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2663stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2664
2665By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2666all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2667ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2668&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2669
2670When a listening daemon
2671.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2672.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2673is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2674configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2675in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2676PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2677running as root.
2678
2679When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2680process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2681used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2682
2683The SIGHUP signal
2684.cindex "SIGHUP"
2685.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2686can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2687whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2688means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2689of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2690referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2691because these are reread each time they are used.
2692
2693.vitem &%-bdf%&
2694.oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2695This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2696from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2697
2698.vitem &%-be%&
2699.oindex "&%-be%&"
2700.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2701.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2702Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2703prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2704files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2705of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2706
2707If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2708to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2709used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2710function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2711test data. A line history is supported.
2712
2713Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2714continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2715continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2716string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2717configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2718message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2719is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2720
2721&*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2722files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2723the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2724of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2725
2726.vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2727.oindex "&%-bem%&"
2728.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2729.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2730This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2731of a file. For example:
2732.code
2733exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2734.endd
2735The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2736message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2737variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2738no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2739recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2740&$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2741line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2742&%-be%&).
2743
2744.vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2745.oindex "&%-bF%&"
2746.cindex "system filter" "testing"
2747.cindex "testing" "system filter"
2748This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2749tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2750system filters are recognized.
2751
2752.vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2753.oindex "&%-bf%&"
2754.cindex "filter" "testing"
2755.cindex "testing" "filter file"
2756.cindex "forward file" "testing"
2757.cindex "testing" "forward file"
2758.cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2759This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2760to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2761there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2762supplied.
2763
2764If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2765can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2766filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2767.code
2768exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2769.endd
2770This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2771variables that are used by the user filter.
2772
2773If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2774.code
2775# Exim filter
2776# Sieve filter
2777.endd
2778it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2779that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2780&<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2781redirection lists.
2782
2783The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2784detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2785with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2786separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2787
2788When testing a filter file,
2789.cindex "&""From""& line"
2790.cindex "envelope sender"
2791.oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2792the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2793or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2794that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2795can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2796options).
2797
2798.vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2799.oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2800.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2801This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2802tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2803&$qualify_domain$&.
2804
2805.vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2806.oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2807This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2808tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2809process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2810suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2811actually being delivered.
2812
2813.vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2814.oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2815This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2816file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2817prefix.
2818
2819.vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2820.oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2821This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2822file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2823suffix.
2824
2825.vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2826.oindex "&%-bh%&"
2827.cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2828.cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2829.cindex "testing" "relay control"
2830.cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2831.cindex "policy control" "testing"
2832.cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2833This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2834standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2835after a full stop. For example:
2836.code
2837exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2838exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2839.endd
2840When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2841of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2842conversion to the canonical form is
2843&`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2844
2845Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2846include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2847This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2848messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2849test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2850
2851&*Warning 1*&:
2852.cindex "RFC 1413"
2853You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2854information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2855an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2856connection.
2857
2858&*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2859are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2860occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2861
2862Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2863written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2864lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2865can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2866and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2867session were authenticated.
2868
2869The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2870output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2871acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2872
2873Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2874plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2875specialized SMTP test program such as
2876&url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2877
2878.vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2879.oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2880This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2881verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2882updating the callout cache database.
2883
2884.vitem &%-bi%&
2885.oindex "&%-bi%&"
2886.cindex "alias file" "building"
2887.cindex "building alias file"
2888.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2889Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2890Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2891this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2892tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2893recognized.
2894
2895If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2896configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2897the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2898The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2899use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2900if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2901&%-bi%& is a no-op.
2902
2903.vitem &%-bm%&
2904.oindex "&%-bm%&"
2905.cindex "local message reception"
2906This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
2907locally-generated message on the current input. The recipients are given as the
2908command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
2909argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
2910default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
2911if no other conflicting option is present.
2912
2913If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
2914qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
2915options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
2916suppressing this for special cases.
2917
2918Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
2919the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
2920
2921.cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
2922The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
2923action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
2924
2925The format
2926.cindex "message" "format"
2927.cindex "format" "message"
2928.cindex "&""From""& line"
2929.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
2930.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
2931of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
2932compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
2933.code
2934From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
2935From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
2936.endd
2937(with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
2938is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
2939authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
2940matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
2941option, which can be changed if necessary.
2942
2943.oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
2944The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
2945&%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
2946preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
2947trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
2948
2949.vitem &%-bnq%&
2950.oindex "&%-bnq%&"
2951.cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
2952By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
2953without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
2954is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
2955envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
2956&%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
2957defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
2958
2959Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
2960being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
2961content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
2962header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
2963syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
2964
2965The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
2966messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
2967addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
2968unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
2969
2970
2971.vitem &%-bP%&
2972.oindex "&%-bP%&"
2973.cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
2974.cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
2975If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
2976main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
2977of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
2978arguments, for example:
2979.code
2980exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
2981.endd
2982.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
2983.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
2984.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
2985However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
2986configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
2987users, the output is as in this example:
2988.code
2989mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
2990.endd
2991If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
2992configuration file is output.
2993If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
2994is the name of the file that was actually used.
2995
2996.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2997.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2998If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
2999directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3000respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3001sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3002written directly into the spool directory.
3003
3004If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3005.code
3006exim -bP +local_domains
3007.endd
3008it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3009local part) and outputs what it finds.
3010
3011.cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3012.cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3013.cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3014If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3015followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3016that driver are output. For example:
3017.code
3018exim -bP transport local_delivery
3019.endd
3020The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3021options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3022using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3023&%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3024settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3025&%authenticators%&.
3026
3027.cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3028If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3029are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3030for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3031The output format is one item per line.
3032
3033.vitem &%-bp%&
3034.oindex "&%-bp%&"
3035.cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3036.cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3037This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3038standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3039just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3040admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3041to allow any user to see the queue.
3042
3043Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3044.code
304525m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3046 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3047 <other addresses>
3048.endd
3049.cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3050.cindex "size" "of message"
3051The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3052(in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3053identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3054envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3055&"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3056the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3057before the sender address.
3058
3059.cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3060If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3061&"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3062
3063The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3064displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3065been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3066expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3067displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3068complete.
3069
3070
3071.vitem &%-bpa%&
3072.oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3073This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3074that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3075alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3076of just &"D"&.
3077
3078
3079.vitem &%-bpc%&
3080.oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3081.cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3082This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3083to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3084&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3085
3086
3087.vitem &%-bpr%&
3088.oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3089This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3090chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3091lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3092going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3093
3094.vitem &%-bpra%&
3095.oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3096This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3097
3098.vitem &%-bpru%&
3099.oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3100This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3101
3102
3103.vitem &%-bpu%&
3104.oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3105This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3106addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3107forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3108router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3109
3110
3111.vitem &%-brt%&
3112.oindex "&%-brt%&"
3113.cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3114.cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3115This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3116arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3117and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3118.code
3119exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3120Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3121.endd
3122See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3123argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3124&'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3125contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3126retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3127with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3128rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3129sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3130used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3131.code
3132exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3133Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3134.endd
3135
3136.vitem &%-brw%&
3137.oindex "&%-brw%&"
3138.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3139.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3140This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3141a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3142complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3143would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3144&<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3145
3146.vitem &%-bS%&
3147.oindex "&%-bS%&"
3148.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3149.cindex "batched SMTP input"
3150This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3151for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3152submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3153input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3154input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3155&%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3156believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3157
3158The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3159dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3160provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3161
3162As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3163messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3164Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3165&%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3166
3167Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3168as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3169QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3170
3171.cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3172If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3173error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3174was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3175was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3176
3177More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3178&<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3179
3180.vitem &%-bs%&
3181.oindex "&%-bs%&"
3182.cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3183.cindex "local SMTP input"
3184This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3185on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3186policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3187Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3188messages to the MTA.
3189
3190In
3191.cindex "sender" "source of"
3192this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3193set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3194Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3195the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3196&%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3197&%-bnq%& option is used.
3198
3199.cindex "inetd"
3200The
3201&%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3202using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3203whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3204&'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3205above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3206Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3207the listening daemon.
3208
3209.vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3210.oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3211.cindex "testing", "malware"
3212.cindex "malware scan test"
3213This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3214using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3215this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3216the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3217not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3218will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3219
3220Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3221using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3222user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3223This option requires admin privileges.
3224
3225The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3226there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3227administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3228
3229.vitem &%-bt%&
3230.oindex "&%-bt%&"
3231.cindex "testing" "addresses"
3232.cindex "address" "testing"
3233This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3234as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3235written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3236user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3237sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3238
3239If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3240right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3241
3242Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3243&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3244security issues.
3245
3246Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3247(compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3248written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3249&%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3250genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3251program.
3252
3253.cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3254The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3255failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3256code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3257
3258.cindex "duplicate addresses"
3259&*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3260addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3261This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3262always shown.
3263
3264&*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3265routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3266message,
3267.oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3268you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3269&%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3270default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3271whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3272those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3273doing such tests.
3274
3275.vitem &%-bV%&
3276.oindex "&%-bV%&"
3277.cindex "version number of Exim"
3278This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3279number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3280It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3281specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3282name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3283
3284As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3285configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3286values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3287detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3288alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3289realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3290dynamic testing facilities.
3291
3292.vitem &%-bv%&
3293.oindex "&%-bv%&"
3294.cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3295.cindex "address" "verification"
3296This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3297taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3298not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3299happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3300(see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3301including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3302
3303If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3304failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3305usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3306
3307If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3308right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3309
3310Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3311&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3312security issues.
3313
3314Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3315that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3316router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3317verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3318address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3319
3320If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3321address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3322latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3323causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3324addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3325and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3326to succeed.
3327
3328When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3329and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3330considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3331
3332The
3333.cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3334return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3335failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3336code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3337
3338If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3339address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3340sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3341calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3342
3343.vitem &%-bvs%&
3344.oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3345This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3346than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3347might happen.
3348
3349.vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3350.oindex "&%-C%&"
3351.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3352.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3353.cindex "alternate configuration file"
3354This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3355list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3356compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3357name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3358file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3359proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3360
3361When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3362from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3363runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3364However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3365file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3366which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3367listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3368CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3369not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3370
3371Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3372configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3373even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3374running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3375delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3376test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3377on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3378
3379If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3380prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3381must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3382However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3383CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3384usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3385unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3386
3387ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3388to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3389broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3390configuration file.
3391
3392The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3393syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3394caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3395require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3396specified by this option.
3397
3398
3399.vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3400.oindex "&%-D%&"
3401.cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3402This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3403(see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3404unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3405If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3406completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3407
3408If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3409colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3410supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3411not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3412the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3413to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3414regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3415
3416The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3417command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3418string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3419synonymous:
3420.code
3421exim -DABC ...
3422exim -DABC= ...
3423.endd
3424To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3425quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3426example:
3427.code
3428exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3429.endd
3430&%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3431
3432
3433.vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3434.oindex "&%-d%&"
3435.cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3436.cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3437This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3438error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3439database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3440filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3441writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3442return code.
3443
3444When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3445standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3446some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3447made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3448of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3449debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3450no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3451are:
3452.display
3453&`acl `& ACL interpretation
3454&`auth `& authenticators
3455&`deliver `& general delivery logic
3456&`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3457&`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3458&`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3459&`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3460&`filter `& filter handling
3461&`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3462&`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3463&`ident `& ident lookup
3464&`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3465&`lists `& matching things in lists
3466&`load `& system load checks
3467&`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3468 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3469&`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3470&`memory `& memory handling
3471&`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3472&`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3473&`queue_run `& queue runs
3474&`receive `& general message reception logic
3475&`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3476&`retry `& retry handling
3477&`rewrite `& address rewriting
3478&`route `& address routing
3479&`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3480&`tls `& TLS logic
3481&`transport `& transports
3482&`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3483&`verify `& address verification logic
3484&`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3485.endd
3486The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3487for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3488tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3489is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3490generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3491turn everything off.
3492
3493.cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3494.cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3495The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3496with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3497unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3498rather than stderr.
3499
3500The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3501&`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3502However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3503daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3504automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3505run in parallel.
3506
3507The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3508of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3509in processing.
3510
3511If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3512any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3513
3514.vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3515.oindex "&%-dd%&"
3516This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3517starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3518subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3519behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3520
3521.vitem &%-dropcr%&
3522.oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3523This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3524handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3525described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3526
3527.vitem &%-E%&
3528.oindex "&%-E%&"
3529.cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3530This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3531failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3532and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3533generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3534could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3535follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3536new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3537
3538.vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3539.oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3540There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3541called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3542example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3543form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3544
3545.vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3546.oindex "&%-F%&"
3547.cindex "sender" "name"
3548.cindex "name" "of sender"
3549This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3550message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3551entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3552their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3553between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3554
3555.vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3556.oindex "&%-f%&"
3557.cindex "sender" "address"
3558.cindex "address" "sender"
3559.cindex "trusted users"
3560.cindex "envelope sender"
3561.cindex "user" "trusted"
3562This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3563message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3564by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3565users to use it.
3566
3567Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3568trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3569options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3570of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3571domain.
3572
3573There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3574can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3575never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3576string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3577examples of shell commands:
3578.code
3579exim -f '<>' user@domain
3580exim -f "" user@domain
3581.endd
3582In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3583with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3584&%-bv%& options.
3585
3586Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3587it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3588refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3589though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3590
3591White
3592.cindex "&""From""& line"
3593space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3594given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3595locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3596&"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3597if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3598
3599.vitem &%-G%&
3600.oindex "&%-G%&"
3601.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-G%& option ignored"
3602This is a Sendmail option which is ignored by Exim.
3603
3604.vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3605.oindex "&%-h%&"
3606.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3607This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3608Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3609headers.)
3610
3611.vitem &%-i%&
3612.oindex "&%-i%&"
3613.cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3614.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3615This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3616line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3617no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3618command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3619
3620.vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3621.oindex "&%-M%&"
3622.cindex "forcing delivery"
3623.cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3624.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3625This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3626any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3627delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3628and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3629
3630Retry
3631.cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3632hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3633the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3634to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3635which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3636for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3637
3638The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3639not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3640produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3641use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3642
3643.vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3644.oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3645.cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3646.cindex "recipient" "adding"
3647This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3648message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3649id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3650active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3651can be used only by an admin user.
3652
3653.vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3654 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3655.oindex "&%-MC%&"
3656.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3657.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3658.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3659This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3660by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3661an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3662given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3663must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3664
3665.vitem &%-MCA%&
3666.oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3667This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3668by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3669connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3670
3671.vitem &%-MCP%&
3672.oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3673This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3674by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3675which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3676
3677.vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3678.oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3679This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3680by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3681started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3682together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3683signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3684messages through the same SMTP connection.
3685
3686.vitem &%-MCS%&
3687.oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3688This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3689by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3690SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3691connection.
3692
3693.vitem &%-MCT%&
3694.oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3695This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3696by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3697host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3698
3699.vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3700.oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3701.cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3702.cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3703This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3704but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3705that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3706provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3707order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3708However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3709respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3710overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3711If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3712&%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3713and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3714
3715.vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3716.oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3717.cindex "message" "changing sender"
3718.cindex "sender" "changing"
3719This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3720given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3721&"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3722be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3723is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3724This option can be used only by an admin user.
3725
3726.vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3727.oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3728.cindex "freezing messages"
3729.cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3730This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3731prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3732either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3733However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3734attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3735user.
3736
3737.vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3738.oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3739.cindex "giving up on messages"
3740.cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3741.cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3742This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3743including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3744their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3745is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3746Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3747user.
3748
3749.vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3750.oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3751.cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3752This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3753as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3754message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3755altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3756
3757.vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3758.oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3759.cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3760.cindex "recipient" "removing"
3761.cindex "removing recipients"
3762This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3763(&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3764the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3765addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3766(in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3767can be used only by an admin user.
3768
3769.vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3770.oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3771.cindex "removing messages"
3772.cindex "abandoning mail"
3773.cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3774This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3775bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3776the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3777only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3778placed on the queue.
3779
3780.vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3781.oindex "&%-Mset%&
3782.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3783.cindex "expansion" "testing"
3784This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3785string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3786the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3787&$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3788available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3789make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3790user. See also &%-bem%&.
3791
3792.vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3793.oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3794.cindex "thawing messages"
3795.cindex "unfreezing messages"
3796.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3797.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3798This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3799&"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3800messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3801by an admin user.
3802
3803.vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3804.oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3805.cindex "listing" "message body"
3806.cindex "message" "listing body of"
3807This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3808written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3809
3810.vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3811.oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3812.cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3813.cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3814This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3815be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3816only by an admin user.
3817
3818.vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3819.oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3820.cindex "listing" "message headers"
3821.cindex "header lines" "listing"
3822.cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3823This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3824written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3825
3826.vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3827.oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3828.cindex "listing" "message log"
3829.cindex "message" "listing message log"
3830This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3831the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3832
3833.vitem &%-m%&
3834.oindex "&%-m%&"
3835This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3836treats it that way too.
3837
3838.vitem &%-N%&
3839.oindex "&%-N%&"
3840.cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3841.cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3842This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3843level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3844it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3845had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3846database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3847than &"=>"&.
3848
3849Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3850user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
3851words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
3852which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
3853address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
3854routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
3855the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
3856for that message.
3857
3858.vitem &%-n%&
3859.oindex "&%-n%&"
3860.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-n%& option ignored"
3861This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&. It is ignored
3862by Exim.
3863
3864.vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
3865.oindex "&%-O%&"
3866This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
3867Exim.
3868
3869.vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
3870.oindex "&%-oA%&"
3871.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
3872This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
3873alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
3874description above.
3875
3876.vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
3877.oindex "&%-oB%&"
3878.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3879.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3880.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3881This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
3882be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
3883transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
3884
3885.vitem &%-odb%&
3886.oindex "&%-odb%&"
3887.cindex "background delivery"
3888.cindex "delivery" "in the background"
3889This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3890including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
3891messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
3892delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
3893processes to finish.
3894
3895When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
3896leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
3897and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
3898This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
3899
3900If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
3901(&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
3902overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
3903setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
3904
3905.vitem &%-odf%&
3906.oindex "&%-odf%&"
3907.cindex "foreground delivery"
3908.cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
3909This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
3910accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
3911&%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
3912and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
3913
3914The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
3915process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
3916during deliveries.
3917
3918However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
3919false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
3920
3921If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
3922message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
3923process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
3924restricted configuration that never queues messages.
3925
3926
3927.vitem &%-odi%&
3928.oindex "&%-odi%&"
3929This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
3930Sendmail.
3931
3932.vitem &%-odq%&
3933.oindex "&%-odq%&"
3934.cindex "non-immediate delivery"
3935.cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
3936.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
3937This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3938including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
3939not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
3940are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
3941process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
3942&%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
3943conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
3944forces queueing.
3945
3946.vitem &%-odqs%&
3947.oindex "&%-odqs%&"
3948.cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
3949This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
3950However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
3951&%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
3952configuration file is in effect.
3953
3954When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
3955message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
3956also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
3957in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
3958done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
3959runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
3960messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
3961host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
3962configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
3963&%-qq%& option.
3964
3965.vitem &%-oee%&
3966.oindex "&%-oee%&"
3967.cindex "error" "reporting"
3968If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
3969example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
3970message.
3971
3972.cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
3973Provided
3974this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
3975exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
3976is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 any other error. This is
3977the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
3978
3979.vitem &%-oem%&
3980.oindex "&%-oem%&"
3981.cindex "error" "reporting"
3982.cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
3983This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
3984return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
3985This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
3986
3987.vitem &%-oep%&
3988.oindex "&%-oep%&"
3989.cindex "error" "reporting"
3990If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
3991error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
3992.cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
3993The return code is 1 for all errors.
3994
3995.vitem &%-oeq%&
3996.oindex "&%-oeq%&"
3997.cindex "error" "reporting"
3998This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
3999effect as &%-oep%&.
4000
4001.vitem &%-oew%&
4002.oindex "&%-oew%&"
4003.cindex "error" "reporting"
4004This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4005effect as &%-oem%&.
4006
4007.vitem &%-oi%&
4008.oindex "&%-oi%&"
4009.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4010This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4011line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4012single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4013lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4014&'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4015
4016.vitem &%-oitrue%&
4017.oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4018This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4019
4020.vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4021.oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4022.cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4023A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4024with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4025over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4026&%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4027other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4028
4029The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4030number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4031.code
4032exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4033.endd
4034An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4035followed by a colon and the port number:
4036.code
4037exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4038.endd
4039The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4040port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4041are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4042whichever one is last.
4043
4044.vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4045.oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4046.cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4047See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4048option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4049name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4050This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4051authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4052
4053.vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4054.oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4055.cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4056See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4057option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4058This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4059where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4060&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4061
4062.vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4063.oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4064.cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4065See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4066option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4067overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4068messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4069default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4070specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4071&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4072
4073.vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4074.oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4075.cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4076See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4077option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4078using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4079&$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4080
4081.vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4082.oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4083.cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4084.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4085See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4086option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4087&$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4088or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4089SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4090&<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4091one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4092be set by &%-oMr%&.
4093
4094.vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4095.oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4096.cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4097See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4098option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4099present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4100uses the name it is given.
4101
4102.vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4103.oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4104.cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4105See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4106option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4107local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4108used, when there is no default.
4109
4110.vitem &%-om%&
4111.oindex "&%-om%&"
4112.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4113In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4114message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4115expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4116
4117.vitem &%-oo%&
4118.oindex "&%-oo%&"
4119.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4120This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4121whatever that means.
4122
4123.vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4124.oindex "&%-oP%&"
4125.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4126.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4127This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4128value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4129written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4130without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4131because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4132
4133.vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4134.oindex "&%-or%&"
4135.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4136This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4137set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4138by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4139described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4140
4141.vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4142.oindex "&%-os%&"
4143.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4144.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4145This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4146applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4147the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4148for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4149
4150.vitem &%-ov%&
4151.oindex "&%-ov%&"
4152This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4153
4154.vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4155.oindex "&%-oX%&"
4156.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4157.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4158.cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4159This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4160is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4161of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4162in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4163file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4164
4165.vitem &%-pd%&
4166.oindex "&%-pd%&"
4167.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4168This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4169chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4170option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4171needed.
4172
4173.vitem &%-ps%&
4174.oindex "&%-ps%&"
4175.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4176This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4177chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4178option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4179started.
4180
4181.vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4182.oindex "&%-p%&"
4183For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4184.display
4185&`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4186.endd
4187It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4188host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4189Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4190to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`p`&
4191or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4192
4193.vitem &%-q%&
4194.oindex "&%-q%&"
4195.cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4196This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4197configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4198relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4199and &%-S%& options).
4200
4201.cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4202The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4203waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4204for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4205process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4206have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4207
4208If
4209.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4210.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4211.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4212the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4213passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4214proceeding.
4215
4216When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4217process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4218mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4219this to be repeated periodically.
4220
4221Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4222random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4223If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4224MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4225
4226It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4227order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4228&%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4229
4230.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4231The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4232behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4233appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4234
4235.vitem &%-qq...%&
4236.oindex "&%-qq%&"
4237.cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4238.cindex "queue" "routing"
4239.cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4240An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4241stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4242every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4243transports are run.
4244
4245.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4246The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4247is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4248complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4249place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4250delivered down a single SMTP
4251.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4252.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4253.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4254connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4255This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4256intermittently.
4257
4258.vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4259.oindex "&%-qi%&"
4260.cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4261If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4262those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4263delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4264&%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4265
4266.vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4267.oindex "&%-qf%&"
4268.cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4269.cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4270If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4271message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4272their retry times are tried.
4273
4274.vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4275.oindex "&%-qff%&"
4276.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4277If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4278frozen or not.
4279
4280.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4281.oindex "&%-ql%&"
4282.cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4283The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4284be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4285for later delivery.
4286
4287.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4288.cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4289When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4290lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4291starting message id. For example:
4292.code
4293exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4294.endd
4295Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4296second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4297are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4298.code
4299exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4300.endd
4301just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4302&%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4303that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4304mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4305are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4306queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4307
4308.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4309.cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4310.cindex "periodic queue running"
4311When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4312starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4313(whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4314&%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4315single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4316combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4317.code
4318/usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4319.endd
4320Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4321process every 30 minutes.
4322
4323When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4324pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4325
4326.vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4327.oindex "&%-qR%&"
4328This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4329compatibility.
4330
4331.vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4332.oindex "&%-qS%&"
4333This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4334
4335.vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4336.oindex "&%-R%&"
4337.cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4338.cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4339.cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4340The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4341is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4342which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4343<&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4344
4345This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4346perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4347queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4348address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4349way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4350regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4351
4352If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4353you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4354.code
4355exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4356.endd
4357This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4358every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4359applied to each queue run.
4360
4361Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4362are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4363information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4364means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4365existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4366address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4367will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4368information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4369address will be skipped.
4370
4371.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4372If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4373all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4374&'ff'& is present.
4375
4376The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4377to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4378command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4379effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4380an arbitrary command instead.
4381
4382.vitem &%-r%&
4383.oindex "&%-r%&"
4384This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4385
4386.vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4387.oindex "&%-S%&"
4388.cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4389.cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4390This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4391message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4392conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4393has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4394
4395.vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4396.oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4397This an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4398recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4399&"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4400
4401.vitem &%-t%&
4402.oindex "&%-t%&"
4403.cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4404.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4405.cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4406.cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4407When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4408input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4409from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4410from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4411takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4412
4413.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4414If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4415is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4416the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4417and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4418Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4419Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4420argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4421Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4422instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4423&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4424
4425.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4426If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4427recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4428lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4429with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4430&%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4431
4432RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4433message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4434added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4435not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4436nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4437In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4438are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4439once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4440&%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4441
4442.vitem &%-ti%&
4443.oindex "&%-ti%&"
4444This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4445compatibility with Sendmail.
4446
4447.vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4448.oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4449.cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4450.cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4451This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4452incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4453&%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4454&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4455
4456
4457.vitem &%-U%&
4458.oindex "&%-U%&"
4459.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4460Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4461documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4462syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4463set. Exim ignores this option.
4464
4465.vitem &%-v%&
4466.oindex "&%-v%&"
4467This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4468describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4469receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4470dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4471the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4472selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4473unconditional.
4474
4475.vitem &%-x%&
4476.oindex "&%-x%&"
4477AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4478National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4479It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4480this option.
4481.endlist
4482
4483.ecindex IIDclo1
4484.ecindex IIDclo2
4485
4486
4487. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4488. Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4489. line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4490. creates a man page for the options.
4491. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4492
4493.literal xml
4494<!-- === End of command line options === -->
4495.literal off
4496
4497
4498
4499
4500
4501. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4502. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4503
4504
4505.chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4506 "The runtime configuration file"
4507
4508.cindex "run time configuration"
4509.cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4510.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4511.cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4512.cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4513.cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4514Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4515binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4516because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4517control.
4518
4519If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4520writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4521The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4522errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4523not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4524actually alter the string.
4525
4526The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4527reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4528most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4529give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4530existing file in the list.
4531
4532.cindex "EXIM_USER"
4533.cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4534.cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4535.cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4536.cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4537.cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4538The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4539specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4540configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4541group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4542CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4543
4544&*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4545to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4546easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4547CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4548who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4549
4550Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4551be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4552since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4553compromise the Exim user account.
4554
4555A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4556is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4557defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4558configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4559CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4560&<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4561configuration.
4562
4563
4564
4565.section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4566.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4567A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4568option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4569&%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4570unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4571CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4572is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4573is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4574installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4575specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4576
4577Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4578with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4579listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4580testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4581delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4582Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4583the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4584can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4585message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4586&%-M%&).
4587
4588If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4589prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4590start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4591There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4592name can be used with &%-C%&.
4593
4594One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4595option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4596configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4597non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4598If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4599completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4600
4601The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4602to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4603necessarily be discarded.
4604WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4605considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4606values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4607is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4608transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4609values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4610
4611Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4612share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4613If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4614looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4615and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4616file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4617each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4618
4619In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4620different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4621help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4622
4623
4624
4625.section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4626.cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4627.cindex "format" "configuration file"
4628Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4629option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4630are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4631is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4632optional parts are:
4633
4634.ilist
4635&'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4636&<<CHAPACL>>&).
4637.next
4638.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4639&'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4640are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4641.next
4642&'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4643addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4644&<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4645.next
4646&'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4647define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4648&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4649.next
4650&'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4651If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4652defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4653are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4654&<<CHAPretry>>&.
4655.next
4656&'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4657when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4658chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4659.next
4660&'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4661want to use this feature, you must set
4662.code
4663LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4664.endd
4665in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4666facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4667.endlist
4668
4669.cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4670.cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4671.cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4672Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4673
4674Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4675leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4676# character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4677and does not introduce a comment.
4678
4679Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4680the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4681backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4682lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4683appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4684
4685A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4686default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4687change settings as required.
4688
4689The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4690described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4691respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4692items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4693onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4694described.
4695
4696
4697
4698.section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4699.cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4700.cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4701.cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4702.cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4703You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4704using this syntax:
4705.display
4706&`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4707&`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4708.endd
4709on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4710the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4711second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4712name is required.
4713
4714Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4715configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4716If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4717because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4718
4719The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4720comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4721for example:
4722.code
4723hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4724 .include /some/file
4725.endd
4726Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4727process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4728inclusion appears.
4729
4730
4731
4732.section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4733.cindex "macro" "description of"
4734.cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4735If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4736&"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4737definition, and must be of the form
4738.display
4739<&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4740.endd
4741The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4742in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4743continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4744space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4745a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4746
4747Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4748definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4749ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4750
4751.section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4752Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4753files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4754scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4755replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4756for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4757the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4758define
4759.display
4760&`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4761&`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4762.endd
4763but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4764error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4765before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4766consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4767line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4768comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4769
4770
4771.section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4772Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4773(or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4774&'='&. For example:
4775.code
4776MAC = initial value
4777...
4778MAC == updated value
4779.endd
4780Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4781subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4782the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4783Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4784.code
4785MAC = initial value
4786...
4787MAC == MAC and something added
4788.endd
4789This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4790from a number of other files.
4791
4792.section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4793The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4794&%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4795used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4796using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4797file to be ignored.
4798
4799
4800
4801.section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4802As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4803up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4804strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4805.code
4806ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4807 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4808.endd
4809This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4810.code
4811data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4812.endd
4813In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4814address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4815section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4816
4817
4818.section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4819.cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4820.cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4821You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4822&`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4823portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4824read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4825
4826The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4827be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4828that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4829line. Thus:
4830.code
4831.ifdef AAA
4832message_size_limit = 50M
4833.else
4834message_size_limit = 100M
4835.endif
4836.endd
4837sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
4838otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
4839is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
4840obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
4841
4842Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
4843it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
4844in this line"& will always be true.
4845
4846Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
4847to clarify complicated nestings.
4848
4849
4850
4851.section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
4852.cindex "common option syntax"
4853.cindex "syntax of common options"
4854.cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
4855For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
4856each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
4857lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
4858these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
4859space) and then the value. For example:
4860.code
4861qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
4862.endd
4863.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
4864.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
4865.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
4866Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
4867accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
4868line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
4869word &"hide"&. For example:
4870.code
4871hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
4872.endd
4873For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
4874.code
4875mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
4876.endd
4877If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
4878all instances of the same driver.
4879
4880The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
4881that are found in option settings.
4882
4883
4884.section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
4885.cindex "format" "boolean"
4886.cindex "boolean configuration values"
4887.oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
4888.oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
4889Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
4890different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
4891the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
4892if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
4893boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
4894&"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
4895the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
4896.code
4897queue_only
4898queue_only = true
4899.endd
4900The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
4901.code
4902no_queue_only
4903queue_only = false
4904.endd
4905You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
4906
4907
4908
4909
4910.section "Integer values" "SECID48"
4911.cindex "integer configuration values"
4912.cindex "format" "integer"
4913If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
4914hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
4915number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
4916with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
4917hexadecimal number.
4918
4919If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
4920it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
4921of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
49221024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
4923and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
4924used.
4925
4926
4927.section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
4928.cindex "integer format"
4929.cindex "format" "octal integer"
4930If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
4931interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
4932Such options are always output in octal.
4933
4934
4935.section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
4936.cindex "fixed point configuration values"
4937.cindex "format" "fixed point"
4938If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
4939integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
4940
4941
4942
4943.section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
4944.cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
4945.cindex "format" "time interval"
4946A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
4947the following letters, with no intervening white space:
4948
4949.table2 30pt
4950.irow &%s%& seconds
4951.irow &%m%& minutes
4952.irow &%h%& hours
4953.irow &%d%& days
4954.irow &%w%& weeks
4955.endtable
4956
4957For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
4958intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
4959is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
4960
4961
4962
4963.section "String values" "SECTstrings"
4964.cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
4965.cindex "format" "string"
4966If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
4967or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
4968consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
4969the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
4970removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
4971Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
4972appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
4973therefore equivalent:
4974.code
4975trusted_users = uucp:mail
4976trusted_users = uucp:\
4977 # This comment line is ignored
4978 mail
4979.endd
4980.cindex "string" "quoted"
4981.cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
4982If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
4983double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
4984continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
4985
4986.table2 100pt
4987.irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
4988.irow &`\n`& "newline"
4989.irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
4990.irow &`\t`& "tab"
4991.irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
4992.irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
4993 character"
4994.endtable
4995
4996If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
4997character, that character replaces the pair.
4998
4999Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5000insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5001trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5002current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5003in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5004and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5005
5006
5007.section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5008.cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5009Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5010by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5011circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5012is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5013strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5014However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5015backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5016within a quoted configuration string.
5017
5018
5019.section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5020.cindex "user name" "format of"
5021.cindex "format" "user name"
5022.cindex "groups" "name format"
5023.cindex "format" "group name"
5024User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5025above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5026either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5027&[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5028
5029
5030.section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5031.cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5032.cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5033.cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5034The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5035default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5036the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5037&"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5038are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5039particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5040&<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5041
5042In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5043input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5044&<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5045in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5046on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5047start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5048example, the list
5049.code
5050local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5051.endd
5052contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5053
5054&*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5055list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5056colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5057be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5058
5059.section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
5060.cindex "list separator" "changing"
5061.cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5062Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5063introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5064with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5065character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5066above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5067.code
5068local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5069.endd
5070This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5071&%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5072confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5073
5074.cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5075.cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5076It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5077code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5078must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5079are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5080sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5081interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5082generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5083.code
5084domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5085.endd
5086This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5087to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5088expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5089the value in quotes. For example:
5090.code
5091local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5092.endd
5093Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5094doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5095set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5096enclosing an empty list item.
5097
5098
5099
5100.section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5101.cindex "list" "empty item in"
5102An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5103separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5104.code
5105senders = user@domain :
5106.endd
5107contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5108in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5109items, the second of which is empty:
5110.code
5111senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5112.endd
5113&*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5114are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5115would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5116just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5117.code
5118senders = :
5119.endd
5120In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5121is at the end of the list.
5122
5123
5124
5125
5126.section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5127.cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5128There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5129and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5130instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5131a sequence of lines like this:
5132.display
5133<&'instance name'&>:
5134 <&'option'&>
5135 ...
5136 <&'option'&>
5137.endd
5138In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5139followed by three options settings:
5140.code
5141localuser:
5142 driver = accept
5143 check_local_user
5144 transport = local_delivery
5145.endd
5146For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5147setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5148settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5149deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5150a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5151described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5152
5153You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5154the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5155
5156The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5157passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5158transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5159authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5160them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5161server.
5162
5163.cindex "generic options"
5164.cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5165Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5166and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5167same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5168&%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5169.cindex "private options"
5170The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5171they all have default values.
5172
5173The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5174precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5175this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5176
5177Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5178elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5179with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5180a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5181instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5182confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5183configuration lines:
5184.code
5185remote_smtp:
5186 driver = smtp
5187.endd
5188create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5189&(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5190different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5191instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5192thus:
5193.code
5194special_smtp:
5195 driver = smtp
5196 port = 1234
5197 command_timeout = 10s
5198.endd
5199The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5200these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5201lines.
5202
5203Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5204list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5205defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5206option.
5207
5208
5209
5210
5211
5212
5213. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5214. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5215
5216.chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5217.scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5218.cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5219The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5220is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5221the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5222configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5223of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5224itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5225initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5226mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5227
5228
5229
5230.section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5231The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5232file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5233the line
5234.code
5235# primary_hostname =
5236.endd
5237This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5238to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5239can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5240it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5241
5242The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5243.code
5244domainlist local_domains = @
5245domainlist relay_to_domains =
5246hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5247.endd
5248These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5249domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5250domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5251configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5252
5253The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5254later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5255on the local host.
5256
5257.cindex "@ in a domain list"
5258There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5259of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5260called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5261be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5262the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5263
5264The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5265list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5266controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5267domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5268domain is permitted.
5269
5270The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5271used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5272that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5273loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5274submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5275hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5276
5277Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5278we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5279and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5280
5281The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5282.code
5283acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5284acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5285.endd
5286These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5287during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5288command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5289respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5290&'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5291section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5292accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5293to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5294contents of a message to be checked.
5295
5296Two commented-out option settings are next:
5297.code
5298# av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5299# spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5300.endd
5301These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5302content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5303scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5304details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5305
5306Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5307.code
5308# tls_advertise_hosts = *
5309# tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5310# tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5311.endd
5312These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5313support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5314first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5315connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5316other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5317key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5318More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5319
5320Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5321.code
5322# daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5323# tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5324.endd
5325.cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5326.cindex "port" "for message submission"
5327.cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5328.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5329.cindex "smtps protocol"
5330.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5331.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5332These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5333server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5334TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5335more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5336on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5337port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5338configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5339non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5340&<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5341
5342Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5343.code
5344# qualify_domain =
5345# qualify_recipient =
5346.endd
5347The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5348complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5349receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5350the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5351you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5352addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5353
5354.cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5355The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5356addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5357(an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5358.code
5359# allow_domain_literals
5360.endd
5361The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5362Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5363quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5364try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5365people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5366&'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5367
5368The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5369.code
5370never_users = root
5371.endd
5372It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5373convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5374setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5375The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5376list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5377FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5378contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5379FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5380
5381When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5382Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5383line,
5384.code
5385host_lookup = *
5386.endd
5387specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5388in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5389information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5390or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5391Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5392because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5393unreachable.
5394
5395The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
53961413 (hence their names):
5397.code
5398rfc1413_hosts = *
5399rfc1413_query_timeout = 5s
5400.endd
5401These settings cause Exim to make ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5402You can limit the hosts to which these calls are made, or change the timeout
5403that is used. If you set the timeout to zero, all ident calls are disabled.
5404Although they are cheap and can provide useful information for tracing problem
5405messages, some hosts and firewalls have problems with ident calls. This can
5406result in a timeout instead of an immediate refused connection, leading to
5407delays on starting up an incoming SMTP session.
5408
5409When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5410be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5411if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5412find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5413.code
5414# sender_unqualified_hosts =
5415# recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5416.endd
5417show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5418and recipient addresses, respectively.
5419
5420The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5421.code
5422# percent_hack_domains =
5423.endd
5424It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5425This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5426anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5427
5428The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5429concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5430message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5431occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5432address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5433bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5434are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5435always bounce messages.
5436.code
5437ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5438timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5439.endd
5440The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5441discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5442message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5443after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5444bounce message ever lasts a week.
5445
5446
5447
5448.section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5449.cindex "default" "ACLs"
5450.cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5451In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5452It starts with the line
5453.code
5454begin acl
5455.endd
5456and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5457&'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5458and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5459
5460.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5461The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5462RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5463are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5464rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5465result of the ACL processing.
5466.code
5467acl_check_rcpt:
5468.endd
5469This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5470ACL, and names it.
5471.code
5472accept hosts = :
5473.endd
5474This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5475But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5476names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5477list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5478host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5479important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5480
5481What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5482messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5483input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5484manner.
5485.code
5486deny message = Restricted characters in address
5487 domains = +local_domains
5488 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5489
5490deny message = Restricted characters in address
5491 domains = !+local_domains
5492 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5493.endd
5494These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5495characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5496Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5497&"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5498in Internet mail addresses.
5499
5500The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5501addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5502option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5503in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5504programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5505at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5506characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5507policy of being as safe as possible.
5508
5509The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5510to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5511first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5512&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5513reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5514&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5515
5516The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5517block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5518or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5519have to modify this rule.
5520
5521Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5522allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5523common convention of local parts constructed as
5524&"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5525the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5526with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5527file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5528that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5529is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5530
5531The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5532allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5533and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5534with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5535local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5536and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5537(or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5538.code
5539accept local_parts = postmaster
5540 domains = +local_domains
5541.endd
5542This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5543local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5544&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5545reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5546&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5547
5548The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5549by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5550in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5551.code
5552require verify = sender
5553.endd
5554This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5555ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5556address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5557see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5558addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5559used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5560discusses the details of address verification.
5561.code
5562accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5563 control = submission
5564.endd
5565This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5566hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5567verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5568that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5569second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5570is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5571messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5572&'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5573probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5574.code
5575accept authenticated = *
5576 control = submission
5577.endd
5578This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5579Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5580likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5581authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5582examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5583fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5584.code
5585require message = relay not permitted
5586 domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
5587.endd
5588This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5589one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5590.code
5591require verify = recipient
5592.endd
5593This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5594fails, the address is rejected.
5595.code
5596# deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5597# is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5598# $dnslist_text
5599# dnslists = black.list.example
5600#
5601# warn dnslists = black.list.example
5602# add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5603# a black list at $dnslist_domain
5604# log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5605.endd
5606These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5607sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5608from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5609line.
5610.code
5611# require verify = csa
5612.endd
5613This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5614authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5615records.
5616.code
5617accept
5618.endd
5619The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5620address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5621.code
5622acl_check_data:
5623.endd
5624This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5625of this ACL are commented out:
5626.code
5627# deny malware = *
5628# message = This message contains a virus \
5629# ($malware_name).
5630.endd
5631These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5632viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5633suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5634virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5635.code
5636# warn spam = nobody
5637# message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5638# X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5639# X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5640# X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5641.endd
5642These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5643SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5644and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5645&`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5646series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5647whatever the spam score.
5648.code
5649accept
5650.endd
5651This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5652
5653
5654.section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5655.cindex "default" "routers"
5656.cindex "routers" "default"
5657The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5658by the line
5659.code
5660begin routers
5661.endd
5662Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5663messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5664accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5665matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5666manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5667.code
5668# domain_literal:
5669# driver = ipliteral
5670# domains = !+local_domains
5671# transport = remote_smtp
5672.endd
5673.cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5674This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5675support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5676you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5677&%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5678.code
5679dnslookup:
5680 driver = dnslookup
5681 domains = ! +local_domains
5682 transport = remote_smtp
5683 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5684 no_more
5685.endd
5686The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5687domains. This is specified by the line
5688.code
5689domains = ! +local_domains
5690.endd
5691The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5692exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5693that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5694the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5695indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5696passed on to the following routers.
5697
5698The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5699and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5700the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5701instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5702one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5703
5704The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5705DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5706router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5707specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5708in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5709the address fails and is bounced.
5710
5711The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5712be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5713encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5714whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5715Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5716email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5717continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5718out.
5719.code
5720system_aliases:
5721 driver = redirect
5722 allow_fail
5723 allow_defer
5724 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5725# user = exim
5726 file_transport = address_file
5727 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5728.endd
5729Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5730domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5731alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5732data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5733the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5734the next router.
5735
5736&_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5737often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5738file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5739&_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5740.code
5741userforward:
5742 driver = redirect
5743 check_local_user
5744# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5745# local_part_suffix_optional
5746 file = $home/.forward
5747# allow_filter
5748 no_verify
5749 no_expn
5750 check_ancestor
5751 file_transport = address_file
5752 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5753 reply_transport = address_reply
5754.endd
5755This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5756redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5757individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5758local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5759router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5760namely:
5761.code
5762# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5763# local_part_suffix_optional
5764.endd
5765.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5766show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5767is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5768by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5769variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5770presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5771the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5772
5773When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5774home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5775declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5776redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5777
5778.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5779Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5780files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5781is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5782of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5783filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5784separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5785
5786The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5787verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5788There are two reasons for doing this:
5789
5790.olist
5791Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5792checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5793unnecessary work.
5794.next
5795More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5796command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5797The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5798It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5799this time.
5800.endlist
5801
5802The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5803address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5804works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5805forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5806
5807The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5808forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5809auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5810.code
5811a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5812.endd
5813the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5814transport.
5815.code
5816localuser:
5817 driver = accept
5818 check_local_user
5819# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5820# local_part_suffix_optional
5821 transport = local_delivery
5822.endd
5823The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5824part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
5825the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5826routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
5827same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
5828
5829
5830.section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
5831.cindex "default" "transports"
5832.cindex "transports" "default"
5833Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
5834only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
5835not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
5836.code
5837begin transports
5838.endd
5839One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
5840.code
5841remote_smtp:
5842 driver = smtp
5843.endd
5844This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections. All its
5845options are defaulted. The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
5846.code
5847local_delivery:
5848 driver = appendfile
5849 file = /var/mail/$local_part
5850 delivery_date_add
5851 envelope_to_add
5852 return_path_add
5853# group = mail
5854# mode = 0660
5855.endd
5856This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
5857traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
5858local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
5859directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
5860under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
5861show how this can be done.
5862
5863Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
5864&'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
5865similarly-named options above.
5866.code
5867address_pipe:
5868 driver = pipe
5869 return_output
5870.endd
5871This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
5872redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
5873option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
5874sender.
5875.code
5876address_file:
5877 driver = appendfile
5878 delivery_date_add
5879 envelope_to_add
5880 return_path_add
5881.endd
5882This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
5883redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
5884&(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
5885.code
5886address_reply:
5887 driver = autoreply
5888.endd
5889This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
5890filter files.
5891
5892
5893
5894.section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
5895.cindex "retry" "default rule"
5896.cindex "default" "retry rule"
5897The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
5898Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
5899introduced by the line
5900.code
5901begin retry
5902.endd
5903In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
5904errors:
5905.code
5906* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
5907.endd
5908This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
59092 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
59101.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
5911is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
5912
5913If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
5914if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
5915temporary errors into permanent errors.
5916
5917
5918.section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
5919The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
5920.code
5921begin rewrite
5922.endd
5923contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
5924rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
5925
5926
5927
5928.section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
5929.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
5930The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
5931.code
5932begin authenticators
5933.endd
5934defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
5935configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
5936which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
5937standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
5938mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
5939to support most MUA software.
5940
5941The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
5942.code
5943#PLAIN:
5944# driver = plaintext
5945# server_set_id = $auth2
5946# server_prompts = :
5947# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
5948# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
5949.endd
5950And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
5951.code
5952#LOGIN:
5953# driver = plaintext
5954# server_set_id = $auth1
5955# server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
5956# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
5957# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
5958.endd
5959
5960The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
5961in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
5962&%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
5963that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
5964i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
5965when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
5966when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
5967need to add support for TLS as described in &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
5968
5969The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
5970password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
5971To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
5972expression like one of the examples in &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
5973
5974Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
5975usercode and password are in different positions. &<<CHAPplaintext>>&
5976covers both.
5977
5978.ecindex IIDconfiwal
5979
5980
5981
5982. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5983. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5984
5985.chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
5986
5987.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
5988.cindex "PCRE"
5989Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
5990uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
5991matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
5992regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
5993Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
5994O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
5995
5996The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
5997are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
5998description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
5999the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6000the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6001case-insensitive.
6002
6003In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6004it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6005or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6006second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6007.code
6008domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6009.endd
6010The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6011precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6012of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6013regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6014backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6015normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6016matched.
6017
6018There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6019recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6020string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6021these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6022it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6023match anywhere in the subject string.
6024
6025In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6026you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6027.code
6028domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6029.endd
6030matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6031You need to use:
6032.code
6033domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6034.endd
6035if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6036$ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6037
6038
6039
6040. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6041. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6042
6043.chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6044.scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6045.scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6046.cindex "lookup" "description of"
6047Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6048messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6049
6050.olist
6051A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6052cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6053lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6054can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6055&<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6056.next
6057Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6058way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6059returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6060succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6061chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6062.endlist
6063
6064String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6065that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6066involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6067if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6068time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6069chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6070
6071.section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6072It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6073lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6074processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6075Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6076.code
6077domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6078domains = lsearch;/some/file
6079.endd
6080The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6081No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6082defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6083The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6084file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6085.code
6086192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6087192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6088.endd
6089When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6090possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6091
6092In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6093Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6094in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6095.code
6096domain1:
6097domain2:
6098.endd
6099Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6100matches the list item.
6101
6102It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6103Consider a file containing lines like this:
6104.code
6105192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6106.endd
6107If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6108first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6109causes a second lookup to occur.
6110
6111The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6112available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6113lookup is permitted.
6114
6115
6116.section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6117.cindex "lookup" "types of"
6118.cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6119Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6120
6121.ilist
6122The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6123and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6124lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6125.next
6126.cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6127The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6128key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6129Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6130.endlist
6131
6132The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6133the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6134default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6135.code
6136LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6137LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6138.endd
6139which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6140For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6141libraries and header files before building Exim.
6142
6143
6144
6145
6146.section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6147.cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6148.cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6149The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6150
6151.ilist
6152.cindex "cdb" "description of"
6153.cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6154.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6155&(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6156string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6157indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6158re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6159aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6160be found in several places:
6161.display
6162&url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6163&url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6164&url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6165.endd
6166A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6167because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6168However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6169you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6170.next
6171.cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6172.cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6173.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6174&(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6175DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6176zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6177&<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6178
6179.cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6180For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6181when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6182using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6183the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6184that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6185other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6186.next
6187.cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6188.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6189.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6190.cindex "Courier"
6191.cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6192.cindex "dmbnz lookup type"
6193&(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6194is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6195if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6196other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6197use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6198calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6199utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6200by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6201.next
6202.cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6203.cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6204&(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6205whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6206contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6207the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6208symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6209lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6210&<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6211.next
6212.cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6213.cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6214&(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6215terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6216file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6217IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6218being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6219.code
62201.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6221192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6222"abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6223"abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6224.endd
6225The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6226file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6227key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6228&"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6229&(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6230
6231&*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6232&(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6233lookup types support only literal keys.
6234
6235&*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6236the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6237&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6238.next
6239.cindex "linear search"
6240.cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6241.cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6242.cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6243&(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6244line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6245end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6246letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6247in the file is used.
6248
6249White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6250line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6251continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6252space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6253junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6254colon, for example:
6255.code
6256baduser: :fail:
6257.endd
6258Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6259middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6260that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6261wildcarding of any kind.
6262
6263.cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6264.cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6265In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6266characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6267If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6268matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6269contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6270quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6271quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6272
6273.next
6274.cindex "NIS lookup type"
6275.cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6276.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6277&(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6278the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6279&(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6280reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6281aliases; the full map names must be used.
6282
6283.next
6284.cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6285.cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6286.cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6287.cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6288&(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6289&(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6290the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6291that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6292used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6293
6294.cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6295Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6296file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6297&`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6298
6299. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6300. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6301
6302.olist
6303The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6304.code
6305 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6306 *fish data for anythingfish
6307.endd
6308.next
6309The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6310example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6311.code
6312 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6313.endd
6314Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6315expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6316string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6317.code
6318 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6319.endd
6320The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6321expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6322For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6323.code
6324 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6325.endd
6326
6327If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6328either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6329ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6330colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6331escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6332
6333&*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6334match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6335is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6336takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6337&((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6338
6339.next
6340Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6341is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6342lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6343example:
6344.code
6345 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6346.endd
6347The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6348.endlist olist
6349
6350Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6351continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6352be followed by optional colons.
6353
6354&*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6355&((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6356lookup types support only literal keys.
6357.endlist ilist
6358
6359
6360.section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6361.cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6362.cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6363The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6364many of them are given in later sections.
6365
6366.ilist
6367.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6368.cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6369&(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6370are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6371records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6372.next
6373.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6374.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6375&(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6376.next
6377.cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6378.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6379&(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6380returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6381that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6382called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6383any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6384.next
6385.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6386.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6387&(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6388MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6389.next
6390.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6391.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6392&(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6393the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6394.next
6395.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6396.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6397&(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6398Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6399.next
6400.cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6401.cindex "passwd lookup type"
6402.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6403&(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6404lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6405success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6406lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6407password value. For example:
6408.code
6409*:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6410.endd
6411.next
6412.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6413.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6414&(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6415PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6416
6417.next
6418.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6419.cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6420&(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6421that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6422
6423.next
6424&(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6425not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6426.next
6427.cindex "whoson lookup type"
6428.cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6429&(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6430allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6431address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6432obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6433at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6434superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6435&"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6436.code
6437require condition = \
6438 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6439.endd
6440The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6441the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6442this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6443one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6444.endlist
6445
6446
6447
6448.section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6449.cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6450Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6451completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6452reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6453options such as a list of local domains.
6454
6455When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6456of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6457temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6458or may give up altogether.
6459
6460
6461
6462.section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6463.cindex "wildcard lookups"
6464.cindex "lookup" "default values"
6465.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6466.cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6467.cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6468In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6469that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6470
6471&*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6472lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6473specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6474
6475If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6476and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6477provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6478
6479.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6480.cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6481.cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6482Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6483&%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6484character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6485by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6486that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6487take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6488For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6489.code
6490data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6491.endd
6492Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6493looks up these keys, in this order:
6494.code
6495jane@eyre.example
6496*@eyre.example
6497*
6498.endd
6499The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6500&(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6501complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6502Exim move on to try the next key.
6503
6504
6505
6506.section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6507.cindex "partial matching"
6508.cindex "wildcard lookups"
6509.cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6510.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6511.cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6512The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6513match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6514being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6515information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6516domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6517a key in a DBM file is
6518.code
6519*.dates.fict.example
6520.endd
6521then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6522&'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6523by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6524file.
6525
6526&*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6527also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6528&<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6529
6530Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6531keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6532be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6533partial matching keys
6534beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6535Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6536unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6537
6538Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6539the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6540is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6541is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6542fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6543start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6544remains.
6545
6546A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6547by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6548&%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6549modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6550subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6551up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6552.code
65532250.dates.fict.example
6554*.2250.dates.fict.example
6555*.dates.fict.example
6556*.fict.example
6557.endd
6558As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6559finishes.
6560
6561.cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6562.cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6563The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6564changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6565formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6566parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6567.code
6568domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6569.endd
6570In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6571&`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6572components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6573other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6574.code
6575domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6576.endd
6577For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6578&`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6579
6580If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6581just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6582down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6583
6584.ilist
6585If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6586.next
6587If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6588example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6589.next
6590Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6591remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6592for &"*"& on its own.
6593.next
6594Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6595.endlist
6596
6597
6598If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6599&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6600this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6601specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6602prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6603lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6604&"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6605
6606The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6607in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6608dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6609in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6610subject key is always followed by a dot.
6611
6612
6613
6614
6615.section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6616.cindex "lookup" "caching"
6617.cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6618Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6619lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6620of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6621single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6622
6623For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6624another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6625many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6626the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6627closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6628own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6629
6630The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6631strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6632complete.
6633
6634
6635
6636
6637.section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6638.cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6639.cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6640When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6641is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6642the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6643.code
6644[name=$local_part]
6645.endd
6646will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6647For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6648.code
6649[name="$local_part"]
6650.endd
6651but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6652NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6653rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6654of the following form is provided:
6655.code
6656${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6657.endd
6658For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6659.code
6660[name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6661.endd
6662See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6663operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6664lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6665
6666
6667
6668
6669.section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6670.cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6671.cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6672.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6673The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6674of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6675an expansion string could contain:
6676.code
6677${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6678.endd
6679If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6680is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6681&`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6682&<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6683
6684The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SRV, and TXT, and,
6685when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6686configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6687the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6688&%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6689.code
6690${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6691.endd
6692If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6693altered and nothing is added.
6694
6695.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6696.cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6697For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6698each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6699port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6700
6701For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6702single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6703concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6704depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6705between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6706by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6707.code
6708${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6709.endd
6710It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6711white space is ignored.
6712
6713.cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6714For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6715unless a separator for them is specified using a comma after the separator
6716character followed immediately by the TXT record item separator. To concatenate
6717items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
6718.code
6719${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6720${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6721.endd
6722It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6723white space is ignored.
6724
6725.section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6726.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6727By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6728each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
6729the pseudo-type MXH:
6730.code
6731${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6732.endd
6733In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
6734returned.
6735
6736.cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
6737Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
6738records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6739component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6740records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6741error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6742but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6743top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6744.code
6745${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6746${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6747.endd
6748Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6749the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
6750the name servers for &%edu%&.
6751
6752You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6753top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6754sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6755given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6756for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
6757such a list.
6758
6759.cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6760A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
6761records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
6762&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
6763not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
6764result of a successful lookup such as:
6765.code
6766${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
6767.endd
6768has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
6769The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
6770authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
6771
6772
6773.section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
6774In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
6775However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6776&(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6777the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6778.code
6779${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6780${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6781${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6782.endd
6783In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6784the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6785to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6786case, it does not treat it as a list.
6787
6788The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6789in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6790different separator can be specified, as described above.
6791
6792The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6793temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6794an optional keyword followed by a comma that may appear before the record
6795type. The possible keywords are &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and
6796&"defer_lax"&. With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6797whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6798ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6799With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6800error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6801succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6802.code
6803${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6804${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6805.endd
6806Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6807yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6808
6809
6810
6811
6812.section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
6813.cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
6814.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6815.cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
6816The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
6817become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
6818implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
6819contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
6820the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
6821it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
6822indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
6823your &_Local/Makefile_&:
6824.code
6825LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
6826LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
6827LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
6828LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
6829LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
6830.endd
6831If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
6832same interface as the University of Michigan version.
6833
6834There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
6835the way they handle the results of a query:
6836
6837.ilist
6838&(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
6839gives an error.
6840.next
6841&(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
6842Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
6843.next
6844&(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
6845from all of them are returned.
6846.endlist
6847
6848
6849For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
6850Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
6851the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
6852First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
6853
6854
6855.section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
6856.cindex "LDAP" "query format"
6857An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
6858the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
6859.code
6860data = ${lookup ldap \
6861 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
6862 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
6863.endd
6864.cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
6865The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
6866secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
6867encrypted TLS connection is used.
6868
6869With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
6870LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
6871See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
6872
6873
6874.section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
6875.cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
6876Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
6877and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
6878within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
6879reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
6880
6881The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6882filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
6883the string:
6884.code
6885* => \2A
6886( => \28
6887) => \29
6888\ => \5C
6889.endd
6890in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
6891to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
6892.code
6893! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
6894.endd
6895are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
6896.code
6897${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6898.endd
6899yields
6900.code
6901%20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
6902.endd
6903Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
6904.code
6905a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
6906.endd
6907The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6908base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
6909by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
6910.code
6911, + " \ < > ;
6912.endd
6913It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
6914before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
6915is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
6916.code
6917${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6918.endd
6919yields
6920.code
6921%5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
6922.endd
6923Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
6924.code
6925\ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
6926.endd
6927There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
6928authentication below.
6929
6930
6931.section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
6932.cindex "LDAP" "connections"
6933The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
6934is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
6935an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
6936by starting it with
6937.code
6938ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
6939.endd
6940If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
6941used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
6942taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
6943colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
6944handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
6945returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
6946are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
6947Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
6948failures, and timeouts.
6949
6950For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
6951of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
6952&%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
6953doubled. For example
6954.code
6955ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
6956.endd
6957If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
6958to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
6959the local host) is used.
6960
6961If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
6962a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
6963&`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
6964to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
6965not available.
6966
6967For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
6968for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
6969can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
6970the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
6971.code
6972ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
6973.endd
6974When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
6975&`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
6976.code
6977${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
6978.endd
6979When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
6980a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
6981specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
6982socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
6983&%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
6984or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
6985the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
6986backup host.
6987
6988If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
6989specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
6990&%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
6991
6992.ilist
6993Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
6994interface.
6995.next
6996Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
6997.endlist
6998
6999
7000Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7001&%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7002
7003
7004
7005.section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7006.cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7007The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7008information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7009be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7010spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7011when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7012them. The following names are recognized:
7013.display
7014&`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7015&`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7016&`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7017&`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7018&`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7019&`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7020&`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7021.endd
7022The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7023&"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7024must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7025library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7026
7027The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7028backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7029enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7030network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7031&'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7032LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7033if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7034SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7035Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7036
7037The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7038set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7039
7040
7041Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7042values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7043.code
7044${lookup ldap
7045 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7046 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7047 {$value}fail}
7048.endd
7049The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7050any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7051which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7052non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7053
7054The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7055connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7056on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7057
7058When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7059removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7060some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7061quoting has two advantages:
7062
7063.ilist
7064It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7065DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7066.next
7067It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7068.endlist
7069
7070For example, a setting such as
7071.code
7072USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7073.endd
7074should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7075
7076Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7077expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7078field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7079does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7080.code
7081PASS=${quote:$3}
7082.endd
7083The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7084SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7085&<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7086
7087
7088
7089.section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7090.cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7091The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7092as a sequence of values, for example
7093.code
7094cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7095.endd
7096The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7097search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7098the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7099values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7100you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7101directory.
7102
7103In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7104result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7105has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7106
7107If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7108strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7109quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7110backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7111Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7112output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7113same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7114
7115Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7116LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7117&%attr1%& has two values, whereas &%attr2%& has only one value:
7118.code
7119ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7120value1.1, value1.2
7121
7122ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7123value two
7124
7125ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7126attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7127
7128ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7129objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7130.endd
7131The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7132individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs. You can
7133make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7134results of LDAP lookups.
7135
7136
7137
7138
7139.section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7140.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7141.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7142NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7143and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7144contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7145of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7146values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7147.code
7148[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7149.endd
7150might return the string
7151.code
7152name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7153home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7154.endd
7155(split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7156.code
7157[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7158.endd
7159would just return
7160.code
7161Martin Guerre
7162.endd
7163with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7164for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7165operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7166
7167
7168
7169.section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7170.cindex "SQL lookup types"
7171.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7172.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7173.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7174.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7175.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7176.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7177.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7178.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7179Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7180databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7181might be
7182.code
7183${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7184 {$value}fail}
7185.endd
7186If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7187field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7188.code
7189${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7190 {$value}}
7191.endd
7192might be
7193.code
7194home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7195.endd
7196Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7197quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7198field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7199.code
7200Mister X
7201.endd
7202If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7203with a newline between the data for each row.
7204
7205
7206.section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7207.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7208.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7209.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7210.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7211.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7212.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7213.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7214.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7215If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7216&%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7217option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7218information.
7219(For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7220queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7221&<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7222items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7223Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7224name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7225.code
7226hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7227.endd
7228Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7229&"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7230option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7231.code
7232hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7233 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7234.endd
7235For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7236because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7237query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7238a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7239found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7240servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7241
7242The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7243convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7244respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7245itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7246addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7247for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7248characters are not special.
7249
7250.section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7251For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7252it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7253done by starting the query with
7254.display
7255&`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7256.endd
7257Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7258.olist
7259If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7260global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7261of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7262taken from there.
7263.next
7264If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7265.endlist
7266The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7267Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7268successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7269
7270This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7271are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7272master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7273like this:
7274.code
7275mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7276 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7277 master/db/name/pw
7278.endd
7279In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7280.code
7281${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7282.endd
7283That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7284the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7285option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7286.code
7287${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7288.endd
7289
7290
7291.section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7292For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7293causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7294socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7295each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7296.display
7297<&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7298 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7299.endd
7300Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7301the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7302
7303No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7304the queries.
7305
7306If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7307or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7308
7309&*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7310anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7311is zero because no rows are affected.
7312
7313
7314.section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7315PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7316This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7317However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7318database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7319looks like this:
7320.code
7321hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7322.endd
7323In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7324given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7325visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7326
7327If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7328update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7329affected.
7330
7331.section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7332.cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7333.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7334SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7335addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7336daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7337of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7338separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7339contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7340.code
7341${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7342 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7343.endd
7344In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7345.code
7346domainlist relay_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7347 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7348.endd
7349The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7350quote, which it doubles.
7351
7352The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7353internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7354update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7355are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7356waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7357to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7358option.
7359.ecindex IIDfidalo1
7360.ecindex IIDfidalo2
7361
7362
7363. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7364. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7365
7366.chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7367 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7368 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7369.scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7370A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7371email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7372contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7373are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7374arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7375
7376Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7377host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7378different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7379general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7380
7381
7382
7383.section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7384.cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7385Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7386expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7387into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7388but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7389&<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7390discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7391
7392
7393If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7394testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7395expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7396
7397If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7398other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7399misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7400the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7401expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7402.code
7403deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7404 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7405.endd
7406The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7407&`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7408senders based on the receiving domain.
7409
7410
7411
7412
7413.section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7414.cindex "list" "negation"
7415.cindex "negation" "in lists"
7416Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7417leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7418defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7419it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7420(respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7421
7422The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7423subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7424subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7425subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7426was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7427.code
7428domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7429.endd
7430matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7431neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7432list is positive. However, if the setting were
7433.code
7434domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c
7435.endd
7436then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7437list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7438as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7439
7440Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7441the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7442item.
7443
7444
7445
7446.section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7447.cindex "list" "file name in"
7448If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7449name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7450processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7451file names are not allowed,
7452and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7453Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7454lines:
7455
7456.ilist
7457For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7458file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7459.next
7460Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7461address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7462white space or the start of the line. For example:
7463.code
7464not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7465.endd
7466.endlist
7467
7468Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7469file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7470is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7471so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7472
7473If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7474within the file is inverted. For example, if
7475.code
7476hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7477.endd
7478and the file contains the lines
7479.code
7480!a.b.c
7481*.b.c
7482.endd
7483then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7484any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7485
7486
7487
7488.section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7489As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7490to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7491confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7492an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7493sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7494non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7495always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7496
7497If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7498list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7499in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7500&(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7501
7502
7503
7504
7505.section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7506.cindex "named lists"
7507.cindex "list" "named"
7508A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7509which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7510particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7511places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7512the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7513a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7514locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7515.code
7516domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7517.endd
7518Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7519for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7520configured with the line
7521.code
7522domains = +local_domains
7523.endd
7524The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7525except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7526.code
7527dnslookup:
7528 driver = dnslookup
7529 domains = ! +local_domains
7530 transport = remote_smtp
7531 no_more
7532.endd
7533The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7534the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7535respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7536equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7537.code
7538hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7539addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7540.endd
7541A named list may refer to other named lists:
7542.code
7543domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7544domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7545domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7546.endd
7547&*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7548effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7549out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7550.code
7551domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7552domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7553.endd
7554The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7555list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7556means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7557.code
7558domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7559.endd
7560where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7561referenced lists if you can.
7562
7563Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7564address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7565lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7566.code
7567domains = +local_domains
7568.endd
7569on several of your routers
7570or in several ACL statements,
7571the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7572if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7573references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7574the same each time they are referenced.
7575
7576By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7577extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7578is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7579hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7580
7581
7582
7583.section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7584.cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7585.cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7586At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7587configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7588write
7589.code
7590ALIST = host1 : host2
7591auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7592.endd
7593it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7594.code
7595auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7596.endd
7597Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7598list, and write
7599.code
7600hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7601auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7602.endd
7603the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7604.code
7605auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7606.endd
7607
7608
7609.section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7610.cindex "list" "caching of named"
7611.cindex "caching" "named lists"
7612While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7613it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7614the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7615that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7616an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7617message. For example:
7618.code
7619domainlist special_domains = \
7620 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7621.endd
7622This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7623address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7624in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7625cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7626same list each time.
7627
7628By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7629cache the result anyway. For example:
7630.code
7631domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7632.endd
7633If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7634the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7635
7636
7637
7638.section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7639.cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7640.cindex "list" "domain list"
7641Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7642The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7643
7644.ilist
7645.cindex "primary host name"
7646.cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7647.oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7648.cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7649.cindex "@ in a domain list"
7650If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7651as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7652possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7653differ only in their names.
7654.next
7655.cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7656.cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7657.cindex "domain literal"
7658If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7659in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7660only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7661&%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7662control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7663In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7664.next
7665.cindex "@mx_any"
7666.cindex "@mx_primary"
7667.cindex "@mx_secondary"
7668.cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7669If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7670has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7671.oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7672&%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7673are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7674local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7675but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7676preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7677
7678The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7679performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7680example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7681resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7682options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7683
7684Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7685patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7686list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7687ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7688on a router). For example:
7689.code
7690domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7691.endd
7692This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7693the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7694
7695The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7696host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7697contain negative items.
7698
7699Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7700be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7701list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7702.code
7703domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7704 an.other.domain : ...
7705.endd
7706so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7707involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7708.code
7709domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7710 an.other.domain ? ...
7711.endd
7712.next
7713.cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
7714.cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
7715.cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
7716If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7717are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
7718domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7719list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7720matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7721list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
7722&'cipher.key.ex'&.
7723
7724.next
7725.cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
7726.cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
7727If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7728expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7729function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7730Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
7731default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
7732with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
7733are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
7734
7735&*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7736must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7737use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
7738it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
7739expression by expansion, of course).
7740.next
7741.cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
7742.cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
7743If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7744semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
7745must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7746&"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
7747.code
7748domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7749.endd
7750The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7751key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
7752only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
7753is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
7754or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
7755&$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
7756other statements in the same ACL.
7757
7758.next
7759Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
7760&`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
7761.code
7762domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
7763.endd
7764This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
7765works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
7766
7767.next
7768.cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
7769Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
7770a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
7771original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
7772select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
7773value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
7774expansion variable.
7775.next
7776If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
7777semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
7778pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
7779chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
7780.code
7781hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
7782 where domain = '$domain';
7783.endd
7784In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
7785example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
7786whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
7787&%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
7788variable and can be referred to in other options.
7789.next
7790.cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
7791If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
7792between the pattern and the domain.
7793.endlist
7794
7795Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
7796.code
7797domainlist funny_domains = \
7798 @ : \
7799 lib.unseen.edu : \
7800 *.foundation.fict.example : \
7801 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
7802 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
7803 nis;domains.byname : \
7804 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
7805.endd
7806There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
7807an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
7808explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
7809but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
7810patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
7811patterns earlier.
7812
7813
7814
7815.section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
7816.cindex "host list" "patterns in"
7817.cindex "list" "host list"
7818Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
7819example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
7820may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
7821two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
7822pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
7823You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
7824involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
7825
7826
7827.section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
7828.cindex "empty item in hosts list"
7829.cindex "host list" "empty string in"
7830If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
7831involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
7832process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
7833not used.
7834
7835.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
7836The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
7837the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
7838
7839
7840
7841.section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
7842.cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
7843If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
7844the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
7845&`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
7846list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
7847systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
7848concerns.)
7849
7850The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
7851inspecting its IP address:
7852
7853.ilist
7854If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
7855with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
7856to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
7857&[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
7858This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
7859with the IP address of the subject host.
7860
7861If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
7862lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
7863ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
7864temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
7865what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
7866
7867.next
7868.cindex "@ in a host list"
7869If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
7870domain name, as just described.
7871
7872.next
7873If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
7874subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
7875IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
7876be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
7877separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
7878without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
7879IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
7880that can never match a client host.
7881
7882.next
7883.cindex "@[] in a host list"
7884If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
7885the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
7886interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
7887.code
7888accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
7889accept hosts = @[]
7890.endd
7891.next
7892.cindex "CIDR notation"
7893If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
7894example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
7895host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
7896included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
7897specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
7898significant end of the address.
7899
7900&*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
7901of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
7902address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
7903addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
7904.code
7905192.168.23.236/31
7906.endd
7907matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
790832 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
7909matches.
7910
7911Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
7912.code
7913recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
7914 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
7915.endd
7916The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
7917appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
7918For example:
7919.code
7920recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
7921.endd
7922could make use of a file containing
7923.code
7924172.16.0.0/12
79253ffe:ffff:836f::/48
7926.endd
7927to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
7928addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
7929changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
7930.code
7931recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
7932 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
7933.endd
7934The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
7935list.
7936.endlist
7937
7938
7939
7940.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
7941 "SECThoslispatsikey"
7942.cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
7943When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
7944address, the pattern takes this form:
7945.display
7946&`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
7947.endd
7948For example:
7949.code
7950hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
7951.endd
7952The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
7953IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
7954letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
7955&(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
7956quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
7957returned by the lookup is not used.
7958
7959.cindex "IP address" "masking"
7960.cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
7961Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
7962patterns of this form:
7963.display
7964&`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
7965.endd
7966For example:
7967.code
7968net24-dbm;/networks.db
7969.endd
7970The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
7971length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
7972mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
7973is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
7974&"192.168.34.0/24"&.
7975
7976When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
7977of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
7978terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
7979to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
7980recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
7981(notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
7982For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
7983converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
7984addresses are always used.
7985
7986Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
7987colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
7988However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
7989configurations.
7990
7991&*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
7992IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
7993the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
7994case the IP address is used on its own.
7995
7996
7997
7998.section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
7999.cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8000.cindex "unknown host name"
8001.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8002There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8003remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8004complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8005address to match against, as described in the section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8006above.)
8007
8008If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8009patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8010Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8011DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8012Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8013effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8014Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8015
8016Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8017against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8018
8019By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8020if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8021&[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8022are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8023security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8024for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8025Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8026discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8027found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8028
8029There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8030found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8031
8032.cindex "host" "alias for"
8033.cindex "alias for host"
8034As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8035of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8036
8037.ilist
8038.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8039If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8040the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8041&'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8042requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8043expression.
8044.next
8045.cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8046.cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8047If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8048matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8049expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8050case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8051syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8052example,
8053.code
8054^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8055.endd
8056is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8057&'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8058that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8059string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8060part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8061.code
8062sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8063.endd
8064&*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8065&`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8066example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8067required.
8068.endlist
8069
8070
8071
8072
8073.section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8074.cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8075While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8076name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8077from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8078behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8079
8080&*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8081apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8082
8083.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8084.cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8085By default, Exim behaves as if the host does not match the list. This may not
8086always be what you want to happen. To change Exim's behaviour, the special
8087items &`+include_unknown`& or &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at
8088top level &-- they are not recognized in an indirected file).
8089
8090.ilist
8091If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8092cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8093.code
8094host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8095.endd
8096rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8097any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8098
8099.next
8100If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8101be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8102example:
8103.code
8104accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8105 192.168.4.5
8106.endd
8107accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8108whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8109name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8110.endlist
8111
8112Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8113list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8114list.
8115
8116
8117.section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8118 "SECTtemdnserr"
8119.cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8120.cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8121.cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8122A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8123&%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8124host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8125&`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8126section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8127host lists such as whitelists.
8128
8129
8130
8131.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8132 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8133.cindex "unknown host name"
8134.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8135If a pattern is of the form
8136.display
8137<&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8138.endd
8139for example
8140.code
8141dbm;/host/accept/list
8142.endd
8143a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8144lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8145is not used.
8146
8147&*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8148keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8149addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8150&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8151two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8152lookup, both using the same file.
8153
8154
8155
8156.section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8157If a pattern is of the form
8158.display
8159<&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8160.endd
8161the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8162data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8163&$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8164.code
8165hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8166 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8167.endd
8168The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8169can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8170use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8171operator.
8172
8173If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8174looks up the host name if has not already done so. (See section
8175&<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8176
8177Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8178host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8179&`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8180still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8181effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8182See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8183
8184
8185
8186.section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8187 "SECTmixwilhos"
8188.cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8189If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same
8190host list, you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, in an
8191ACL you could have:
8192.code
8193accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8194.endd
8195The reason for this lies in the left-to-right way that Exim processes lists.
8196It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an
8197item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to
8198compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8199&%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even if its
8200IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8201
8202If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8203address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8204.code
8205accept hosts = *.friend.example
8206accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8207.endd
8208If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8209&<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs.
8210
8211
8212
8213
8214
8215.section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8216.cindex "list" "address list"
8217.cindex "address list" "empty item"
8218.cindex "address list" "patterns"
8219Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8220is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8221always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8222list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8223using this option setting:
8224.code
8225senders = :
8226.endd
8227The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8228data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8229detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8230and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8231
8232Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8233example:
8234.code
8235senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8236.endd
8237A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8238character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8239semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8240subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8241with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8242the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8243wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8244.code
8245deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8246 *@+hostile_domains:\
8247 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8248 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8249.endd
8250.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8251.cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8252If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8253specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8254treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8255
8256If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8257contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8258address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8259domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8260is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8261.code
8262deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8263.endd
8264
8265The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8266address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8267senders:
8268
8269.ilist
8270.cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8271.cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8272If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8273done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8274You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8275as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8276to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8277.code
8278deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8279 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8280.endd
8281The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8282start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8283
8284.next
8285.cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8286Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8287lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8288example:
8289.code
8290deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8291 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8292 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8293.endd
8294Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8295lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8296not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8297always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8298
8299Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8300cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8301panic log.
8302.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8303However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8304&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8305default. For example, with this lookup:
8306.code
8307accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8308.endd
8309the file could contains lines like this:
8310.code
8311user1@domain1.example
8312*@domain2.example
8313.endd
8314and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8315that are tried is:
8316.code
8317nimrod@jaeger.example
8318*@jaeger.example
8319*
8320.endd
8321&*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8322would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8323
8324&*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8325.code
8326deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8327deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8328.endd
8329The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8330because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8331domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8332.endlist
8333
8334
8335The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8336If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8337always fails.
8338
8339
8340.ilist
8341.cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8342.cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8343.cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8344If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8345(for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8346split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8347it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8348from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8349of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8350
8351.cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8352The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8353keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8354patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8355even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8356with
8357.code
8358deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8359.endd
8360the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8361.code
8362baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8363.endd
8364to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8365
8366.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8367If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8368has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8369may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8370but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8371surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8372.code
8373aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8374spammer3 : spammer4
8375.endd
8376As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8377doubling.
8378
8379If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8380of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8381list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8382might have entries like
8383.code
8384aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8385xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8386*: ^\d{8}$
8387.endd
8388in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8389local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8390each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8391chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8392
8393.cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8394It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8395them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8396
8397.next
8398The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8399lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8400can only return a single list of local parts.
8401.endlist
8402
8403&*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8404in these two examples:
8405.code
8406senders = +my_list
8407senders = *@+my_list
8408.endd
8409In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8410example it is a named domain list.
8411
8412
8413
8414
8415.section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8416.cindex "case of local parts"
8417.cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8418.cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8419Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8420case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8421Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8422Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8423blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8424lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8425default.
8426
8427The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8428address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8429comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8430the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8431that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8432keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8433works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8434case-independent.
8435
8436.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8437To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8438an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8439part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8440longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8441lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8442performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8443become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8444
8445
8446
8447.section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8448.cindex "list" "local part list"
8449.cindex "local part" "list"
8450Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8451lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8452setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8453set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8454case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8455matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8456&%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8457option is case-sensitive from the start.
8458
8459If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8460comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8461only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8462Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8463that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8464&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8465Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8466types.
8467.ecindex IIDdohoadli
8468
8469
8470
8471
8472. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8473. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8474
8475.chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8476.scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8477Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8478them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8479
8480When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8481when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8482start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8483below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8484escape character, as described in the following section.
8485
8486
8487
8488.section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8489.cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8490An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8491backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8492character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8493If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8494required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8495the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8496
8497.cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8498A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8499two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8500expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8501.code
8502deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8503.endd
8504On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8505without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8506string.
8507
8508
8509
8510.section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8511.cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8512A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8513expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8514carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8515octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8516backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8517encoding.
8518
8519These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8520in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8521and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8522
8523
8524.section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8525.cindex "expansion" "testing"
8526.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8527.oindex "&%-be%&"
8528Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8529takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8530arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8531to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8532since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8533value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8534database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8535and &%nhash%&.
8536
8537Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8538instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8539using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8540
8541.oindex "&%-bem%&"
8542If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8543from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8544option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8545read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8546.code
8547exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8548.endd
8549The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8550Exim message identifier. For example:
8551.code
8552exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8553.endd
8554This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8555is therefore restricted to admin users.
8556
8557
8558.section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8559.cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8560A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8561alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8562(which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8563used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8564instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8565the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8566that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8567its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8568from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8569taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8570being expanded.
8571
8572
8573
8574
8575.section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8576The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8577between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8578outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8579white space is significant.
8580
8581.vlist
8582.vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8583.cindex "expansion" "variables"
8584Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8585.code
8586$local_part
8587${domain}
8588.endd
8589The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8590characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8591&'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8592section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8593given, the expansion fails.
8594
8595.vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8596.cindex "expansion" "operators"
8597The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8598<&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8599.code
8600${lc:$local_part}
8601.endd
8602The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8603leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8604below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8605one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8606string easier to understand.
8607
8608.vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8609This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8610expansion item below.
8611
8612.vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
8613 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8614.cindex &%dlfunc%&
8615This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
8616This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
8617.code
8618EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
8619.endd
8620set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
8621object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
8622(but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
8623
8624There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
8625a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
8626included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
8627are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
8628must have the following type:
8629.code
8630int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
8631.endd
8632Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
8633function should return one of the following values:
8634
8635&`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
8636into the expanded string that is being built.
8637
8638&`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
8639from &'yield'&, if it is set.
8640
8641&`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
8642taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
8643
8644&`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
8645
8646When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
8647you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
8648configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
8649
8650.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
8651 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8652.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
8653.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
8654The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
8655white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
8656must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
8657form:
8658.display
8659<&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
8660.endd
8661.vindex "&$value$&"
8662where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
8663values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
8664values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
8665described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
8666for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
8667the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8668otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8669variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8670is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8671
8672If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8673key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8674extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
8675yield &"2001"&:
8676.code
8677${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
8678${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
8679.endd
8680Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
8681appear, for example:
8682.code
8683${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
8684.endd
8685This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
8686{<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
8687
8688
8689.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
8690 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8691.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
8692.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
8693The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
8694apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
8695This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
8696behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
8697extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
8698argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
8699<&'string3'&> as before.
8700
8701The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
8702separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
8703The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
8704counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
8705number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
8706number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
8707expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
8708provided. For example:
8709.code
8710${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8711.endd
8712yields &"42"&, and
8713.code
8714${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8715.endd
8716yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
8717empty (for example, the fifth field above).
8718
8719
8720.vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
8721.cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
8722.cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
8723.vindex "&$item$&"
8724After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8725default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8726in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
8727evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
8728item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
8729separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
8730input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
8731.code
8732${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
8733.endd
8734yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
8735to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8736
8737
8738.vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8739.cindex "hash function" "textual"
8740.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
8741This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
8742early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
8743(numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
8744
8745The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
8746<&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8747<&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
8748use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8749.code
8750${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8751.endd
8752The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
8753or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
8754Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
8755function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
8756first <&'m'&> characters of the string
8757.code
8758abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
8759.endd
8760If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
8761letters appear. For example:
8762.display
8763&`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
8764&`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
8765&`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
8766.endd
8767
8768.vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8769 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8770 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8771 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8772 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8773 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
8774.cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
8775.vindex "&$header_$&"
8776.vindex "&$bheader_$&"
8777.vindex "&$rheader_$&"
8778.cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
8779.cindex "header lines" "character sets"
8780.cindex "header lines" "decoding"
8781Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
8782.code
8783$header_reply-to:
8784.endd
8785The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
8786internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
8787lines) may be present.
8788
8789The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
8790the data in the header line is interpreted.
8791
8792.ilist
8793.cindex "white space" "in header lines"
8794&%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
8795processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
8796
8797.next
8798.cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
8799&%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
8800or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
8801character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
8802&"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
8803.cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
8804produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
8805what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
8806
8807.next
8808&%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
8809standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
8810be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
8811returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
8812&[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
8813a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
8814.endlist ilist
8815
8816In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
8817command of the following form:
8818.code
8819headers charset "UTF-8"
8820.endd
8821This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
8822subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
8823character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
8824option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
8825value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
8826ISO-8859-1.
8827
8828Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
8829any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
8830&'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
8831if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
8832
8833Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
8834this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
8835message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
8836filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
8837router or transport are not accessible.
8838
8839For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
8840before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
8841message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
8842are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
8843point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
8844by earlier ACLs are visible.
8845
8846Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
8847following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
8848this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
8849white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
8850If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
8851replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
8852&<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
8853
8854If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
8855to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
8856&%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
8857each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
8858newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
8859newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
8860those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
8861junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
8862
8863
8864.vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
8865.cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
8866.cindex &%hmac%&
8867This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
8868shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
8869RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
8870&`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
8871cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
8872or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
8873present. For example:
8874.code
8875${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
8876.endd
8877For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
8878produces:
8879.code
8880dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
8881.endd
8882As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
8883an Exim configuration:
8884.code
8885SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
8886.endd
8887In a router or a transport you could then have:
8888.code
8889headers_add = \
8890 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
8891 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
8892 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
8893.endd
8894Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
8895&'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
8896this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
8897host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
8898using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
8899&'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
8900
8901
8902.vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8903.cindex "expansion" "conditional"
8904.cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
8905If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
8906item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
8907in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
8908.code
8909${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
8910.endd
8911The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
8912true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
8913be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
8914case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
8915&<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
8916
8917If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
8918is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
8919cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
8920.code
8921condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
8922.endd
8923you can use
8924.code
8925condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
8926.endd
8927
8928.vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8929.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
8930.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
8931The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
8932strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
8933you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
8934change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
8935some of the braces:
8936.code
8937${length_<n>:<string>}
8938.endd
8939The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
8940of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
8941&%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
8942
8943
8944.vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
8945 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
8946This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
8947described in the next item.
8948
8949.vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
8950 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
8951.cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
8952.cindex "file" "lookups"
8953.cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
8954The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
8955discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
8956lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
8957<&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
8958
8959If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
8960a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
8961other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
8962in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
8963out by the system administrator.
8964
8965.vindex "&$value$&"
8966If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
8967During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
8968lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
8969level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
8970the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
8971string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
8972lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
8973original lookup fails.
8974
8975If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
8976data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
8977expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
8978the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
8979appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
8980to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
8981{<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
8982successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
8983
8984For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
8985search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
8986type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
8987&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
8988
8989.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
8990If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
8991and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
8992They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
8993
8994This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
8995.code
8996${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
8997.endd
8998This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
8999the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9000.code
9001${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9002 {$value}fail}
9003.endd
9004
9005
9006.vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9007.cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9008.vindex "&$item$&"
9009After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9010default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9011in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9012expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9013for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9014setting is not included in the output. For example:
9015.code
9016${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9017.endd
9018expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9019value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9020and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9021
9022.vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9023.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9024.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9025The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9026<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9027if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9028can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9029.code
9030${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9031.endd
9032The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9033the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9034processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9035slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9036example,
9037.code
9038${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9039.endd
9040returns the string &"6/33"&.
9041
9042
9043
9044.vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9045.cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9046.cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9047This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9048interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9049expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9050additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9051name of the subroutine, is nine.
9052
9053The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9054the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9055way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9056Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9057return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9058not its contents.
9059
9060If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9061with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9062Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9063
9064The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9065out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9066
9067
9068.vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9069.cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9070The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9071keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9072it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9073to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9074as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9075and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9076
9077.vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9078 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9079.cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9080This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9081checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9082yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9083empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9084prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9085version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9086variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9087
9088These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9089retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9090against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9091which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9092
9093The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9094string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9095result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9096whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9097is the expansion of the third argument.
9098
9099All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9100However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9101For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9102
9103.vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9104.cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9105.cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9106.cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9107The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9108then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9109the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9110newlines are left in the string.
9111String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9112you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9113the string expansion fails.
9114
9115The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9116locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9117
9118
9119
9120.vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9121 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9122.cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9123.cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9124.cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9125This item inserts data from a Unix domain or Internet socket into the expanded
9126string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9127examples:
9128.code
9129${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9130${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9131.endd
9132For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9133For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9134a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9135number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9136optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9137example:
9138.code
9139${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9140.endd
9141Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9142one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9143both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9144(unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9145is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9146extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9147.code
9148${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9149.endd
9150A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9151that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9152turns them into spaces:
9153.code
9154${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9155.endd
9156As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9157happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9158addition, the following errors can occur:
9159
9160.ilist
9161Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9162.next
9163Failure to connect the socket;
9164.next
9165Failure to write the request string;
9166.next
9167Timeout on reading from the socket.
9168.endlist
9169
9170By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9171you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9172errors occurs. For example:
9173.code
9174${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9175 {socket failure}}
9176.endd
9177You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9178expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9179and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9180if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9181non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9182
9183The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9184locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9185
9186
9187.vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9188.cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9189.cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9190.vindex "&$value$&"
9191.vindex "&$item$&"
9192This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9193<&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9194separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9195assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9196list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9197them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9198iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9199added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9200number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9201.code
9202${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9203.endd
9204The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9205can be found:
9206.code
9207${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9208.endd
9209At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9210restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9211expansion items.
9212
9213.vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9214This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9215expansion item above.
9216
9217.vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9218 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9219.cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9220.cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9221The command and its arguments are first expanded separately, and then the
9222command is run in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in
9223other command executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If you want
9224a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9225
9226The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9227and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9228.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9229.vindex "&$value$&"
9230If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9231and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9232from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9233<&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9234expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9235&$value$&.
9236
9237If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9238can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9239command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9240of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9241
9242.vindex "&$runrc$&"
9243The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9244remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9245.code
9246if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9247 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9248 ...
9249endif
9250.endd
9251If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9252the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9253commands.
9254
9255&*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9256option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9257testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9258by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9259
9260The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9261out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9262
9263
9264.vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9265.cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9266.cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9267This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9268option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9269modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9270into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9271a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9272.code
9273${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9274.endd
9275yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9276if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9277substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9278.code
9279${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9280.endd
9281yields &"defabc"&, and
9282.code
9283${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9284.endd
9285yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9286the regular expression from string expansion.
9287
9288
9289
9290.vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9291.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9292.cindex "substring extraction"
9293.cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9294The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9295<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9296if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9297can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9298.code
9299${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9300.endd
9301The second number is optional (in both notations).
9302If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9303omitted.
9304
9305The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9306&%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9307length required. For example
9308.code
9309${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9310.endd
9311If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9312null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9313length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9314given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9315
9316The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9317from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9318second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9319.code
9320${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9321.endd
9322yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9323length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9324the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9325.code
9326${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9327.endd
9328yields an empty string, but
9329.code
9330${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9331.endd
9332yields &"1"&.
9333
9334When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9335is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9336string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9337no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9338.code
9339${substr_-1:abcde}
9340${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9341.endd
9342yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9343
9344
9345
9346.vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9347 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9348.cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9349.cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9350This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9351argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9352matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9353replacement list. For example
9354.code
9355${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9356.endd
9357yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9358last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9359last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9360place.
9361.endlist
9362
9363
9364
9365.section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9366.cindex "expansion" "operators"
9367For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9368the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9369The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9370following operations can be performed:
9371
9372.vlist
9373.vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9374.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9375.cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9376The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9377header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9378not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9379
9380
9381.vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9382.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9383.cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9384The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
93852822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9386operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9387result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9388doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9389Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9390
9391It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9392separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9393character. For example:
9394.code
9395${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9396.endd
9397expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9398expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9399address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9400processing lists.
9401
9402
9403.vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9404.cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9405.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9406The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9407base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9408the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9409its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9410names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9411be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9412
9413.vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9414.cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9415.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9416The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9417environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9418identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9419string.
9420
9421.vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9422.cindex "domain" "extraction"
9423.cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9424The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9425from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9426
9427
9428.vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9429.cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9430.cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9431If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9432escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9433significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9434is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9435
9436
9437.vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9438.cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9439.cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9440.cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9441These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9442expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9443arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9444logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9445integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9446C programming language):
9447.table2 70pt 300pt
9448.irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9449.irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9450.irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9451.irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9452.irow "" "and (&&)"
9453.irow "" "xor (^)"
9454.irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9455.endtable
9456Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9457space is permitted before or after operators.
9458
9459For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9460hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9461decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9462permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9463times, which often do have leading zeros.
9464
9465A number may be followed by &"K"& or &"M"& to multiply it by 1024 or 1024*1024,
9466respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
9467a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"& or &"M"&). For example:
9468
9469.display
9470&`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
9471&`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
9472&`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
9473&`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
9474&`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
9475&`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
9476&`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
9477&`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
9478&`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
9479&`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
9480&`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
9481.endd
9482
9483As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
9484.code
9485deny message = Too many bad recipients
9486 condition = \
9487 ${if and { \
9488 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
9489 { \
9490 < \
9491 {$recipients_count} \
9492 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
9493 } \
9494 }{yes}{no}}
9495.endd
9496The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
9497fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
9498
9499
9500.vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9501.cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
9502The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
9503example,
9504.code
9505${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
9506.endd
9507first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
9508and then re-expands what it has found.
9509
9510
9511.vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9512.cindex "Unicode"
9513.cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
9514.cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
9515.cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
9516The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
9517email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
9518to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
9519UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
9520converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
9521the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
9522
9523Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
9524ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
9525For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
9526way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
9527characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
9528single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
9529translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
9530
9531
9532.vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9533.cindex "hash function" "textual"
9534.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9535The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
9536be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
9537change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9538.code
9539${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9540.endd
9541See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
9542abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
9543
9544
9545
9546.vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
9547.cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
9548.cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
9549.cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
9550This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
9551be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
9552
9553
9554.vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9555.cindex "case forcing in strings"
9556.cindex "string" "case forcing"
9557.cindex "lower casing"
9558.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9559.cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
9560This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
9561.code
9562${lc:$local_part}
9563.endd
9564
9565.vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9566.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9567.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9568The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
9569can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
9570changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
9571.code
9572${length{<number>}{<string>}}
9573.endd
9574See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
9575&%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
9576when &%length%& is used as an operator.
9577
9578
9579.vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9580.cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
9581.cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
9582The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
9583extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
9584empty.
9585
9586
9587.vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
9588.cindex "masked IP address"
9589.cindex "IP address" "masking"
9590.cindex "CIDR notation"
9591.cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
9592.cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
9593If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
9594slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
9595expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
9596masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
9597the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
9598.code
9599${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
9600.endd
9601returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
9602be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
9603address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
9604terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
9605.code
9606${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
9607.endd
9608returns the string
9609.code
96103ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
9611.endd
9612Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
9613
9614
9615.vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9616.cindex "MD5 hash"
9617.cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
9618.cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
9619The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
9620as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
9621
9622
9623.vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9624.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9625.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9626The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
9627that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
9628strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9629.code
9630${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9631.endd
9632See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
9633
9634
9635.vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9636.cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
9637.cindex "expansion" "quoting"
9638.cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
9639The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
9640is an empty string or
9641contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
9642Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
9643Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
9644respectively For example,
9645.code
9646${quote:ab"*"cd}
9647.endd
9648becomes
9649.code
9650"ab\"*\"cd"
9651.endd
9652The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
9653variable or a message header.
9654
9655.vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9656.cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
9657This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
9658required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
9659example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
9660If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
9661(or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
9662
9663
9664.vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9665.cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
9666This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
9667query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
9668the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
9669.code
9670${quote_ldap:two * two}
9671.endd
9672returns
9673.code
9674two%20%5C2A%20two
9675.endd
9676For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
9677yields an unchanged string.
9678
9679
9680.vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
9681.cindex "random number"
9682This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
9683supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
9684on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
9685If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
9686Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
9687srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
9688random().
9689
9690
9691.vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
9692.cindex "expansion" "IP address"
9693This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
9694dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addreses the result is in
9695dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
9696for DNS. For example,
9697.code
9698${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4} and ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.3}
9699.endd
9700returns
9701.code
97024.2.0.192 and 3.0.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
9703.endd
9704
9705
9706.vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9707.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9708.cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
9709.cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
9710This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
9711encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
9712assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
9713&%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
9714contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
9715characters
9716.code
9717? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
9718.endd
9719it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
9720string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
9721characters.
9722
9723
9724.vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9725.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9726.cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
9727.cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
9728This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
9729bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
9730character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
9731not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
9732
9733&*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
9734access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
9735to use this operator as well.
9736
9737
9738
9739.vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9740.cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
9741.cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
9742.cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
9743The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
9744characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
9745variables or headers inside regular expressions.
9746
9747
9748.vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9749.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9750.cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
9751.cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
9752The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
9753it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
9754
9755
9756.vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9757.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
9758.cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
9759.cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
9760The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
9761function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
9762expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
9763series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
9764except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
9765a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
976610-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
9767&"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
9768can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
9769
9770The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
9771the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
9772systems for files larger than 2GB.
9773
9774.vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9775.cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
9776.cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
9777.cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
9778This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
9779
9780
9781
9782.vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9783.cindex "expansion" "string length"
9784.cindex "string" "length in expansion"
9785.cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
9786The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
9787decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
9788
9789
9790.vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9791.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9792.cindex "substring extraction"
9793.cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
9794The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
9795can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
9796that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9797.code
9798${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
9799.endd
9800See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
9801abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
9802
9803.vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9804.cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
9805.cindex "time interval" "decoding"
9806This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
9807seconds.
9808
9809.vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9810.cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
9811.cindex "time interval" "formatting"
9812The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
9813represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
9814number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
9815&`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
9816
9817.vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9818.cindex "case forcing in strings"
9819.cindex "string" "case forcing"
9820.cindex "upper casing"
9821.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9822.cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
9823This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
9824.endlist
9825
9826
9827
9828
9829
9830
9831.section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
9832.scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
9833The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
9834while expanding strings:
9835
9836.vlist
9837.vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
9838.cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
9839.cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
9840Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
9841condition.
9842
9843.vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9844.cindex "numeric comparison"
9845.cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
9846There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
9847are:
9848.display
9849&`= `& equal
9850&`== `& equal
9851&`> `& greater
9852&`>= `& greater or equal
9853&`< `& less
9854&`<= `& less or equal
9855.endd
9856For example:
9857.code
9858${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
9859.endd
9860Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
9861two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
9862optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"& or &"M"& (in either upper or
9863lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024 or 1024*1024, respectively.
9864As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
9865zero.
9866
9867
9868.vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9869.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
9870.cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
9871This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
9872a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
9873(case-insensitively); also positive integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
9874false if zero. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
9875All other string values will result in expansion failure.
9876
9877When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
9878make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
9879For example:
9880.code
9881${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
9882.endd
9883
9884
9885.vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9886.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
9887.cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
9888Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
9889where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
9890loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
9891and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
9892true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
9893
9894Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
9895
9896.vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9897.cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
9898.cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
9899.cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
9900This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
9901authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
9902necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
9903included in the binary.
9904
9905The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
9906compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
9907be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
9908encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
9909does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
9910&[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
9911Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
9912string in LDAP form is:
9913.code
9914{md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
9915.endd
9916If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
9917be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
9918.code
9919${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
9920.endd
9921The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
9922supported:
9923
9924.ilist
9925.cindex "MD5 hash"
9926.cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
9927&%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
9928printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
9929length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
9930(as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
9931hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
9932comparison fails.
9933
9934.next
9935.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9936&%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
9937printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
9938length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
9939If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
9940SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
9941
9942.next
9943.cindex "&[crypt()]&"
9944&%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
9945only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
9946systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
9947whatever its length.
9948
9949.next
9950.cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
9951&%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
9952use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
9953modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
9954.endlist
9955Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
9956&[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
9957HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
9958operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
9959the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
9960support &[crypt16()]&.
9961
9962Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
9963it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
9964turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
9965&[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
9966algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
9967
9968However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
9969functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
9970Exim is seen as very low priority.
9971
9972If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
9973comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
9974determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
9975default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
9976function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
9977
9978.vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
9979.cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
9980.cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
9981The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
9982variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
9983variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
9984.code
9985${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
9986.endd
9987Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
9988variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
9989
9990.vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
9991 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9992.cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
9993This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
9994exists in the message. For example,
9995.code
9996${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
9997.endd
9998&*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
9999the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10000
10001.vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10002 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10003.cindex "string" "comparison"
10004.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10005.cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10006.cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10007The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10008resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10009letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10010
10011.vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10012.cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10013.cindex "file" "existence test"
10014.cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10015The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10016condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10017is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10018users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10019
10020.vitem &*first_delivery*&
10021.cindex "delivery" "first"
10022.cindex "first delivery"
10023.cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10024.cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10025This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10026attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10027
10028
10029.vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10030 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10031.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10032.cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10033.cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10034.vindex "&$item$&"
10035These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10036the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10037the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10038be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10039condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10040.ilist
10041For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10042the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10043items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10044.next
10045For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10046and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10047all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10048.endlist
10049Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10050items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10051that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10052list separator is changed to a comma:
10053.code
10054${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10055.endd
10056The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10057being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10058
10059
10060.vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10061 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10062.cindex "string" "comparison"
10063.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10064.cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10065.cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10066The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10067string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10068comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10069case-independent.
10070
10071.vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10072 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10073.cindex "string" "comparison"
10074.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10075.cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10076.cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10077The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10078string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10079includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10080case-independent.
10081
10082.vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10083 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10084 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10085.cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10086.cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10087.cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10088.cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10089.cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10090The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10091an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10092&%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10093
10094For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10095which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10096colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10097hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10098component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10099
10100&*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10101values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10102check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10103host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10104.code
10105${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10106.endd
10107to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10108
10109.vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10110.cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10111.cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10112.cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10113This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10114&<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10115queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10116query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10117password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10118server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10119with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10120will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10121of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10122this can be used.
10123
10124
10125.vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10126 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10127.cindex "string" "comparison"
10128.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10129.cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10130.cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10131The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10132string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10133comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10134case-independent.
10135
10136.vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10137 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10138.cindex "string" "comparison"
10139.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10140.cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10141.cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10142The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10143string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10144includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10145case-independent.
10146
10147
10148.vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10149.cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10150.cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10151.cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10152The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10153expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10154regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10155escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10156(curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10157premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10158&`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10159For example,
10160.code
10161${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10162.endd
10163If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10164backslashes is also required.
10165
10166The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10167The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10168metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10169and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10170the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10171metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10172
10173.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10174At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10175substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10176succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10177will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10178of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10179combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10180variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10181
10182.vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10183.cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10184See &*match_local_part*&.
10185
10186.vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10187.cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10188See &*match_local_part*&.
10189
10190.vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10191.cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10192This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10193be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10194address or an empty string. The second (after expansion) is a restricted host
10195list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10196.code
10197${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10198.endd
10199The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10200
10201.ilist
10202An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10203.next
10204A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10205.next
10206An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10207useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10208in a single test such as
10209. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10210. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10211. ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10212. ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10213.code
10214 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10215.endd
10216where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10217.next
10218The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10219.next
10220Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10221even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10222address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10223&*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10224masks. For example:
10225.code
10226 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10227.endd
10228It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10229do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10230address mask, for example:
10231.code
10232 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10233.endd
10234However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10235just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10236.code
10237 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10238.endd
10239.endlist ilist
10240
10241Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10242
10243.vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10244.cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10245.cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10246.cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10247.cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10248This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10249possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10250condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10251example is:
10252.code
10253${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10254.endd
10255In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10256list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10257expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10258Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10259.code
10260${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10261.endd
10262.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10263For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10264item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10265have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10266caselessly.
10267
10268&*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10269hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10270how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10271matched using &%match_ip%&.
10272
10273.vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10274.cindex "PAM authentication"
10275.cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10276.cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10277.cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10278.cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10279&'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10280(&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10281available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10282distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10283the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10284.code
10285SUPPORT_PAM=yes
10286.endd
10287in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10288in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10289
10290The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10291colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10292The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10293taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10294The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10295from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10296request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10297
10298There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10299characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10300separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10301item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10302of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10303.code
10304server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10305.endd
10306For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10307.code
10308server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10309.endd
10310In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10311running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10312messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10313A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10314Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10315The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10316to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10317group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10318
10319
10320.vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10321.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10322.cindex "Cyrus"
10323.cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10324.cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10325This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10326This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10327that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10328deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10329
10330The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10331the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10332building Exim. For example:
10333.code
10334CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10335.endd
10336You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10337the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10338from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10339access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10340
10341The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10342password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10343configuration, you might have this:
10344.code
10345server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10346.endd
10347Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
10348.code
10349server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
10350.endd
10351.vitem &*queue_running*&
10352.cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10353.cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10354.cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10355This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10356initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10357
10358
10359.vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10360.cindex "Radius"
10361.cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10362.cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10363Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
10364set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
10365the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
10366support.
10367
10368With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
10369library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
10370this library, you need to set
10371.code
10372RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
10373.endd
10374in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
10375&%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
10376.code
10377RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
10378.endd
10379in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
10380You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
10381Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
10382
10383The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
10384Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
10385the authentication is successful. For example:
10386.code
10387server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
10388.endd
10389
10390
10391.vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
10392 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
10393.cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
10394.cindex "Cyrus"
10395.cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
10396.cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
10397This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
10398daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
10399Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
10400by a process that is not running as root.
10401
10402The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10403the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10404building Exim. For example:
10405.code
10406CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
10407.endd
10408You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10409the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10410from the Cyrus SASL library.
10411
10412Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
10413two are mandatory. For example:
10414.code
10415server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
10416.endd
10417The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
10418in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
10419realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
10420.endlist vlist
10421
10422
10423
10424.section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
10425.cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
10426Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
10427and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
10428conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
10429sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
10430the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
10431
10432
10433.vlist
10434.vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10435.cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
10436.cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
10437The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10438any one of the sub-conditions is true.
10439For example,
10440.code
10441${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
10442.endd
10443When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
10444evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
10445numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
10446
10447.vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10448.cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
10449.cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
10450The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10451all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
10452sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
10453the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
10454parsed but not evaluated.
10455.endlist
10456.ecindex IIDexpcond
10457
10458
10459
10460
10461.section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
10462.cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
10463This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
10464of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
10465support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
10466
10467.vlist
10468.vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
10469.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
10470When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
10471captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
10472processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
10473However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
10474values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
10475variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
10476precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
10477Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
10478matching condition.
10479
10480.vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
10481Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
10482can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
10483long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
10484example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
10485variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
10486used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
10487same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
10488with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
10489during subsequent delivery.
10490
10491.vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
10492These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
10493are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
10494received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
10495message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
10496also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
10497message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
10498and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
10499delivery.
10500
10501.vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
10502.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
10503After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
10504message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
10505be preserved by coding like this:
10506.code
10507warn !verify = sender
10508 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
10509.endd
10510You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
10511&%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
10512failure.
10513
10514.vitem &$address_data$&
10515.vindex "&$address_data$&"
10516This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
10517value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
10518and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
10519the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
10520for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
10521user filter files.
10522
10523If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
10524a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
10525conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
10526to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
10527of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
10528from the child's routing.
10529
10530If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
10531sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
10532&$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
10533address.
10534
10535In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
10536after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
10537these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
10538
10539.vitem &$address_file$&
10540.vindex "&$address_file$&"
10541When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
10542to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
10543is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
10544default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
10545.code
10546/home/r2d2/savemail
10547.endd
10548then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
10549contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
10550.cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
10551For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
10552then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
10553to the relevant file.
10554
10555.vitem &$address_pipe$&
10556.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
10557When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
10558this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
10559
10560.vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
10561.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
10562These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
10563&<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
10564
10565.vitem &$authenticated_id$&
10566.cindex "authentication" "id"
10567.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
10568When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
10569preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
10570&$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
10571user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
10572in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
10573&$sender_host_authenticated$&.
10574When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
10575the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
10576process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
10577command line option.
10578
10579
10580
10581
10582.vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
10583.cindex "sender" "authenticated"
10584.cindex "authentication" "sender"
10585.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
10586.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
10587When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
10588SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
10589described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
10590&"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
10591available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
10592sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
10593
10594.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
10595When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
10596value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
10597name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
10598can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
10599
10600
10601.vitem &$authentication_failed$&
10602.cindex "authentication" "failure"
10603.vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
10604This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
10605command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
10606possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
10607(&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
10608&"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
10609is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
10610negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
10611an undefined mechanism.
10612
10613.new
10614.vitem &$av_failed$&
10615.cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
10616This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
10617extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
10618problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
10619the ACL malware condition.
10620.wen
10621
10622.vitem &$body_linecount$&
10623.cindex "message body" "line count"
10624.cindex "body of message" "line count"
10625.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
10626When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10627number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
10628
10629.vitem &$body_zerocount$&
10630.cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
10631.cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
10632.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10633.vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
10634When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10635number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
10636
10637.vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
10638.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
10639This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
10640it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
10641chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10642
10643.vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
10644.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
10645This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
10646up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
10647file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10648
10649.vitem &$caller_gid$&
10650.cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
10651.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
10652The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10653not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
10654&$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10655incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
10656
10657.vitem &$caller_uid$&
10658.cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
10659.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
10660The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10661not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
10662&$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10663incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
10664
10665.vitem &$compile_date$&
10666.vindex "&$compile_date$&"
10667The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
10668
10669.vitem &$compile_number$&
10670.vindex "&$compile_number$&"
10671The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
10672of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
10673compilations of the same version of the program.
10674
10675.vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
10676.vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
10677This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
10678the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
10679details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10680
10681.vitem &$demime_reason$&
10682.vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
10683This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10684content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10685see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10686
10687.vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
10688 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
10689 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
10690 &$dnslist_value$&
10691.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
10692.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
10693.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
10694.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
10695.cindex "black list (DNS)"
10696When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
10697the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
10698looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
10699main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
10700
10701.vitem &$domain$&
10702.vindex "&$domain$&"
10703When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
10704contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
10705case for &$domain$&.
10706
10707Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
10708&$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
10709is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
10710message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
10711
10712When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
10713RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
10714have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
10715at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
10716the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
10717which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
10718
10719.oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
10720At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
10721set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
10722
10723The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
10724
10725.ilist
10726When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
10727the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
10728&$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
10729normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
10730is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
10731&$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
10732the &(smtp)& transport.
10733
10734.next
10735When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
10736&$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
10737it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
10738rewrite domains by file lookup.
10739
10740.next
10741With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
10742&$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
10743a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
10744is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
10745that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
10746recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
10747
10748.next
10749.cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
10750.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
10751When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
10752the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
10753.endlist
10754
10755
10756.vitem &$domain_data$&
10757.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
10758When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
10759means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
10760of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
10761address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
10762transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
10763used.
10764
10765&$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
10766domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
10767the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
10768to nothing.
10769
10770.vitem &$exim_gid$&
10771.vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
10772This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
10773
10774.vitem &$exim_path$&
10775.vindex "&$exim_path$&"
10776This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
10777
10778.vitem &$exim_uid$&
10779.vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
10780This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
10781
10782.vitem &$found_extension$&
10783.vindex "&$found_extension$&"
10784This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10785content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10786see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10787
10788.vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
10789This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
10790inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
10791be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
10792characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
10793
10794.vitem &$home$&
10795.vindex "&$home$&"
10796When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
10797directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
10798means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
10799explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
10800by a setting on the transport itself.
10801
10802When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
10803of the environment variable HOME.
10804
10805.vitem &$host$&
10806.vindex "&$host$&"
10807If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
10808list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
10809to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
10810to local and remote transports.
10811
10812.cindex "transport" "filter"
10813.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
10814For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
10815&$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
10816particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
10817using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
10818&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
10819is connected.
10820
10821When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
10822&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
10823client is connected.
10824
10825
10826.vitem &$host_address$&
10827.vindex "&$host_address$&"
10828This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
10829for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
10830when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
10831
10832.vitem &$host_data$&
10833.vindex "&$host_data$&"
10834If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
10835result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
10836allows you, for example, to do things like this:
10837.code
10838deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
10839message = $host_data
10840.endd
10841.vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
10842.cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
10843.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
10844This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
10845message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
10846name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
10847variables is set to &"1"&.
10848
10849.ilist
10850If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
10851succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
10852
10853.next
10854If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
10855tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
10856lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
10857.endlist ilist
10858
10859Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
10860single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
10861names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
10862is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
10863&$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
10864IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
10865sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
10866lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
10867the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
10868&"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
10869
10870.vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
10871.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
10872See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
10873
10874
10875.vitem &$inode$&
10876.vindex "&$inode$&"
10877The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
10878option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
10879of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
10880a unique name for the file.
10881
10882.vitem &$interface_address$&
10883.vindex "&$interface_address$&"
10884This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
10885
10886.vitem &$interface_port$&
10887.vindex "&$interface_port$&"
10888This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
10889
10890.vitem &$item$&
10891.vindex "&$item$&"
10892This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
10893conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
10894&*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
10895empty.
10896
10897.vitem &$ldap_dn$&
10898.vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
10899This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
10900contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
10901lookup.
10902
10903.vitem &$load_average$&
10904.vindex "&$load_average$&"
10905This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
10906is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
10907variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
10908
10909.vitem &$local_part$&
10910.vindex "&$local_part$&"
10911When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
10912variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
10913delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
10914session), &$local_part$& is not set.
10915
10916Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
10917&$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
10918&$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
10919because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
10920once.
10921
10922.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
10923.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
10924If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
10925value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
10926any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
10927&$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
10928
10929When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
10930result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
10931the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
10932&$address_pipe$&).
10933
10934When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
10935local part of the recipient address.
10936
10937When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
10938&$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
10939it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
10940
10941In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
10942the addresses
10943.code
10944"abc:xyz"@test.example
10945abc\:xyz@test.example
10946.endd
10947the value of &$local_part$& is
10948.code
10949abc:xyz
10950.endd
10951If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
10952inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
10953have:
10954.code
10955data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
10956.endd
10957&*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
10958to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
10959&%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
10960
10961.vitem &$local_part_data$&
10962.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
10963When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
10964lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
10965router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
10966to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
10967handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
10968
10969&$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
10970matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
10971available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
10972variable expands to nothing.
10973
10974.vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
10975.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
10976When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
10977specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
10978variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
10979
10980.vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
10981.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
10982When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
10983specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
10984variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
10985
10986.vitem &$local_scan_data$&
10987.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
10988This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
10989a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
10990
10991.vitem &$local_user_gid$&
10992.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
10993See &$local_user_uid$&.
10994
10995.vitem &$local_user_uid$&
10996.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
10997This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
10998&%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
10999are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11000and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11001router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11002are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11003
11004.vitem &$localhost_number$&
11005.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11006This contains the expanded value of the
11007&%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11008been read.
11009
11010.vitem &$log_inodes$&
11011.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11012The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11013log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11014referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11015the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11016
11017.vitem &$log_space$&
11018.vindex "&$log_space$&"
11019The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11020partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11021whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11022ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11023the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11024
11025
11026.vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11027.vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11028This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11029&(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11030&%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11031contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11032without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11033variable is empty.
11034
11035.vitem &$malware_name$&
11036.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11037This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11038content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11039when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11040
11041.vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11042.vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11043.cindex "maximum" "line length"
11044.cindex "line length" "maximum"
11045This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11046received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11047character(s).
11048
11049.vitem &$message_age$&
11050.cindex "message" "age of"
11051.vindex "&$message_age$&"
11052This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11053of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11054delivery attempt.
11055
11056.vitem &$message_body$&
11057.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11058.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11059.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11060.vindex "&$message_body$&"
11061.oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11062This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11063being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11064number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11065&%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11066
11067.oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11068By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11069easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11070this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11071zeros are always converted into spaces.
11072
11073.vitem &$message_body_end$&
11074.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11075.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11076.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11077This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11078body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11079&$message_body$&.
11080
11081.vitem &$message_body_size$&
11082.cindex "body of message" "size"
11083.cindex "message body" "size"
11084.vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11085When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11086in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11087separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11088also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11089
11090.vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11091.vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11092When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11093unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11094An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11095received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11096line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11097&`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11098
11099.vitem &$message_headers$&
11100.vindex &$message_headers$&
11101This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11102is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11103lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11104same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11105
11106.vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11107.vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11108This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11109contents of header lines is done.
11110
11111.vitem &$message_id$&
11112This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&, which is now deprecated.
11113
11114.vitem &$message_linecount$&
11115.vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11116This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11117message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11118During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11119number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11120routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11121&'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11122lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11123from the body is not counted.
11124
11125As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11126appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11127&$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11128file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11129header and the body).
11130
11131Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11132.code
11133deny message = Too many lines in message header
11134 condition = \
11135 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11136.endd
11137In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11138message has not yet been received.
11139
11140.vitem &$message_size$&
11141.cindex "size" "of message"
11142.cindex "message" "size"
11143.vindex "&$message_size$&"
11144When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11145most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11146message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11147deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11148expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11149doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11150precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11151&$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11152
11153.cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11154While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11155contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11156value may not, of course, be truthful.
11157
11158.vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11159A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11160available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11161details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11162
11163.vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11164These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11165of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11166
11167.vitem &$original_domain$&
11168.vindex "&$domain$&"
11169.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11170When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11171same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11172generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11173variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11174differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11175aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11176single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11177
11178If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11179filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11180part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11181
11182.vitem &$original_local_part$&
11183.vindex "&$local_part$&"
11184.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11185When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11186same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11187local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11188part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11189filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11190the original address.
11191
11192If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11193case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11194This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11195one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11196delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11197
11198If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11199filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11200part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11201
11202.vitem &$originator_gid$&
11203.cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11204.cindex "sender" "gid"
11205.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11206.vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11207This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11208message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11209gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11210normally the gid of the Exim user.
11211
11212.vitem &$originator_uid$&
11213.cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11214.cindex "sender" "uid"
11215.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11216.vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11217The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11218messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11219For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11220user.
11221
11222.vitem &$parent_domain$&
11223.vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11224This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11225above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11226
11227.vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11228.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11229This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11230(see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11231
11232.vitem &$pid$&
11233.cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11234.vindex "&$pid$&"
11235This variable contains the current process id.
11236
11237.vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11238.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11239.cindex "transport" "filter"
11240.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11241This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11242&`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11243&(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11244(described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11245It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11246variable"& error if encountered.
11247
11248.vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11249.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11250This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11251configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11252a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11253&[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11254qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11255
11256
11257.vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11258This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11259which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11260&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11261
11262.vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11263This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11264which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11265&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11266
11267.vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11268This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11269which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11270&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11271
11272.vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11273.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11274The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11275
11276.vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11277.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
11278The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
11279or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
11280
11281.vitem &$rcpt_count$&
11282.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
11283When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11284RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
11285RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
11286
11287.vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
11288.vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
11289.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
11290When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11291RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11292temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
11293
11294.vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
11295.vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
11296When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11297RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11298permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
11299
11300.vitem &$received_count$&
11301.vindex "&$received_count$&"
11302This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
11303including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
11304is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
11305delivering.
11306
11307.vitem &$received_for$&
11308.vindex "&$received_for$&"
11309If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
11310variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
11311built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
11312the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
11313
11314.vitem &$received_ip_address$&
11315.vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
11316As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
11317variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
11318is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
11319&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
11320the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
11321option.
11322
11323As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
11324could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
11325on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
11326values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
11327messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
11328time.
11329
11330&*Note:*& There are no equivalent variables for outgoing connections, because
11331the values are unknown (unless they are explicitly set by options of the
11332&(smtp)& transport).
11333
11334.vitem &$received_port$&
11335.vindex "&$received_port$&"
11336See &$received_ip_address$&.
11337
11338.vitem &$received_protocol$&
11339.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
11340When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
11341protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
11342by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
11343&"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
11344(encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
11345is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
11346connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
11347
11348Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
11349automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
11350&%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
11351encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
11352where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
11353STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
11354
11355The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
11356messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
11357identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
11358
11359.vitem &$received_time$&
11360.vindex "&$received_time$&"
11361This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
11362as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11363
11364.vitem &$recipient_data$&
11365.vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
11366This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
11367condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
11368until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
11369.display
11370&`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11371&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
11372.endd
11373&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11374method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11375The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11376expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11377
11378.vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
11379.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
11380In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
11381information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
11382
11383.ilist
11384&"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
11385was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
11386
11387.next
11388&"route"&: Routing failed.
11389
11390.next
11391&"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
11392or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
11393MAIL).
11394
11395.next
11396&"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
11397.next
11398
11399&"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
11400.endlist
11401
11402The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
11403rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
11404
11405.vitem &$recipients$&
11406.vindex "&$recipients$&"
11407This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
11408a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
11409is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
11410unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
11411cases:
11412
11413.olist
11414In a system filter file.
11415.next
11416In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
11417is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
11418&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
11419&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
11420.next
11421From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
11422.endlist
11423
11424
11425.vitem &$recipients_count$&
11426.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
11427When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
11428envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
11429from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
11430increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
11431
11432
11433.vitem &$regex_match_string$&
11434.vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
11435This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
11436&%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
11437
11438
11439.vitem &$reply_address$&
11440.vindex "&$reply_address$&"
11441When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
11442&'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
11443contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
11444white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
11445decoding or character code translation takes place.
11446
11447.vitem &$return_path$&
11448.vindex "&$return_path$&"
11449When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
11450the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
11451in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
11452same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
11453mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
11454for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
11455address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
11456that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
11457the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
11458envelope sender.
11459
11460.vitem &$return_size_limit$&
11461.vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
11462This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
11463
11464.vitem &$runrc$&
11465.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
11466.vindex "&$runrc$&"
11467This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
11468&%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
11469assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
11470preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
11471reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
11472another.
11473
11474.vitem &$self_hostname$&
11475.oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
11476.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
11477When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
11478local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
11479One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
11480happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
11481original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
11482
11483.vitem &$sender_address$&
11484.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
11485When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
11486that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
11487is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
11488value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
11489
11490.vitem &$sender_address_data$&
11491.vindex "&$address_data$&"
11492.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
11493If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11494sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
11495distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
11496after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
11497longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
11498
11499.vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
11500.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
11501The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
11502
11503.vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
11504.vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
11505The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
11506
11507.vitem &$sender_data$&
11508.vindex "&$sender_data$&"
11509This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
11510in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
11511value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
11512this:
11513.display
11514&`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11515&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
11516.endd
11517&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11518method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11519The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11520expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11521
11522.vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
11523.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
11524When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
11525name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
11526brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
11527enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
11528issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
11529looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
11530&%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
11531start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
11532verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
11533the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
11534the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
11535
11536.vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
11537.vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
11538When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
11539command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
11540set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
11541the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
11542
11543.vitem &$sender_host_address$&
11544.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
11545When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains that
11546host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is empty.
11547
11548.vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
11549.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
11550This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
11551driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
11552received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
11553&$authenticated_id$&.
11554
11555.vitem &$sender_host_name$&
11556.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
11557When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11558host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
11559other means, this variable is empty.
11560
11561.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11562If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
11563&$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
11564A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
11565via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
11566any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
11567&$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11568
11569.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11570However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
11571DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
11572&$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
11573
11574Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
11575host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
11576in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11577is set to &"1"&.
11578
11579Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
11580maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
11581these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
11582following are true:
11583
11584.ilist
11585A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
11586.next
11587The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
11588configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
11589to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
11590.next
11591Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
11592that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
11593&<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
11594.next
11595The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
11596In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
11597EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
11598.next
11599The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
11600domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
11601. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11602. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
11603.code
11604 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
11605.endd
11606which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
11607IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
11608.endlist
11609
11610
11611.vitem &$sender_host_port$&
11612.vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
11613When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
11614number that was used on the remote host.
11615
11616.vitem &$sender_ident$&
11617.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
11618When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11619identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
11620been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
11621called Exim.
11622
11623.vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
11624A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
11625&%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
11626&<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
11627
11628.vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
11629.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
11630.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
11631.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
11632This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
11633either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
11634there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
11635there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
11636the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
11637followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
11638first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
11639the parentheses.
11640
11641There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
11642was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
11643address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
11644all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
11645into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
11646
11647.vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
11648.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
11649In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
11650about the failure. The details are the same as for
11651&$recipient_verify_failure$&.
11652
11653.vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
11654.vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
11655This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11656been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
11657used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
11658on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
11659connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
11660
11661.vitem &$sending_port$&
11662.vindex "&$sending_port$&"
11663This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11664been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
11665connections, see &$received_port$&.
11666
11667.vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
11668.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
11669During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
11670host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
11671&$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
11672value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
11673
11674.vitem &$smtp_command$&
11675.vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
11676During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
11677entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
11678the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
11679.code
11680MAIL FROM:<>
11681MAIL FROM: <>
11682.endd
11683For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
11684command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
11685rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
11686the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
11687
11688.vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
11689.cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
11690.vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
11691While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
11692argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
11693space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
11694somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
11695
11696.vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
11697.vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
11698This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
11699daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
11700in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
11701connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
11702the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
11703never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
11704there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
11705single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
11706daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
11707
11708.vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
11709These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
11710that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
11711filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
11712example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
11713message is junk mail.
11714
11715.vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
11716A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
11717is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
11718&<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
11719
11720
11721.vitem &$spool_directory$&
11722.vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
11723The name of Exim's spool directory.
11724
11725.vitem &$spool_inodes$&
11726.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
11727The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
11728being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
11729If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
11730is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
11731
11732.vitem &$spool_space$&
11733.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
11734The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
11735Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
11736variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
11737find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
11738value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
11739megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
11740.code
11741condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
11742.endd
11743See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
11744
11745
11746.vitem &$thisaddress$&
11747.vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
11748This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
11749command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
11750command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
11751interfaces to mail filtering'&.
11752
11753.vitem &$tls_certificate_verified$&
11754.vindex "&$tls_certificate_verified$&"
11755This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
11756message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
11757
11758.vitem &$tls_cipher$&
11759.vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
11760When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11761connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
11762example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
11763received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
11764&$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
11765non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
11766
11767The &$tls_cipher$& variable retains its value during message delivery, except
11768when an outward SMTP delivery takes place via the &(smtp)& transport. In this
11769case, &$tls_cipher$& is cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
11770and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
11771&<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
11772details of the &(smtp)& transport.
11773
11774.vitem &$tls_peerdn$&
11775.vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
11776When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11777connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
11778the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
11779&$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing. Like &$tls_cipher$&, the
11780value is retained during message delivery, except during outbound SMTP
11781deliveries.
11782
11783.vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
11784.vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
11785The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
11786files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
11787
11788.vitem &$tod_epoch$&
11789.vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
11790The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11791
11792.vitem &$tod_full$&
11793.vindex "&$tod_full$&"
11794A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
11795+0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
11796positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
11797values for those that are behind (west).
11798
11799.vitem &$tod_log$&
11800.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
11801The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
118021995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
11803
11804.vitem &$tod_logfile$&
11805.vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
11806This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
11807is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
11808flag.
11809
11810.vitem &$tod_zone$&
11811.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
11812This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
11813-0500.
11814
11815.vitem &$tod_zulu$&
11816.vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
11817This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
11818by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
11819
11820.vitem &$value$&
11821.vindex "&$value$&"
11822This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
11823or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
11824&*reduce*& expansion.
11825
11826.vitem &$version_number$&
11827.vindex "&$version_number$&"
11828The version number of Exim.
11829
11830.vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
11831.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
11832This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
11833delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
11834
11835.vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
11836.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
11837This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
11838delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
11839.endlist
11840.ecindex IIDstrexp
11841
11842
11843
11844. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11845. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11846
11847.chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
11848.scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
11849Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
11850Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
11851use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
11852your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
11853the line
11854.code
11855EXIM_PERL = perl.o
11856.endd
11857in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
11858
11859
11860.section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
11861.oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
11862Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
11863&%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
11864no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
11865interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
11866the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
11867option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
11868a newly created Perl interpreter.
11869
11870The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
11871need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
11872should usually be something like
11873.code
11874perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
11875.endd
11876where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
11877use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
11878soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
11879the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
11880its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
11881fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
11882necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
11883the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
11884two ways:
11885
11886.ilist
11887.oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
11888Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
11889a startup when Exim is entered.
11890.next
11891The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
11892overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
11893.endlist
11894
11895There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
11896initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
11897
11898
11899.section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
11900When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
11901of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
11902by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
11903forms:
11904.code
11905${perl{foo}}
11906${perl{foo}{argument}}
11907${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
11908.endd
11909which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
11910arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
11911with an error message of the form
11912.code
11913Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
11914.endd
11915The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
11916it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
11917return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
11918an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
11919by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
11920that was passed to &%die%&.
11921
11922
11923.section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
11924Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
11925is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
11926the Perl code
11927.code
11928my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
11929.endd
11930makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
11931Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
11932&$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
11933
11934If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
11935&'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
11936expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
11937an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
11938
11939.cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
11940.cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
11941Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
11942&'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
11943debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
11944&'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
11945timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
11946
11947
11948.section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
11949.cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
11950You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
11951Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
11952before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
11953SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
11954is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
11955error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
11956avoided, but the output is lost.
11957
11958.cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
11959The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
11960Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
11961you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
11962output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
11963change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
11964For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
11965.code
11966$SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
11967.endd
11968Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
11969example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
11970include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
11971as the first subroutine argument.
11972.ecindex IIDperl
11973
11974
11975. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11976. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11977
11978.chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
11979 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
11980 "Starting the daemon"
11981.cindex "daemon" "starting"
11982.cindex "interface" "listening"
11983.cindex "network interface"
11984.cindex "interface" "network"
11985.cindex "IP address" "for listening"
11986.cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
11987.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
11988.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
11989A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
11990hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
11991or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
11992works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
11993In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
11994IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
11995knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
11996
11997.olist
11998When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
11999and ports to listen on.
12000.next
12001When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12002are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12003processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12004same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12005when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12006local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12007option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12008as an error situation.
12009.next
12010When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12011for the outgoing connection.
12012.endlist
12013
12014
12015Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12016of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12017addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12018standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12019rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12020
12021In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12022interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12023options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12024chapter describes how they operate.
12025
12026When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12027actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12028
12029
12030
12031.section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12032When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12033option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12034following options:
12035
12036.ilist
12037&%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports. (For backward
12038compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12039.next
12040&%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12041listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12042.endlist
12043
12044The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
12045described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
12046it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
12047colons. For example:
12048.code
12049local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
12050 192.168.23.65 ; \
12051 ::1 ; \
12052 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
12053.endd
12054There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
12055in &%local_interfaces%&:
12056
12057.olist
12058The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
12059on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
12060.code
12061local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
12062 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
12063.endd
12064.next
12065The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
12066with a colon separator, for example:
12067.code
12068local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
12069 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
12070.endd
12071.endlist
12072
12073When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
12074default setting contains just one port:
12075.code
12076daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12077.endd
12078If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
12079specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
12080&%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
12081&_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
12082IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
12083
12084
12085
12086.section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
12087The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
12088as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
12089case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
12090instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
12091default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12092.code
12093local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
12094.endd
12095when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
12096.code
12097local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12098.endd
12099Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
12100
12101
12102
12103.section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
12104The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
12105&%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
12106instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
12107option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
12108the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
12109exim.
12110
12111The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
12112changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
12113contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
12114&%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
12115items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12116replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
12117.code
12118-oX 1225
12119.endd
12120overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
12121whereas
12122.code
12123-oX 192.168.34.5.1125
12124.endd
12125overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
12126(However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
12127value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
12128
12129
12130
12131.section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
12132.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
12133.cindex "smtps protocol"
12134.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
12135.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
12136Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
12137before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
12138still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
12139list of port numbers, connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
12140common use of this option is expected to be
12141.code
12142tls_on_connect_ports = 465
12143.endd
12144because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
12145a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
12146this way when a daemon is started.
12147
12148&*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
12149daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
12150&%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
12151because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
12152connections via the daemon.)
12153
12154
12155
12156
12157.section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
12158.cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
12159IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
12160can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
12161interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
12162address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
12163percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
12164adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
12165.code
12166fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
12167.endd
12168To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
12169allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
12170to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
12171percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
12172address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
12173&[getaddrinfo()]&. If
12174.code
12175IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
12176.endd
12177is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
12178Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
12179instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
12180function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
12181&[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
12182
12183.section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
12184.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
12185Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
12186run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
12187using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
12188connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
12189.oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
12190&%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
12191activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
12192that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
12193etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
12194to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
12195
12196On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
12197disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
12198option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
12199and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
12200IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
12201
12202
12203
12204.section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
12205The default case in an IPv6 environment is
12206.code
12207daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12208local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12209.endd
12210This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
12211Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
12212the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
12213read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
12214
12215To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
12216.code
12217daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
12218.endd
12219(leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
12220.code
12221local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
12222 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
12223.endd
12224To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
12225IPv4 loopback address only:
12226.code
12227local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
12228.endd
12229To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
12230.code
12231local_interfaces = 192.168.34.67 : 192.168.34.67
12232.endd
12233&*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
12234
12235
12236
12237.section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
12238The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
12239whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
12240addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
12241treated as local.
12242
12243For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
12244the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
12245available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
12246(that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
12247
12248Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
12249many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
12250email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
12251interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
12252&%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
12253&"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
12254used for listening. Consider this example:
12255.code
12256local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
12257 192.168.53.235 ; \
12258 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
12259
12260extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12261.endd
12262The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
12263address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
12264Exim is routing.
12265
12266In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
12267address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
12268desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
12269these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
12270This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
12271during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
12272host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
12273addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
12274
12275
12276
12277.section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
12278Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
12279allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
12280there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
12281&%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
12282description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
12283details.
12284
12285
12286
12287
12288. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12289. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12290
12291.chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
12292.scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
12293.scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
12294The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
12295
12296.ilist
12297Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
12298&<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
12299.next
12300Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
12301&"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
12302section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
12303.next
12304Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
12305(with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
12306&"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
12307only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
12308settings.
12309.endlist
12310
12311This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
12312types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
12313in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
12314are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
12315an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
12316listed in more than one group.
12317
12318.section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
12319.table2
12320.row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
12321.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12322.row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
12323.row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
12324.row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
12325.row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
12326.row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
12327.row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
12328.row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
12329.endtable
12330
12331
12332.section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
12333.table2
12334.row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
12335.row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12336.row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
12337.row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
12338.row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
12339.row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
12340.endtable
12341
12342
12343
12344.section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
12345.table2
12346.row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
12347.row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
12348.row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
12349.row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12350.row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12351.row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
12352.row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
12353.row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
12354.row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
12355.row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
12356.row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
12357.endtable
12358
12359
12360
12361.section "Logging" "SECID99"
12362.table2
12363.row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
12364.row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12365.row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
12366.row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
12367.row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
12368.row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
12369.row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
12370.row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
12371.row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
12372.row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
12373.row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
12374.row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
12375.endtable
12376
12377
12378
12379.section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
12380.table2
12381.row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
12382.row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
12383.row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
12384.row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
12385.endtable
12386
12387
12388
12389.section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
12390.table2
12391.row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
12392.row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
12393.row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
12394.row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
12395.row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
12396.row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
12397.row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
12398.row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
12399.row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
12400.row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
12401.row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
12402.row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
12403.row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
12404.row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
12405.row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
12406.endtable
12407
12408
12409
12410.section "Message ids" "SECID102"
12411.table2
12412.row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
12413.row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
12414.endtable
12415
12416
12417
12418.section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
12419.table2
12420.row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
12421.row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
12422.endtable
12423
12424
12425
12426.section "Daemon" "SECID104"
12427.table2
12428.row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
12429.row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
12430.row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
12431.row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
12432.row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
12433.row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12434.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12435.endtable
12436
12437
12438
12439.section "Resource control" "SECID105"
12440.table2
12441.row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12442.row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
12443.row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12444.row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
12445.row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
12446.row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
12447.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12448.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12449.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12450.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12451.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12452.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12453.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12454.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12455.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12456.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12457 connection"
12458.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12459.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12460.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12461.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
12462.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12463.endtable
12464
12465
12466
12467.section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
12468.table2
12469.row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
12470.row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
12471.row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
12472.row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
12473.row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
12474.row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
12475.row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
12476.row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
12477.row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
12478.row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
12479.row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
12480.row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
12481.row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
12482.row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
12483.row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
12484.row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
12485.row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
12486.row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
12487.row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
12488.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12489 words""&"
12490.row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
12491.row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
12492.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12493.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12494.row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
12495.row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
12496.row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
12497.row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
12498.row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
12499.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12500.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12501.row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
12502.row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
12503.row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
12504.row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
12505.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12506.row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
12507.row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
12508.endtable
12509
12510
12511
12512.section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
12513.table2
12514.row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
12515 item"
12516.row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
12517 item"
12518.row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
12519.row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
12520.row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
12521.endtable
12522
12523
12524
12525.section "TLS" "SECID108"
12526.table2
12527.row &%gnutls_require_kx%& "control GnuTLS key exchanges"
12528.row &%gnutls_require_mac%& "control GnuTLS MAC algorithms"
12529.row &%gnutls_require_protocols%& "control GnuTLS protocols"
12530.row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
12531.row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
12532.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12533.row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
12534.row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
12535.row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
12536.row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
12537.row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
12538.row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
12539.row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
12540.row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
12541.row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
12542.row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
12543.endtable
12544
12545
12546
12547.section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
12548.table2
12549.row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
12550.row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
12551.row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
12552.row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
12553.row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
12554.row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
12555.row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
12556.row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
12557.endtable
12558
12559
12560
12561.section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
12562.table2
12563.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12564.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12565.row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
12566.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12567.row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
12568.row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
12569.row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
12570.row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
12571.endtable
12572
12573
12574
12575
12576.section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
12577.table2
12578.row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
12579.endtable
12580
12581
12582
12583
12584
12585.section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
12586See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
12587
12588.table2
12589.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12590.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12591.row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
12592.row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
12593.row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
12594.row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
12595.row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
12596.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12597.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12598.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12599.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12600.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12601.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12602.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12603 connection"
12604.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12605.row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
12606.row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
12607.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12608.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12609.row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
12610.row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
12611.row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
12612.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
12613.row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
12614.row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
12615.row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
12616.row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
12617.row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
12618.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12619.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12620.endtable
12621
12622
12623
12624.section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
12625.table2
12626.row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
12627.row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
12628.row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
12629.row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
12630.row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
12631.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12632.endtable
12633
12634
12635
12636.section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
12637.table2
12638.row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
12639.row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
12640.row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
12641.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12642 words""&"
12643.row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12644.row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12645.row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
12646.row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
12647.row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
12648.row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
12649.row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12650.row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
12651.row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
12652.row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
12653.endtable
12654
12655
12656
12657.section "System filter" "SECID115"
12658.table2
12659.row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
12660.row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
12661 directory"
12662.row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
12663.row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
12664.row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
12665.row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
12666.row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
12667.endtable
12668
12669
12670
12671.section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
12672.table2
12673.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12674.row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
12675.row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
12676.row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
12677.row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
12678.row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
12679.row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
12680.row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
12681.row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
12682.row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
12683.row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
12684.row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
12685.row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
12686.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12687.row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
12688.row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
12689.row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
12690.row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
12691.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12692.row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
12693.row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
12694.row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
12695.endtable
12696
12697
12698
12699.section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
12700.table2
12701.row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
12702.row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
12703.row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
12704.row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
12705.row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
12706.row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
12707.row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
12708.row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
12709.row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
12710.row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
12711.row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
12712.row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
12713.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12714.row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
12715.endtable
12716
12717
12718
12719.section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
12720Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
12721&dagger;.
12722
12723.option accept_8bitmime main boolean false
12724.cindex "8BITMIME"
12725.cindex "8-bit characters"
12726This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
12727EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
12728However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
12729takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
12730Consequently, this option is turned off by default.
12731
12732.option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
12733.cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
12734.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12735This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
12736read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12737further details.
12738
12739.option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12740This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
12741messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
12742SMTP messages.
12743
12744.option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
12745.cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
12746.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12747This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
12748non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12749
12750.option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
12751.cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
12752.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
12753This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
12754received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12755
12756.option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
12757.cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
12758This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
12759See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12760
12761.option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
12762.cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
12763This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
12764processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
12765acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12766
12767.option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
12768.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
12769This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
12770received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12771
12772.option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
12773.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
12774This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
12775received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12776
12777.option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
12778.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
12779.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
12780This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
12781command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12782
12783
12784.option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
12785.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
12786This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
12787received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12788
12789.option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
12790.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12791This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
12792a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
12793&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
12794
12795.option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12796.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
12797This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
12798extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
12799section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
12800
12801.option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
12802This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
12803received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12804further details.
12805
12806.option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
12807.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
12808This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
12809received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12810
12811.option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
12812.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
12813This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
12814received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12815
12816.option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
12817.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
12818This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
12819received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12820
12821.option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
12822.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
12823This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
12824received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12825
12826.option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
12827.cindex "admin user"
12828This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
12829current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
12830colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
12831programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
12832admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
12833not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
12834To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
12835
12836.option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
12837.cindex "domain literal"
12838If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
12839email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
12840format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
12841has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
12842
12843Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
12844format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
12845addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
12846&%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
12847domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
12848configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
12849the local host's IP addresses.
12850
12851
12852.option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
12853.cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
12854It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
12855and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
12856MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
12857that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
12858practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
12859&%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
12860recommended, except when you have no other choice.
12861
12862.option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
12863.cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
12864.cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
12865Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
12866camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
12867that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
12868experiment if they wish.
12869
12870If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
12871UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
12872letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
12873enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
12874adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
12875suitable setting is:
12876.code
12877dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
12878 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
12879.endd
12880Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
12881.code
12882dns_check_names_pattern =
12883.endd
12884That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
12885
12886
12887.option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
12888.cindex "authentication" "advertising"
12889.cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
12890If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
12891response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
12892Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
12893Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
12894advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
12895authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
12896&%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
12897authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
12898
12899Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
12900and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
12901not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
12902authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
12903to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
12904which Exim advertises AUTH.
12905
12906.cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
12907If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
12908is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
12909option is expanded, with a setting like this:
12910.code
12911auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{}{*}}
12912.endd
12913.vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12914If &$tls_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
12915the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
12916expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
12917
12918
12919.option auto_thaw main time 0s
12920.cindex "thawing messages"
12921.cindex "unfreezing messages"
12922If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
12923new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
12924this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
12925being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
12926saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
12927
12928&*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
12929&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
12930thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
12931
12932
12933.option av_scanner main string "see below"
12934This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
12935It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
12936.code
12937sophie:/var/run/sophie
12938.endd
12939If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
12940before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
12941
12942
12943.option bi_command main string unset
12944.oindex "&%-bi%&"
12945This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
12946the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
12947just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
12948required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
12949
12950
12951.option bounce_message_file main string unset
12952.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
12953.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
12954This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
12955for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
12956chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
12957
12958
12959.option bounce_message_text main string unset
12960When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
12961message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
12962delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
12963
12964.option bounce_return_body main boolean true
12965.cindex "bounce message" "including body"
12966This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
12967bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
12968causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
12969value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
12970message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
12971error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
12972point at which the error was detected are returned.
12973.cindex "bounce message" "including original"
12974
12975.option bounce_return_message main boolean true
12976If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
12977bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
12978&%bounce_return_body%&.
12979
12980
12981.option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
12982.cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
12983.cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
12984.cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
12985This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
12986senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
12987limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
12988any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
12989that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
12990
12991When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
12992greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
12993added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
12994to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
12995size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
12996messages.
12997
12998.option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
12999.cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
13000.cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
13001.cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
13002This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
13003bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
13004connection. A typical setting might be:
13005.code
13006bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13007.endd
13008which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
13009.code
13010MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13011.endd
13012The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
13013address.
13014
13015.option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
13016.cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
13017.cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
13018This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
13019domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13020section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13021
13022
13023.option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
13024This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
13025domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13026section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13027
13028
13029.option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
13030This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
13031address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13032section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13033
13034
13035.option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
13036This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
13037address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13038section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13039
13040
13041.option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
13042This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
13043callout verification. The default value is
13044.code
13045$primary_host_name-$tod_epoch-testing
13046.endd
13047See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
13048
13049
13050.option check_log_inodes main integer 0
13051See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13052
13053
13054.option check_log_space main integer 0
13055See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13056
13057.oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
13058.cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
13059.option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
13060RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
13061system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
13062word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
13063multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
13064exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
13065of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
13066set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
13067
13068
13069.option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
13070See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13071
13072
13073.option check_spool_space main integer 0
13074.cindex "checking disk space"
13075.cindex "disk space, checking"
13076.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
13077The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
13078message is accepted.
13079
13080.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
13081.vindex "&$log_space$&"
13082.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13083.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13084When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
13085want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
13086testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
13087&$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
13088
13089
13090&%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
13091either value is greater than zero, for example:
13092.code
13093check_spool_space = 10M
13094check_spool_inodes = 100
13095.endd
13096The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
13097SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
13098transit.
13099
13100&%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
13101files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
13102&%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
13103
13104If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
13105incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
13106error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
13107SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
13108&%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
13109&%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
13110
13111The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
13112number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
13113
13114For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
13115failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
13116it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
13117
13118.option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
13119.cindex "port" "for daemon"
13120.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13121This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
13122listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
13123backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
13124
13125.option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
13126.cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
13127This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
13128the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
13129(typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
13130defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
13131&%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
13132
13133.option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
13134See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
13135
13136.option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
13137.cindex "warning of delay"
13138.cindex "delay warning, specifying"
13139When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
13140intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
13141after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
13142string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
13143message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
13144between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
13145with
13146.code
13147delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
13148.endd
13149the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
13150the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
13151because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
13152just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
13153.code
13154delay_warning = 6h
13155.endd
13156messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
13157a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
13158.code
13159delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
13160.endd
13161
13162.option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
13163.vindex "&$domain$&"
13164The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
13165deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
13166expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
13167forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
13168&"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
13169not sent. The default is:
13170.code
13171delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
13172 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
13173 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
13174 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
13175 } {no}{yes}}
13176.endd
13177This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
13178&'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
13179&"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
13180&"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
13181
13182.option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
13183.cindex "unprivileged delivery"
13184.cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
13185If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
13186delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
13187the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
13188of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
13189chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
13190
13191.option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
13192.cindex "load average"
13193.cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
13194When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
13195becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
13196ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
13197See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
13198
13199
13200.option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
13201.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
13202Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
13203message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13204handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
13205should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
13206removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
13207occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13208
13209.option disable_fsync main boolean false
13210.cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
13211This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
13212ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
13213a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
13214build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
13215really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
13216distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
13217
13218When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
13219updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
13220such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
13221Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
13222
13223
13224.option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
13225.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13226If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13227activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13228that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
13229etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13230to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13231
13232
13233.option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
13234.cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
13235DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
13236&"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
13237keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
13238incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
13239may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
13240anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
13241This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
13242by a setting such as this:
13243.code
13244dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
13245.endd
13246This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
13247&[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
13248since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
13249&(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
13250when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
13251options are applied after this global option.
13252
13253.option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
13254.cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
13255When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
13256names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
13257the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
13258contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
13259a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
13260done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
13261value of this option. The default pattern is
13262.code
13263dns_check_names_pattern = \
13264 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
13265.endd
13266which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
13267they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
13268permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
13269accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
13270&%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
13271empty string.
13272
13273.option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
13274This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
13275DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13276
13277.option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
13278This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
13279reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
13280section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13281
13282.option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
13283.cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
13284.cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
13285When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
13286looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
13287(A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
13288domain matches this list.
13289
13290This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
13291not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
13292servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
13293
13294
13295.option dns_retrans main time 0s
13296.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13297The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
13298retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
13299defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
13300time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
13301totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
13302take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
13303parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
13304but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
13305to set in them.
13306
13307
13308.option dns_retry main integer 0
13309See &%dns_retrans%& above.
13310
13311
13312.new
13313.option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
13314.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13315.cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
13316If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
13317DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
13318the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
13319on.
13320
13321If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
13322.wen
13323
13324
13325.option drop_cr main boolean false
13326This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
13327handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
13328described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
13329
13330.option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
13331.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
13332.cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
13333This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
13334bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
13335Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
13336.code
13337dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
13338.endd
13339The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
13340panic is logged, and the default value is used.
13341
13342.option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
13343.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
13344Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
13345message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13346handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
13347messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
13348be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
13349the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
13350delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13351
13352
13353.option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
13354.cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
13355.cindex "copy of bounce message"
13356Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
13357generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
13358coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
13359items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
13360a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
13361must be enclosed in double quotes.
13362
13363Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
13364(see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
13365the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
13366items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
13367are examined. For example:
13368.code
13369errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
13370 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
13371 postmaster@mydomain.example
13372.endd
13373.vindex "&$domain$&"
13374.vindex "&$local_part$&"
13375The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
13376and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
13377there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
13378.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
13379variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
13380
13381
13382.option errors_reply_to main string unset
13383.cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
13384By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
13385.display
13386&`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
13387.endd
13388.oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
13389where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
13390A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
13391&(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
13392overrides the default.
13393
13394Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
13395&%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
13396and warning messages. For example:
13397.code
13398errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
13399.endd
13400The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
13401address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
13402&%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
13403own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
13404not used.
13405
13406
13407.option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
13408.cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
13409.cindex "Exim group"
13410This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13411privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
13412option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
13413of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
13414configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
13415security issues.
13416
13417
13418.option exim_path main string "see below"
13419.cindex "Exim binary, path name"
13420This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
13421needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
13422the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
13423is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
13424other place.
13425&*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
13426you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
13427where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
13428settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
13429
13430
13431.option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
13432.cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
13433.cindex "Exim user"
13434This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13435privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
13436time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
13437options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
13438
13439Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
13440&[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
13441not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
13442used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
13443
13444
13445.option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
13446This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
13447routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
13448&<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
13449
13450
13451. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
13452. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
13453
13454.option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
13455 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
13456.oindex "&%-t%&"
13457.cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
13458.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
13459According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
13460are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
13461envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
13462line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
13463behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
13464command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
13465&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
13466argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
13467addresses.
13468
13469
13470.option finduser_retries main integer 0
13471.cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
13472On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
13473distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
13474related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
13475Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
13476errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
13477many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
13478retries.
13479
13480.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
13481You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
13482a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
13483search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
13484
13485
13486
13487.option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
13488.cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
13489On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
13490ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
13491delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
13492&%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
13493feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
13494warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
13495freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
13496is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
13497supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
13498message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
13499freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
13500log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
13501logging that you require.
13502
13503
13504.option gecos_name main string&!! unset
13505.cindex "HP-UX"
13506.cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
13507Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
13508password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
13509looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
13510headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
13511of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
13512it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
13513upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
13514
13515When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
13516expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
13517login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
13518user's name.
13519
13520.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
13521Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
13522pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
13523name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
13524.code
13525gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
13526gecos_name = $1
13527.endd
13528
13529.option gecos_pattern main string unset
13530See &%gecos_name%& above.
13531
13532
13533.option gnutls_require_kx main string unset
13534This option controls the key exchange mechanisms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13535server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13536
13537.option gnutls_require_mac main string unset
13538This option controls the MAC algorithms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13539server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13540
13541.option gnutls_require_protocols main string unset
13542This option controls the protocols when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13543server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13544
13545.option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
13546This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
13547server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
13548implementations of TLS.
13549
13550.option headers_charset main string "see below"
13551This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
13552&"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
13553default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
13554ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
13555insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
13556
13557
13558
13559.option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
13560.cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
13561.cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
13562This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
13563section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
13564&_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
13565sections are rejected.
13566
13567
13568.option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
13569.cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
13570.cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
13571This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
13572all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
13573header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
13574zero means &"no limit"&.
13575
13576
13577
13578
13579.option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13580.cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
13581.cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
13582Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
13583mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
13584some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
13585this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
13586if you want to do semantic checking.
13587See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
13588set.
13589
13590
13591.option helo_allow_chars main string unset
13592.cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
13593.cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
13594.cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
13595This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
13596all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
13597hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
13598.code
13599helo_allow_chars = _
13600.endd
13601Note that the value is one string, not a list.
13602
13603
13604.option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
13605.cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13606.cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13607If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
13608list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
13609default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
13610its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
13611do.
13612
13613
13614.option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13615.cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
13616.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
13617By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
13618&%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
13619to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
13620condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
13621Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
13622to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
13623necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
13624encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
13625Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
13626
13627When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
13628&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
13629EHLO command either:
13630
13631.ilist
13632is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
13633.next
13634.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13635.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13636matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
13637calling host address, or
13638.next
13639when looked up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when
13640available) yields the calling host address.
13641.endlist
13642
13643However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
13644fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
13645be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
13646
13647.option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13648.cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
13649.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
13650Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
13651backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
13652name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
13653&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
13654rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
13655If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
13656error.
13657
13658.option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
13659.cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
13660.cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
13661This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
13662manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
13663&%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
13664verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
13665item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
13666it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
13667
13668This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
13669delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
13670configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
13671domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
13672&%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
13673
13674A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
13675messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
13676time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
13677retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
13678
13679
13680.option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
13681.cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
13682Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
13683is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
13684&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
13685option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
13686default configuration file contains
13687.code
13688host_lookup = *
13689.endd
13690which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
13691is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
13692
13693After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
13694has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
13695this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
13696
13697.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13698.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13699After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
13700unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
13701&%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
13702&`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
13703
13704
13705.option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
13706This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
13707to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
13708first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
13709if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
13710if you want.
13711
13712&*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
13713multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
13714&_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
13715case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
13716
13717
13718
13719.option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
13720.cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
13721If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
13722as soon as the connection is made.
13723This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
13724nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
13725connections immediately.
13726
13727The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
13728ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
13729sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
13730incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
13731chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
13732
13733
13734.option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
13735.cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
13736This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
13737happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
13738you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
13739127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
13740the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
13741list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
13742local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
13743.code
13744hosts_connection_nolog = :
13745.endd
13746If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
13747
13748
13749
13750.option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
13751.cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
13752.cindex "host" "treated as local"
13753If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
13754if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
13755records
13756or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
13757host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
13758
13759This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
13760&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
13761section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
13762&(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
13763that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
13764chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
13765interfaces and recognizing the local host.
13766
13767
13768.option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
13769.cindex "InterBase" "server list"
13770This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
13771to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
13772The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
13773
13774
13775
13776.option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
13777.cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
13778.cindex "discarding bounce message"
13779This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
13780that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
13781suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
13782
13783After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
13784because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
13785message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
13786the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
13787again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
13788bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
13789for frozen messages. For example,
13790.code
13791ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
13792.endd
13793retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
13794failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
13795failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
13796value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
13797dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
13798&%timeout_frozen_after%&.
13799
13800
13801.option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13802.cindex "&""From""& line"
13803.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
13804Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
13805the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
13806message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
13807such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
13808match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
13809process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
13810&%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
13811
13812
13813.option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
13814See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
13815
13816
13817.option keep_malformed main time 4d
13818This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
13819have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
13820next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
13821logged.
13822
13823
13824.option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
13825.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
13826This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
13827a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
13828While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
13829Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
13830and constrained to be a directory.
13831
13832
13833.option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
13834.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
13835This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
13836a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
13837While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
13838Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
13839and constrained to be a file.
13840
13841
13842.option ldap_cert_file main string unset
13843.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
13844This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
13845Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
13846Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
13847
13848
13849.option ldap_cert_key main string unset
13850.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
13851This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
13852to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
13853Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
13854identity to be proven.
13855
13856
13857.option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
13858.cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
13859This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
13860the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
13861cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
13862
13863
13864.option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
13865.cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
13866This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
13867LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
13868details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
13869with LDAP support.
13870
13871
13872.option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
13873.cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
13874This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
13875A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
13876See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
13877Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
13878to hard/demand.
13879
13880
13881.option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
13882.cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
13883If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
13884connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
13885"STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
13886of SSL-on-connect.
13887In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
13888by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
13889
13890
13891.option ldap_version main integer unset
13892.cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
13893This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
13894LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
13895-1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
13896the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
13897has been built with LDAP support.
13898
13899
13900
13901.option local_from_check main boolean true
13902.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
13903.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
13904When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
13905an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
13906checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
13907the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
13908
13909&*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
13910locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
13911&%-bnq%& command line option is used.
13912
13913You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
13914on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
13915&'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
13916and the default qualify domain.
13917
13918If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
13919and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
13920&'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
13921&%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
13922
13923.cindex "envelope sender"
13924These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
13925is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
13926&%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
13927
13928For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
13929request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
13930has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
13931
13932
13933
13934
13935.option local_from_prefix main string unset
13936When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
13937matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
13938ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
13939done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
13940appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
13941&%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
13942example, if
13943.code
13944local_from_prefix = *-
13945.endd
13946is set, a &'From:'& line containing
13947.code
13948From: anything-user@your.domain.example
13949.endd
13950will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
13951matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
13952qualify domain.
13953
13954
13955.option local_from_suffix main string unset
13956See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
13957
13958
13959.option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
13960This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
13961listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
13962&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
13963options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
13964&%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
13965&%local_interfaces%& is
13966.code
13967local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13968.endd
13969when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
13970.code
13971local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13972.endd
13973
13974.option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
13975.cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
13976.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
13977This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
13978&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
13979the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
13980message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
13981non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
13982
13983
13984
13985.option local_sender_retain main boolean false
13986.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
13987When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
13988an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
13989do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
13990also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
13991See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
13992&<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
13993
13994
13995
13996
13997.option localhost_number main string&!! unset
13998.cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
13999.cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
14000.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
14001Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
14002uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
14003value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
14004after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
14005host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
14006range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
14007systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
14008&$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
14009characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
14010time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
14011section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
14012
14013
14014
14015.option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
14016.cindex "log" "file path for"
14017This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
14018files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
14019when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
14020name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
14021are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
14022Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
14023section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
14024used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
14025variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
14026configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
14027&_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
14028early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
14029
14030
14031.option log_selector main string unset
14032.cindex "log" "selectors"
14033This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
14034writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
14035minus characters. For example:
14036.code
14037log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
14038.endd
14039A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
14040logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
14041
14042
14043.option log_timezone main boolean false
14044.cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
14045.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
14046.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
14047By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
14048timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
14049in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
14050avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
14051&%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
14052timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
14053of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
14054&$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
14055another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
14056
14057
14058.option lookup_open_max main integer 25
14059.cindex "too many open files"
14060.cindex "open files, too many"
14061.cindex "file" "too many open"
14062.cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
14063.cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
14064This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
14065lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
14066Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
14067file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
14068recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
14069actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
14070as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
14071open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
14072&%lookup_open_max%&.
14073
14074
14075.option max_username_length main integer 0
14076.cindex "length of login name"
14077.cindex "user name" "maximum length"
14078.cindex "limit" "user name length"
14079Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
14080&[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
14081this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
14082an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
14083
14084
14085.option message_body_newlines main bool false
14086.cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
14087.cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
14088.vindex "&$message_body$&"
14089.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14090By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
14091the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
14092option is set true, this no longer happens.
14093
14094
14095.option message_body_visible main integer 500
14096.cindex "body of message" "visible size"
14097.cindex "message body" "visible size"
14098.vindex "&$message_body$&"
14099.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14100This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
14101&$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
14102
14103
14104.option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
14105.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
14106If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
14107(domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
14108locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
14109means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
14110Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
14111Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
14112replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
14113empty string, the option is ignored.
14114
14115
14116.option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
14117If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
14118the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
14119message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
14120take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
14121the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
14122it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
14123yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
14124before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
14125that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
14126means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
14127colons will become hyphens.
14128
14129
14130.option message_logs main boolean true
14131.cindex "message logs" "disabling"
14132.cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
14133If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
14134&_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
14135Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
14136minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
14137per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
14138which is not affected by this option.
14139
14140
14141.option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
14142.cindex "message" "size limit"
14143.cindex "limit" "message size"
14144.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
14145This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
14146value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
14147to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
14148TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
14149optionally followed by K or M.
14150
14151&*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
14152other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
14153the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
14154error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
14155&%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14156
14157Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
14158exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
14159failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
14160an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
14161the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
14162message that an individual transport can process.
14163
14164If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
14165maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
14166failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
14167virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
14168probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. Eg, with a
14169default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
14170some problems may result.
14171
14172A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
14173SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
14174SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
14175
14176
14177.option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
14178.cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
14179This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
14180.code
14181SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
14182.endd
14183in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
14184moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
14185and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
14186standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
14187lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
14188
14189
14190.option mua_wrapper main boolean false
14191Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
14192it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
14193contains a full description of this facility.
14194
14195
14196
14197.option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
14198.cindex "MySQL" "server list"
14199This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
14200be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
14201option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
14202
14203
14204.option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
14205This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
14206message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
14207recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
14208It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
14209safety precaution.
14210
14211When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
14212list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
14213the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
14214contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
14215can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
14216
14217If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
14218&%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
14219example is
14220.code
14221never_users = root:daemon:bin
14222.endd
14223Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
14224harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
14225transport driver.
14226
14227
14228.option openssl_options main "string list" +dont_insert_empty_fragments
14229.cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
14230This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
14231by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
14232each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value. The default
14233value is one option which happens to have been set historically. You can
14234remove all options with:
14235.code
14236openssl_options = -all
14237.endd
14238This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
14239available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
14240The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
14241the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
14242list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
14243&"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
14244names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
14245
14246Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
14247SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
14248yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
14249adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at by invoking Exim
14250with the &%-bV%& flag.
14251
14252An example:
14253.code
14254openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer
14255.endd
14256
14257
14258.option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
14259.cindex "Oracle" "server list"
14260This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
14261to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14262The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
14263
14264
14265.option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14266.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
14267.cindex "source routing" "in email address"
14268.cindex "address" "source-routed"
14269The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
14270percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
14271replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
14272also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
14273option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
14274but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
14275an ACL.
14276
14277&*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
14278trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
14279if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
14280implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
14281routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
14282a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
14283local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
14284
14285
14286.option perl_at_start main boolean false
14287This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14288interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14289
14290
14291.option perl_startup main string unset
14292This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14293interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14294
14295
14296.option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
14297.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
14298This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
14299data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
14300&<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
14301PostgreSQL support.
14302
14303
14304.option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
14305.cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
14306.cindex "pid file, path for"
14307This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
14308process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
14309to the host name:
14310.code
14311pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
14312.endd
14313If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
14314spool directory.
14315The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
14316option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
14317of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
14318
14319
14320.option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14321.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
14322This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
14323PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
14324control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
14325&%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
14326for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
14327that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
14328not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
14329
14330
14331.option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
14332.cindex "message logs" "preserving"
14333If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
14334completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
14335called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
14336purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
14337volume of mail. Use with care!
14338
14339
14340.option primary_hostname main string "see below"
14341.cindex "name" "of local host"
14342.cindex "host" "name of local"
14343.cindex "local host" "name of"
14344.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14345This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
14346HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
14347option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
14348The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
14349server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
14350
14351If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
14352name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
14353contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
14354&[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
14355version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
14356explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
14357
14358
14359.option print_topbitchars main boolean false
14360.cindex "printing characters"
14361.cindex "8-bit characters"
14362By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
1436332&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
14364when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
14365sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
14366is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
14367characters.
14368
14369This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
14370&(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
14371the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
14372described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
14373Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
14374standards.
14375
14376
14377.option process_log_path main string unset
14378.cindex "process log path"
14379.cindex "log" "process log"
14380.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
14381This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
14382&"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
14383utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
14384in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
14385can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
14386different spool directories.
14387
14388
14389.option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
14390.oindex "&%-M%&"
14391.oindex "&%-R%&"
14392.oindex "&%-q%&"
14393The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
14394admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
14395&%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
14396
14397
14398.option qualify_domain main string "see below"
14399.cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
14400.cindex "address" "qualification"
14401This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
14402addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
14403recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
14404are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
14405also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
14406locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14407
14408Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
14409unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
14410&%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
14411addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
14412necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
14413addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
14414&%primary_hostname%& value.
14415
14416
14417.option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
14418This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
14419addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
14420
14421
14422
14423.option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14424.cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
14425.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14426.cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
14427This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
14428A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
14429domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
14430next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
14431
14432
14433.option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
14434.oindex "&%-bp%&"
14435The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
14436queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
14437&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
14438
14439
14440.option queue_only main boolean false
14441.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14442.cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
14443If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
14444whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
14445next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
14446delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
14447
14448The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
14449and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
14450&%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
14451&%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
14452
14453
14454.option queue_only_file main string unset
14455.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14456.cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
14457This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
14458one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
14459it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
14460each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
14461For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
14462&"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
14463.code
14464queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
14465.endd
14466causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
14467&_/some/file_& exists.
14468
14469
14470.option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
14471.cindex "load average"
14472.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14473.cindex "message" "queueing by load"
14474If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
14475all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
14476happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
14477the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
14478the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14479false.
14480
14481Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
14482option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
14483determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
14484&%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14485
14486
14487.option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
14488.cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
14489When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
14490because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
14491all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
14492This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
14493threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
14494connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
14495circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
14496where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14497should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
14498re-evaluated for each message.
14499
14500
14501.option queue_only_override main boolean true
14502.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14503When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
14504setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
14505&%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
14506to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
14507
14508
14509.option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
14510.cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
14511If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
14512in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
14513must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
14514single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
14515and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
14516single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
14517the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
14518avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
14519&%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
14520when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
14521large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
14522
14523
14524
14525.option queue_run_max main integer 5
14526.cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
14527This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
14528can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
14529but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
14530start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
14531very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
14532however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
14533started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
14534
14535Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
14536the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
14537run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
14538the daemon's command line.
14539
14540.option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14541.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14542.cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
14543When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
14544received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
14545However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
14546&%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
14547message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
14548has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
14549when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
14550over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
14551SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
14552&%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
14553&%queue_domains%&.
14554
14555
14556.option receive_timeout main time 0s
14557.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
14558This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
14559maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
14560the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
14561&%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
14562controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
14563
14564.option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
14565.cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
14566.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
14567This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
14568added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
14569on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
14570used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
14571added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
14572&"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
14573header lines. The default setting is:
14574
14575.code
14576received_header_text = Received: \
14577 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
14578 {${if def:sender_ident \
14579 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
14580 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
14581 by $primary_hostname \
14582 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
14583 ${if def:tls_cipher {($tls_cipher)\n\t}}\
14584 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
14585 ${if def:sender_address \
14586 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
14587 id $message_exim_id\
14588 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
14589.endd
14590
14591The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
14592support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
14593locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
14594header lines such as the following:
14595.code
14596Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
14597by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
14598(envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
14599id 16IOWa-00019l-00
14600for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
14601Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
14602id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
14603.endd
14604Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
14605the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
14606checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
14607message was accepted.
14608
14609
14610.option received_headers_max main integer 30
14611.cindex "loop" "prevention"
14612.cindex "mail loop prevention"
14613.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
14614When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
14615counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
14616have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
14617This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
14618
14619
14620.option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14621.cindex "unqualified addresses"
14622.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14623This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14624recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
14625qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
14626affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
14627addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
14628host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
14629or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
14630option was not set.
14631
14632
14633.option recipients_max main integer 0
14634.cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
14635.cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
14636If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
14637original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
14638by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
14639all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
14640Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
14641done.
14642
14643.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
14644&*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
14645RCPT commands in a single message.
14646
14647
14648.option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
14649If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
14650recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
14651error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
14652error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
14653initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
14654for the remaining recipients at a later time.
14655
14656
14657.option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
14658.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
14659This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
14660hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
14661does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
14662message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
14663have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
14664deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
14665deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
14666each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
14667same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
14668&%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
14669with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
14670tagged with its process id.
14671
14672This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
14673message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
14674manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
14675deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
14676is received.
14677
14678.cindex "number of deliveries"
14679.cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
14680If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
14681need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
14682are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
14683daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
14684fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
14685runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
14686delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
14687then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
14688&%remote_max_parallel%&.
14689
14690If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
14691&%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
14692doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
14693host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
14694
14695
14696.option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14697.cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
14698.cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
14699When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
14700domain into the order given by this list. For example,
14701.code
14702remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
14703.endd
14704would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
14705then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
14706
14707
14708.option retry_data_expire main time 7d
14709.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
14710This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
14711database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
14712host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
14713past failures.
14714
14715
14716.option retry_interval_max main time 24h
14717.cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
14718.cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
14719Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
14720intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
14721straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
14722retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
14723the default value.
14724
14725
14726.option return_path_remove main boolean true
14727.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
14728RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
14729&'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
14730The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
14731MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
14732in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
14733&'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
14734received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
14735the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
14736
14737
14738.option return_size_limit main integer 100K
14739This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14740
14741
14742.option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14743.cindex "RFC 1413"
14744.cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
14745RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
14746in the list.
14747
14748.option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 5s
14749.cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
14750.cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
14751This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
14752no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
14753
14754
14755.option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14756.cindex "unqualified addresses"
14757.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14758This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14759sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
14760&%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
14761not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
14762it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
14763&%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
14764using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
14765
14766
14767.option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
14768.cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
14769This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
14770TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
14771connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
14772other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
14773still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
14774this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
14775connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
14776tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
14777hours to detect unreachable hosts.
14778
14779
14780
14781.option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
14782.cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
14783.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
14784.cindex "inetd"
14785This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
14786that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
14787control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
14788value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
14789non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
14790set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14791
14792A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
14793has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
14794that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
14795and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
14796
14797
14798.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
14799.cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
14800.cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
14801Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
14802the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
14803check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
14804client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
14805client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
14806
14807When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
14808allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
14809but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
14810or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
14811starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
14812counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
14813following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
14814MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
14815
14816
14817.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14818You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
14819check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
14820changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
14821live with.
14822
14823
14824. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14825. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14826
14827.option "smtp_accept_max_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 1000 &&&
14828 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
14829.cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
14830.cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
14831The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
14832prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
14833results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
14834response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
14835precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
14836seen).
14837
14838
14839.option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
14840.cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
14841.cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
14842This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
14843host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
14844expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
14845reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
14846connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
14847is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
14848of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
14849required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
14850
14851&*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
14852constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
14853happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
14854without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
14855could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
14856doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
14857
14858
14859
14860.option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
14861.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
14862.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14863.cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
14864If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
14865listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
14866on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
14867fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
14868subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
14869to all messages received in the same connection.
14870
14871A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
14872if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
14873also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
14874various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
14875
14876
14877. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14878. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14879
14880.option "smtp_accept_queue_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 10 &&&
14881 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
14882.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14883.cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
14884This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
14885automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
14886the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
14887and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
14888number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
14889are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
14890restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
14891systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
14892dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
14893
14894
14895.option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
14896.cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
14897.cindex "host" "reserved"
14898When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
14899number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
14900that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
14901&%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
14902restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
14903of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
14904of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
14905the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
14906individual host.
14907
14908For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
14909set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
14910connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
14911provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
14912
14913
14914.option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
14915.cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
14916.cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
14917.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14918This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
14919several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
14920is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
14921responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
14922incoming HELO or EHLO command.
14923
14924.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
14925The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
14926is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
14927in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
14928
14929If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
14930expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
14931used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
14932panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
14933value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
14934For example:
14935.code
14936smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
14937 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
14938.endd
14939
14940Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
14941messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
14942verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
14943&%helo_data%& value.
14944
14945.option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
14946.cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
14947.cindex "banner for SMTP"
14948.cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
14949.cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
14950This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
14951positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
14952.code
14953smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
14954 $version_number $tod_full
14955.endd
14956Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
14957multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
14958appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
14959in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
14960multiline response).
14961
14962
14963.option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
14964.cindex "checking disk space"
14965.cindex "disk space, checking"
14966.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14967When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
14968option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
14969spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
14970leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
14971is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
14972
14973
14974.option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
14975.cindex "connection backlog"
14976.cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
14977.cindex "backlog of connections"
14978This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
14979this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
14980of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
14981attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
14982say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
14983out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
14984value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
14985attacks by SYN flooding.
14986
14987
14988.option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
14989.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
14990.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
14991The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
14992the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
14993synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
14994fewer, but they still exist.
14995
14996Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
14997for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
14998client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
14999SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
15000for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
15001input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
15002does detect many instances.
15003
15004The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
15005If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
15006hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
15007(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
15008
15009
15010
15011.option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
15012.cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
15013.vindex "&$domain$&"
15014If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
15015command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
15016chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
15017are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
15018argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
15019example:
15020.code
15021smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
15022 $sender_host_address
15023.endd
15024A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
15025complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
15026run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
15027a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
15028receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
15029the command.
15030
15031
15032.option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
15033.cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
15034When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
15035one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
15036section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
15037
15038
15039.option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
15040.cindex "load average"
15041If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
15042accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
15043If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
15044the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
15045systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
15046&%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
15047
15048
15049
15050.option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
15051.cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
15052.cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
15053Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
15054particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
15055.code
15056RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
15057.endd
15058causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
15059(The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
15060example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
15061too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
15062dropped. The limit is set by this option.
15063
15064.cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
15065When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
15066&"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
15067Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
15068&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
15069not count towards the limit.
15070
15071
15072
15073.option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
15074.cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
15075.cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
15076If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
15077Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
15078that subvert web
15079clients
15080into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
15081non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
15082
15083
15084
15085.option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15086.cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
15087.cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
15088.cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
15089Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
15090can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
15091recipients.
15092
15093Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
15094facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
15095&%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
15096&<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
15097
15098When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
15099&%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
15100rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
15101respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
15102values:
15103
15104.ilist
15105A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
15106.next
15107An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
15108fractional parts are allowed here.
15109.next
15110A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
15111.next
15112A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
15113because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
15114.endlist
15115
15116For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
15117first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
15118.code
15119smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
15120smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
15121.endd
15122The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
15123two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
15124seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
15125delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
15126
15127
15128.option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
15129See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15130
15131
15132.option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
15133See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15134
15135
15136.option smtp_receive_timeout main time 5m
15137.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
15138.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
15139This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
15140input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
15141data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
15142the message is abandoned.
15143A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
15144.code
15145SMTP command timeout on connection from...
15146SMTP data timeout on connection from...
15147.endd
15148The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
15149means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
15150
15151
15152.oindex "&%-os%&"
15153The value set by this option can be overridden by the
15154&%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
15155this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
15156of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
15157timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
15158
15159
15160.option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15161This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
15162&%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
15163
15164
15165.option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
15166.cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
15167.cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
15168In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
15169&"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
15170reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
15171to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
15172policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
15173&%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
15174example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
15175.code
15176550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
15177550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
15178.endd
15179
15180.option spamd_address main string "see below"
15181This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
15182extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
15183The default value is
15184.code
15185127.0.0.1 783
15186.endd
15187See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
15188
15189
15190
15191.option split_spool_directory main boolean false
15192.cindex "multiple spool directories"
15193.cindex "spool directory" "split"
15194.cindex "directories, multiple"
15195If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
15196subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
15197sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
15198subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
15199arrival of the message.
15200
15201Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
15202where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
15203directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
15204directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
15205are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
15206
15207It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
15208changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
15209&"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
15210after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
15211automatically deleted.
15212
15213When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
15214changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
15215trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
15216sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
15217sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
15218spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
15219particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
15220if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
15221entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
15222
15223
15224.option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
15225.cindex "spool directory" "path to"
15226This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
15227it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
15228configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
15229string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
15230&$primary_hostname$&.
15231
15232If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
15233that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
15234log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
15235Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
15236as failures in the configuration file.
15237
15238By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
15239tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
15240
15241.option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
15242.cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
15243This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
15244access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
15245
15246.option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
15247.cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
15248This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
15249variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
15250is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
15251&<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
15252
15253.option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
15254.cindex "angle brackets, excess"
15255If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
15256items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
15257treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
15258passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
15259option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
15260
15261
15262.option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
15263.cindex "trailing dot on domain"
15264.cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
15265If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
15266ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
15267MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
15268domain causes a syntax error.
15269However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
15270syntax checking.
15271
15272
15273.option syslog_duplication main boolean true
15274.cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
15275When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
15276separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
15277be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
15278separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
15279nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
15280particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
15281both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
15282containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
15283Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
15284the LOG_ALERT priority.
15285
15286
15287.option syslog_facility main string unset
15288.cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
15289This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15290syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
15291&"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
15292If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15293details of Exim's logging.
15294
15295
15296
15297.option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
15298.cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
15299This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15300syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
15301&<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
15302
15303
15304
15305.option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
15306.cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
15307If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
15308omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15309details of Exim's logging.
15310
15311
15312.option system_filter main string&!! unset
15313.cindex "filter" "system filter"
15314.cindex "system filter" "specifying"
15315.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
15316This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
15317the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
15318must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
15319generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
15320appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
15321which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
15322&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
15323
15324
15325.option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
15326.vindex "&$address_file$&"
15327This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
15328&%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
15329implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
15330During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15331
15332
15333.option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
15334.cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
15335This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
15336command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
15337the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15338
15339.option system_filter_group main string unset
15340.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
15341This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
15342gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
15343with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
15344
15345.option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
15346.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
15347.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
15348This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
15349is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
15350contains the pipe command.
15351
15352
15353.option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
15354.cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
15355This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
15356is used in a system filter.
15357
15358
15359.option system_filter_user main string unset
15360.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
15361If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
15362delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
15363process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
15364Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
15365is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
15366configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
15367specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
15368&%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
15369
15370If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
15371under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
15372transport option overrides.
15373
15374
15375.option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
15376.cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
15377.cindex "Nagle algorithm"
15378.cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
15379If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
15380TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
15381turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
15382performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
15383should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
15384However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
15385this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
15386daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
15387TCP_NODELAY.
15388
15389
15390.option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
15391.cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
15392.cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
15393If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
15394message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
15395is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
15396bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
15397sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
15398If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
15399frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
15400
15401&*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
15402frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
15403messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
15404
15405
15406.option timezone main string unset
15407.cindex "timezone, setting"
15408The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
15409running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
15410created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
15411to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
15412.code
15413timezone = UTC
15414.endd
15415The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
15416or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
15417is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
15418time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
15419runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
15420unfortunately not all, operating systems.
15421
15422
15423.option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15424.cindex "TLS" "advertising"
15425.cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
15426.cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
15427When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
15428of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
15429response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
15430chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
15431
15432
15433.option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
15434.cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
15435.cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
15436The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15437file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
15438assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
15439&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15440
15441&*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
15442receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
15443use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
15444option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
15445
15446
15447.option tls_crl main string&!! unset
15448.cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
15449.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
15450This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
15451be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
15452
15453
15454.option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
15455.cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
15456The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15457a file which contains the server's DH parameter values.
15458This is used only for OpenSSL. When Exim is linked with GnuTLS, this option is
15459ignored. See section &<<SECTopenvsgnu>>& for further details.
15460
15461
15462.option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
15463This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
15464operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
15465set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
15466further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
15467
15468
15469
15470.option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
15471.cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
15472The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15473file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
15474the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
15475key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
15476&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15477
15478
15479.option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
15480.cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
15481.cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
15482If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
15483&"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
15484support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
15485TLS session.
15486
15487
15488.option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
15489.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
15490.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
15491This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
15492The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
15493connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
15494different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
15495permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
15496in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
15497preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
15498&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
15499
15500
15501.option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15502.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15503.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15504See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
15505
15506
15507.option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! unset
15508.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15509.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15510The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15511a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
15512match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. Alternatively, if you
15513are using OpenSSL, you can set &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a
15514directory containing certificate files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the
15515option must be set to the name of a single file if you are using GnuTLS.
15516
15517These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
15518than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
15519the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
15520connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
15521Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
15522use OpenSSL with a directory.
15523
15524
15525.option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15526.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15527.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15528This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
15529certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
15530&%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
15531either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
15532&%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
15533
15534Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
15535&%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
15536present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
15537aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
15538the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
15539connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
15540ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
15541
15542A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
15543matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
15544certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
15545abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
15546state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
15547such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
15548but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
15549certificate"&.
15550
15551Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
15552certificates.
15553
15554
15555.option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
15556.cindex "trusted groups"
15557.cindex "groups" "trusted"
15558This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15559option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
15560which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
15561specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
15562details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
15563&%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
15564are trusted.
15565
15566.option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
15567.cindex "trusted users"
15568.cindex "user" "trusted"
15569This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15570option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
15571trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
15572&<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
15573If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
15574Exim user are trusted.
15575
15576.option unknown_login main string&!! unset
15577.cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
15578.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
15579This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
15580the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
15581gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
15582used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
15583can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
15584is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
15585&%-F%& option.
15586
15587.option unknown_username main string unset
15588See &%unknown_login%&.
15589
15590.option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
15591.cindex "trusted users"
15592.cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
15593.cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
15594.cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
15595.cindex "envelope sender"
15596When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
15597normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
15598default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
15599senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
15600is used) is ignored.
15601
15602However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
15603to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
15604.code
15605exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
15606.endd
15607.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
15608The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
15609other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
15610users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
15611patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
15612identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
15613users to setting senders that start with their login ids
15614followed by a hyphen
15615by a setting like this:
15616.code
15617untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
15618.endd
15619If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
15620restriction, you can use
15621.code
15622untrusted_set_sender = *
15623.endd
15624The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
15625only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
15626to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
15627parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
15628&'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
15629necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
15630overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
15631described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
15632
15633The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
15634&"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
15635&%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
15636envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
15637sender address.
15638
15639
15640.option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
15641.cindex "&""From""& line"
15642.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15643Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
15644an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
15645particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
15646of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
15647matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
15648&%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
15649default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
15650.code
15651From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
15652From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
15653.endd
15654The pattern can be seen by running
15655.code
15656exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
15657.endd
15658It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
15659year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
15660regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
15661&%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
15662(&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
15663&%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
15664
15665
15666.option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
15667See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
15668
15669
15670.option warn_message_file main string unset
15671.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
15672.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
15673This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
15674for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
15675been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
15676&%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
15677&<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
15678
15679
15680.option write_rejectlog main boolean true
15681.cindex "reject log" "disabling"
15682If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
15683See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
15684.ecindex IIDconfima
15685.ecindex IIDmaiconf
15686
15687
15688
15689
15690. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15691. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15692
15693.chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
15694.scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
15695.scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
15696This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
15697Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
15698
15699For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
15700&<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
15701which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
15702provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
15703&%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
15704
15705
15706
15707.option address_data routers string&!! unset
15708.cindex "router" "data attached to address"
15709The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
15710precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
15711router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
15712&%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
15713delivery of the address to be deferred.
15714
15715.vindex "&$address_data$&"
15716When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
15717accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
15718routers, and the eventual transport.
15719
15720&*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
15721that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
15722in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
15723either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
15724put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
15725
15726Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
15727with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
15728on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
15729&$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
15730&"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
15731
15732The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
15733for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
15734you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
15735.code
15736uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
15737.endd
15738In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
15739.code
15740file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
15741.endd
15742This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
15743lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
15744
15745.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
15746.vindex "&$address_data$&"
15747The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
15748from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
15749&$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
15750ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
15751verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
15752
15753
15754
15755.option address_test routers&!? boolean true
15756.oindex "&%-bt%&"
15757.cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
15758If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
15759by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
15760your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
15761having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
15762routing.
15763
15764
15765
15766.option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
15767.cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
15768.cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
15769This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
15770routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
15771&"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
15772&%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
15773value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
15774includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
15775well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
15776you could put:
15777.code
15778cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
15779.endd
15780on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
15781and
15782.code
15783cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
15784.endd
15785on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
15786this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
15787explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
15788logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
15789
15790
15791.option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
15792.cindex "case of local parts"
15793.cindex "router" "case of local parts"
15794By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
15795manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
15796If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
15797this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
15798part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
15799turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
15800more details.
15801
15802.vindex "&$local_part$&"
15803.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
15804.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
15805The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
15806router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
15807an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
15808is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
15809addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
15810and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
15811
15812This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
15813recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
15814modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
15815(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
15816
15817
15818
15819.option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
15820.cindex "local user, checking in router"
15821.cindex "router" "checking for local user"
15822.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
15823.vindex "&$home$&"
15824When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
15825address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
15826local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
15827than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
15828holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
15829user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
15830preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
15831given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
15832overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
15833the router is skipped.
15834
15835If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
15836or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
15837setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
15838two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
15839setting to achieve this. For example:
15840.code
15841local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
15842.endd
15843Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
15844up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
15845&%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
15846
15847
15848
15849.option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
15850.cindex "router" "customized precondition"
15851This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
15852router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
15853evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
15854result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
15855&"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
15856router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
15857
15858If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
15859precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
15860
15861This option is unique in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
15862All &%condition%& options must succeed.
15863
15864The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
15865running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
15866the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
15867.code
15868condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
15869.endd
15870Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
15871.code
15872condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
15873.endd
15874
15875A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
15876.code
15877condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
15878condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
15879condition = foobar
15880.endd
15881
15882If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
15883of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
15884be specified using &%condition%&.
15885
15886
15887.option debug_print routers string&!! unset
15888.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
15889If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
15890option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
15891If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
15892output, and Exim carries on processing.
15893This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
15894so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
15895option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
15896variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
15897&%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
15898are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
15899
15900
15901
15902.option disable_logging routers boolean false
15903If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
15904or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
15905unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
15906transport option of the same name.
15907
15908
15909.option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
15910.cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
15911.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
15912If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
15913the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
15914lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
15915expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
15916a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
15917
15918
15919
15920.option driver routers string unset
15921This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
15922to be used.
15923
15924
15925
15926.option errors_to routers string&!! unset
15927.cindex "envelope sender"
15928.cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
15929If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
15930transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
15931there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
15932message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
15933provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
15934expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
15935
15936The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
15937subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
15938settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
15939setting.
15940
15941If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
15942the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
15943address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
15944expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
15945
15946If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
15947SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
15948any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
15949sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
15950settings:
15951.code
15952errors_to =
15953errors_to = ""
15954.endd
15955An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
15956this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
15957no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
15958address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
15959overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
15960
15961.vindex "&$address_data$&"
15962If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
15963MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
15964path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
15965setting &%return_path%&.
15966
15967The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
15968manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
15969implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
15970
15971
15972
15973.option expn routers&!? boolean true
15974.cindex "address" "testing"
15975.cindex "testing" "addresses"
15976.cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
15977.cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
15978If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
15979as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
15980want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
15981on for the system alias file.
15982See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
15983are evaluated.
15984
15985The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
15986&<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
15987an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
15988
15989
15990
15991.option fail_verify routers boolean false
15992.cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
15993Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
15994&%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
15995
15996
15997
15998.option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
15999If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16000verifying a recipient, verification fails.
16001
16002
16003
16004.option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
16005If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16006verifying a sender, verification fails.
16007
16008
16009
16010.option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
16011.cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
16012.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
16013String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
16014colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
16015changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
16016each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
16017defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
16018&<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
16019
16020If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
16021associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
16022list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
16023randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
16024transport for further details.
16025
16026
16027.option group routers string&!! "see below"
16028.cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
16029.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16030.cindex "transport" "local"
16031.cindex "router" "setting group"
16032When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
16033specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
16034process.
16035The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
16036error is logged and delivery is deferred.
16037The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
16038is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
16039and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16040
16041
16042
16043.option headers_add routers string&!! unset
16044.cindex "header lines" "adding"
16045.cindex "router" "adding header lines"
16046This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
16047associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
16048option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16049the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
16050&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
16051message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
16052header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
16053&"see"& the added header lines.
16054
16055The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
16056&%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If the expanded string is empty, or if
16057the expansion is forced to fail, the option has no effect. Other expansion
16058failures are treated as configuration errors.
16059
16060&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
16061router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
16062
16063.cindex "duplicate addresses"
16064.oindex "&%unseen%&"
16065&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
16066additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
16067For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
16068address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
16069modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
16070circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
16071which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
16072avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
16073
16074
16075
16076.option headers_remove routers string&!! unset
16077.cindex "header lines" "removing"
16078.cindex "router" "removing header lines"
16079This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
16080associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
16081option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16082the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
16083section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
16084the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
16085to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
16086&"see"& the original header lines.
16087
16088The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
16089&%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If the expansion is forced to fail,
16090the option has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
16091errors.
16092
16093&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
16094router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
16095
16096&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
16097removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
16098routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
16099warning for &%headers_add%& above.
16100
16101
16102.option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
16103.cindex "IP address" "discarding"
16104.cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
16105Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
16106entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
16107IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
16108address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
16109like
16110.code
16111remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
16112.endd
16113by setting
16114.code
16115ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
16116.endd
16117on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
16118discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
16119attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
16120domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
16121Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
16122router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
16123
16124You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
16125means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
16126.code
16127ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
16128ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
16129.endd
16130The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
16131in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
16132
16133This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
16134addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
16135is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
16136domain that is being routed.
16137
16138.vindex "&$host_address$&"
16139During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
16140checked.
16141
16142.option initgroups routers boolean false
16143.cindex "additional groups"
16144.cindex "groups" "additional"
16145.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16146.cindex "transport" "local"
16147If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
16148the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
16149&[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
16150any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
16151and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16152
16153
16154
16155.option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
16156.cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
16157.cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
16158If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
16159one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
16160section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
16161evaluated.
16162
16163The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
16164used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
16165asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
16166the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
16167some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
16168.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
16169.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
16170Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
16171section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
16172
16173.vindex "&$local_part$&"
16174.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
16175During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
16176running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
16177expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
16178the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
16179a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
16180command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
16181This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
16182the relevant transport.
16183
16184When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
16185behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
16186means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
16187callout.
16188
16189The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
16190&%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
16191&%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
16192to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
16193immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
16194.code
16195real_localuser:
16196 driver = accept
16197 local_part_prefix = real-
16198 check_local_user
16199 transport = local_delivery
16200.endd
16201For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
16202router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
16203.code
16204 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
16205 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
16206.endd
16207
16208If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
16209both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
16210are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
16211separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
16212
16213
16214.option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
16215See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
16216
16217
16218
16219.option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
16220.cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
16221.cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
16222This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
16223local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
16224&%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
16225mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
16226character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
16227parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
16228&%username-foo%&.
16229
16230
16231.option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
16232See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
16233
16234
16235
16236.option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
16237.cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
16238.cindex "local part" "checking in router"
16239The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
16240See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16241are evaluated, and
16242section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
16243string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
16244example:
16245.code
16246local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
16247.endd
16248.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
16249If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
16250for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
16251expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
16252example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
16253send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
16254each virtual domain:
16255.code
16256postmaster:
16257 driver = redirect
16258 local_parts = postmaster
16259 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
16260.endd
16261
16262
16263.option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
16264.cindex "log" "delivery line"
16265.cindex "delivery" "log line format"
16266Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
16267deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
16268recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
16269this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
16270router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
16271router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
16272redirect addresses.
16273
16274
16275
16276.option more routers boolean&!! true
16277The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16278that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16279result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16280fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
16281delivery to be deferred.
16282
16283If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
16284further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
16285.oindex "&%self%&"
16286However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
16287means of the setting
16288.code
16289self = pass
16290.endd
16291or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
16292does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
16293case, the address is always passed to the next router.
16294
16295Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
16296expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
16297controls what happens next.
16298
16299
16300.option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
16301.cindex "timeout" "of router"
16302.cindex "router" "timeout"
16303If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
16304address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
16305router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
16306intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
16307host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
16308
16309There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
16310lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
16311applies to all of them.
16312
16313
16314
16315.option pass_router routers string unset
16316.cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
16317Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
16318&(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
16319routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
16320these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
16321router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
16322of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
16323be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
16324to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
16325&"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
16326
16327
16328
16329.option redirect_router routers string unset
16330.cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
16331Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
16332generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
16333example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
16334point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
16335
16336The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
16337It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
16338instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
16339which it is set does not generate new addresses.
16340
16341
16342
16343.option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
16344.cindex "file" "requiring for router"
16345.cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
16346This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
16347router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
16348Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
16349through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
16350
16351Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
16352be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
16353If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
16354failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
16355
16356If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
16357below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
16358&"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
16359existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
16360preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
16361
16362.cindex "NFS"
16363If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
16364the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
16365unavailable.
16366
16367This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
16368options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
16369look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
16370full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
16371these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
16372to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
16373that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
16374transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
16375
16376During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
16377facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
16378This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
16379operates as follows:
16380
16381If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
16382characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
16383comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
16384but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
16385used. For example:
16386.code
16387require_files = mail:/some/file
16388require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
16389.endd
16390If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
16391&%require_files%& condition fails.
16392
16393Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
16394checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
16395directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
16396access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
16397
16398&*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
16399incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
16400may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
16401may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
16402user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
16403
16404&*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
16405&[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
16406without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
16407is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
16408check again in that process.
16409
16410The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
16411be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
16412existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
16413circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
16414not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
16415name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
16416as if the file did not exist. For example:
16417.code
16418require_files = +/some/file
16419.endd
16420If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
16421handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
16422option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
16423
16424
16425
16426.option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
16427.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
16428.cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
16429When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
16430in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
16431domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
16432other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
16433Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
16434latter kind.
16435
16436This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
16437hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
16438router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
16439set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
16440for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
16441same name.
16442
16443The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
16444appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
16445independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
16446
16447
16448
16449.option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
16450.cindex "router" "home directory for"
16451.cindex "home directory" "for router"
16452.vindex "&$home$&"
16453This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
16454&%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
16455transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
16456sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
16457forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
16458cause the router to defer.
16459
16460Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
16461&%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
16462place.
16463(See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16464are evaluated.)
16465While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
16466&$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
16467
16468When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
16469the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
16470delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
16471of these values that is set:
16472
16473.ilist
16474The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
16475.next
16476The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
16477.next
16478The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
16479.next
16480The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
16481.endlist
16482
16483In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
16484router, but not for the transport.
16485
16486
16487
16488.option self routers string freeze
16489.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
16490.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
16491This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
16492list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
16493and &(manualroute)& routers.
16494Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
16495of remote hosts.
16496Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
16497&(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
16498host on the list turns out to be the local host.
16499The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
16500&<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
16501
16502Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
16503example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
16504error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
16505reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
16506freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
16507cases:
16508
16509.vlist
16510.vitem &%defer%&
16511Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
16512
16513.vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
16514The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
16515be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
16516behaviour is essentially a redirection.
16517
16518.vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
16519The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
16520reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
16521rewritten.
16522
16523.vitem &%pass%&
16524.oindex "&%more%&"
16525.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
16526The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
16527&%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
16528subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
16529name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
16530distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
16531combination
16532.code
16533self = pass
16534no_more
16535.endd
16536ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
16537Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
16538be passed to the next router.
16539
16540.vitem &%fail%&
16541Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
16542
16543.vitem &%send%&
16544.cindex "local host" "sending to"
16545The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
16546setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
16547makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
16548is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
16549different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
16550.endlist
16551
16552
16553
16554.option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
16555.cindex "router" "checking senders"
16556If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
16557address matches something on the list.
16558See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16559are evaluated.
16560
16561There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
16562dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
16563setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
16564to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
16565set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
16566verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
16567SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
16568matters.
16569
16570
16571.option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
16572.cindex "IP address" "translating"
16573.cindex "packet radio"
16574.cindex "router" "IP address translation"
16575There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
16576it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
16577mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
16578routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
16579is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
16580code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
16581SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
16582
16583.vindex "&$host_address$&"
16584The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
16585by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
16586expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
16587For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
16588If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
16589address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
16590up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
16591produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
16592addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
16593.code
16594translate_ip_address = \
16595 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
16596 {$value}fail}}
16597.endd
16598The file would contain lines like
16599.code
1660010.2.3.128/26 some.host
1660110.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
16602.endd
16603You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
16604are doing.
16605
16606
16607
16608.option transport routers string&!! unset
16609This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
16610and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
16611only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
16612after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
16613and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
16614delivery is deferred.
16615
16616The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
16617have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
16618(see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
16619
16620
16621
16622.option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
16623.cindex "current directory for local transport"
16624This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
16625to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
16626explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
16627file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
16628option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
16629overridden by a setting on the transport.
16630If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16631logged, and delivery is deferred.
16632See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
16633environment.
16634
16635
16636
16637
16638.option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
16639.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
16640This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
16641local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
16642configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
16643pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
16644string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
16645setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
16646If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16647logged, and delivery is deferred.
16648
16649If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
16650&%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
16651the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
16652the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
16653is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
16654
16655See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
16656environment.
16657
16658
16659
16660
16661.option unseen routers boolean&!! false
16662.cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
16663The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16664that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16665result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16666fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
16667delivery to be deferred.
16668
16669When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
16670address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
16671overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
16672&%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
16673the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
16674sometimes true and sometimes false).
16675
16676.cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
16677Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
16678qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
16679delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
16680In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
16681&-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
16682to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
16683&%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
16684
16685&*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
16686this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
16687only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
16688no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
16689a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
16690duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
16691duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
16692&<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
16693so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
16694&%redirect%& router may be of help.
16695
16696Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
16697&%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
16698subsequent routers.
16699
16700
16701.option user routers string&!! "see below"
16702.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
16703.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16704.cindex "transport" "local"
16705.cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
16706.cindex "filter" "user for processing"
16707When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
16708specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
16709The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
16710error is logged and delivery is deferred.
16711This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
16712The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
16713the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
16714a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
16715See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
16716&<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16717
16718
16719
16720.option verify routers&!? boolean true
16721Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
16722&%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
16723
16724
16725.option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
16726.cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
16727.oindex "&%-bv%&"
16728.cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
16729If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address or
16730testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
16731with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
16732restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
16733&%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
16734
16735&*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
16736SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
16737accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
16738user or group.
16739
16740
16741.option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
16742If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
16743addresses
16744or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
16745See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16746are evaluated.
16747
16748
16749.option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
16750If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
16751or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
16752See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16753are evaluated.
16754.ecindex IIDgenoprou1
16755.ecindex IIDgenoprou2
16756
16757
16758
16759
16760
16761
16762. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16763. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16764
16765.chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
16766.cindex "&(accept)& router"
16767.cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
16768The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
16769used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
16770be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
16771specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
16772it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
16773up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
16774.code
16775localusers:
16776 driver = accept
16777 domains = mydomain.example
16778 check_local_user
16779 transport = local_delivery
16780.endd
16781The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
16782&%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
16783When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
16784address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
16785
16786
16787
16788
16789
16790
16791. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16792. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16793
16794.chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
16795.scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
16796.scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
16797The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
16798recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
16799unless &%verify_only%& is set.
16800
16801If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
16802SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
16803MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
16804However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
16805records.
16806
16807MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
16808looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
16809When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
16810except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
16811IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
16812generic option, the router declines.
16813
16814Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
16815to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
16816are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
16817
16818.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
16819.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
16820.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
16821If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
16822address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
16823happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
16824
16825
16826.section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
16827There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
16828Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
16829SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
16830MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
16831problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
16832
16833For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
16834&%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
16835&(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
16836an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
16837domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
16838such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
16839proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
16840look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
16841case routing fails.
16842
16843
16844
16845
16846.section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
16847.cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
16848The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
16849
16850.option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
16851.cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
16852If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
16853(and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
16854process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
16855differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
16856the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
16857
16858
16859.option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
16860.cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
16861The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
16862addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
16863enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
16864required. For example,
16865.code
16866check_srv = smtp
16867.endd
16868looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
16869expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
16870to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
16871submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
16872option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
16873normal way.
16874
16875When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
16876the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
16877host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
16878this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
16879SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
16880according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
16881
16882When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
16883the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
16884records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
16885this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
16886defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
16887and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
16888have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
16889trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
16890
16891See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
16892when there is a DNS lookup error.
16893
16894
16895
16896.option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16897.cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
16898.cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
16899A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
16900record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
16901For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
16902records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
16903setting:
16904.code
16905mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
16906.endd
16907This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
16908has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
16909the address record.
16910
16911
16912.option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16913If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
16914DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
16915&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
16916
16917
16918
16919
16920.option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
16921.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16922.cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
16923When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
16924lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
16925single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
16926called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
16927&'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
16928resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
16929&'resolv.conf'&.
16930
16931
16932
16933.option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
16934.cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
16935.cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
16936If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
16937qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
16938an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
16939expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
16940occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
16941&%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
16942any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
16943header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
16944
16945This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
16946ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
16947sense.
16948
16949When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
16950servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
16951making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
16952some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
16953name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
16954header rewriting.
16955
16956
16957.option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
16958.cindex "address" "copying routing"
16959Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
16960to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
16961options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
16962default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
16963servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
16964any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
16965
16966If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
16967domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
16968local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
16969lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
16970routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
16971message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
16972without processing them independently,
16973provided the following conditions are met:
16974
16975.ilist
16976No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
16977&%headers_remove%&.
16978.next
16979The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
16980the domain.
16981.endlist
16982
16983
16984
16985
16986.option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
16987.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16988When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
16989lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
16990applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
16991the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
16992domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
16993up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
16994&'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
16995actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
16996
16997Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
16998record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
16999local wildcard.
17000
17001
17002
17003.option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17004If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
17005DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
17006&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
17007
17008
17009
17010
17011.option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
17012.cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
17013If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
17014added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
17015if
17016.code
17017widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
17018.endd
17019is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
17020&'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
17021&'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
17022and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
17023the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
17024when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
17025
17026
17027.section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
17028When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
17029of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
17030corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
17031is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
17032
17033These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
17034for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
17035such as that implied by
17036.code
17037domains = @mx_any
17038.endd
17039that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
17040entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
17041.ecindex IIDdnsrou1
17042.ecindex IIDdnsrou2
17043
17044
17045
17046
17047
17048
17049
17050
17051
17052. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17053. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17054
17055.chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
17056.cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
17057.cindex "domain literal" "routing"
17058.cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
17059This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
17060verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
17061generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
17062takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
17063router handles the address
17064.code
17065root@[192.168.1.1]
17066.endd
17067by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
17068consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
17069are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
17070.code
17071postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
17072.endd
17073Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
17074grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
17075
17076.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
17077If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
17078declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
17079&%self%& option determines what happens.
17080
17081The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
17082controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
17083also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
17084Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
17085
17086
17087
17088. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17089. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17090
17091.chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
17092.cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
17093.cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
17094The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
17095Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
17096not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
17097must set
17098.code
17099ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
17100.endd
17101in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
17102
17103The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
17104connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
17105a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
17106message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
17107this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
17108can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
17109must not be specified for it.
17110
17111.cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
17112.option hosts iplookup string unset
17113This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
17114names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
17115(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
17116and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
17117happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
17118
17119
17120.option optional iplookup boolean false
17121If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
17122is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
17123delivery to the address is deferred.
17124
17125
17126.option port iplookup integer 0
17127.cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
17128This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
17129call.
17130
17131
17132.option protocol iplookup string udp
17133This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
17134protocols is to be used.
17135
17136
17137.option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
17138This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
17139default value is:
17140.code
17141$local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
17142.endd
17143The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
17144query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
17145
17146
17147.option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
17148If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
17149returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
17150string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
17151in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
17152&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
17153whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
17154up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
17155
17156
17157.option response_pattern iplookup string unset
17158This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
17159returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
17160router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
17161response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
17162check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
17163address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
17164the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
17165following could be used:
17166.code
17167response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
17168reroute = $local_part@$1
17169.endd
17170
17171.option timeout iplookup time 5s
17172This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
17173machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
17174call. It does not apply to UDP.
17175
17176
17177
17178
17179. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17180. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17181
17182.chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
17183.scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
17184.scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
17185.cindex "domain" "manually routing"
17186The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
17187routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
17188route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
17189normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
17190route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
17191messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
17192
17193The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
17194it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
17195has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
17196include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
17197&"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
17198generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
17199being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
17200
17201.vindex "&$host$&"
17202In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
17203router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
17204an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
17205transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
17206with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
17207passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
17208host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
17209text string.
17210
17211The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
17212&%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
17213or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
17214any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
17215below, following the list of private options.
17216
17217
17218.section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
17219
17220.cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
17221The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
17222
17223.option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
17224See &%host_find_failed%&.
17225
17226.option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
17227This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
17228address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
17229of the following values:
17230.code
17231decline
17232defer
17233fail
17234freeze
17235ignore
17236pass
17237.endd
17238The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
17239error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
17240forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
17241&%pass_router%&),
17242.oindex "&%more%&"
17243overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
17244router only if &%more%& is true.
17245
17246The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
17247cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
17248controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
17249as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
17250
17251The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
17252state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
17253generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
17254
17255
17256.option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
17257.cindex "randomized host list"
17258.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
17259If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
17260is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
17261overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
17262crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
17263same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
17264(even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
17265deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
17266
17267When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
17268into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
17269set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
17270item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
17271.code
17272route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
17273.endd
17274The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
17275randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
17276If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
17277randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
17278&%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
17279
17280
17281.option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
17282If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
17283Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
17284example:
17285.code
17286route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
17287.endd
17288If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
17289router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
17290deferred.
17291
17292
17293.option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
17294This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
17295unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
17296that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
17297
17298
17299.option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
17300.cindex "address" "copying routing"
17301Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
17302router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
17303router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17304default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17305servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17306any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17307
17308If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17309domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
17310local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17311lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
17312&(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
17313addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
17314same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
17315if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
17316
17317
17318
17319
17320.section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
17321The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
17322rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
17323entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
17324described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17325Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
17326.display
17327<&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
17328.endd
17329The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
17330no options:
17331.code
17332route_list = \
17333 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
17334 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17335.endd
17336The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
17337list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
17338usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
17339single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
17340pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
17341&<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
17342except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
17343That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
17344lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
17345in a &%route_list%&).
17346
17347The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
17348matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
17349then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
17350&%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
17351
17352
17353
17354.section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
17355The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
17356routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
17357hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
17358The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
17359Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
17360expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
17361like this:
17362.code
17363dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
17364thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17365.endd
17366This data can be accessed by setting
17367.code
17368route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
17369.endd
17370Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
17371decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
17372requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
17373possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
17374be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
17375
17376
17377
17378
17379.section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
17380A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
17381always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
17382declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
17383and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
17384in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
17385as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17386
17387If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
17388variables are set during its expansion:
17389
17390.ilist
17391.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17392If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
17393&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
17394.code
17395route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
17396.endd
17397.next
17398&$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
17399.next
17400&$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
17401
17402.next
17403.vindex "&$value$&"
17404If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
17405looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
17406.code
17407route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
17408.endd
17409.endlist
17410
17411Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
17412semicolon is the default route list separator.
17413
17414
17415
17416.section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
17417Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
17418optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
17419is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
17420specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
17421by a colon. This leads to some complications:
17422
17423.ilist
17424Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
17425the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
17426be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
17427.code
17428route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
17429route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
17430.endd
17431.next
17432When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
17433colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
17434enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
17435number follows. For example:
17436.code
17437route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
17438.endd
17439.endlist
17440
17441.section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
17442When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
17443the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
17444delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
17445option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
17446transport.
17447
17448Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
17449hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
17450interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
17451records in the DNS. For example:
17452.code
17453route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
17454.endd
17455If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
17456example:
17457.code
17458route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
17459.endd
17460If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
17461randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
17462that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
17463be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
17464Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
17465happens is controlled by the
17466.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17467&%self%& option of the router.
17468
17469A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
17470hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
17471lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
17472below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
17473preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
17474randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
17475defined by MX preferences.
17476
17477If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
17478not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
17479preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
17480
17481If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
17482depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
17483is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
17484Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
17485
17486If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
17487most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
17488router.
17489
17490DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
17491failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
17492&%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
17493
17494The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
17495whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
17496
17497
17498
17499.section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
17500The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
17501present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
17502&%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
17503other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
17504per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
17505routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
17506
17507.ilist
17508&%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
17509setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17510.next
17511&%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
17512overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17513.next
17514&%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
17515find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
17516also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
17517.next
17518&%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
17519no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
17520timeout), delivery is deferred.
17521.endlist
17522
17523For example:
17524.code
17525route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
17526 domain2 host4:host5
17527.endd
17528If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
17529DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
17530result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
17531or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
17532call.
17533
17534&*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
17535called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
17536instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
17537lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
17538function called.
17539
17540
17541
17542If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
17543&%host_find_failed%& option.
17544
17545.vindex "&$host$&"
17546When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
17547The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
17548
17549
17550
17551.section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
17552In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
17553transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
17554
17555.ilist
17556.cindex "smart host" "example router"
17557The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
17558&'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
17559named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
17560.code
17561domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
17562.endd
17563You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
17564your first router something like this:
17565.code
17566smart_route:
17567 driver = manualroute
17568 domains = !+local_domains
17569 transport = remote_smtp
17570 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
17571.endd
17572This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
17573&'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
17574they are tried in order
17575(but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
17576Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
17577.code
17578smart_route:
17579 driver = manualroute
17580 transport = remote_smtp
17581 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
17582.endd
17583There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
17584However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
17585example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
17586precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
17587always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
17588would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
17589always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
17590&%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
17591
17592.next
17593.cindex "mail hub example"
17594A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
17595records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
17596the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
17597machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
17598&(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
17599to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
17600using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
17601lookup is easier to manage.
17602
17603If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
17604to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
17605example:
17606.code
17607hub_route:
17608 driver = manualroute
17609 transport = remote_smtp
17610 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
17611.endd
17612This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
17613whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
17614if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
17615that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
17616domain can be used to find the host:
17617.code
17618through_firewall:
17619 driver = manualroute
17620 transport = remote_smtp
17621 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
17622.endd
17623The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
17624hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
17625data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
17626next router.
17627
17628.next
17629.cindex "batched SMTP output example"
17630.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
17631You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
17632SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
17633storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
17634can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
17635.code
17636save_in_file:
17637 driver = manualroute
17638 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
17639 route_list = saved.domain.example
17640.endd
17641though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
17642several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
17643different transports can be listed in the routing information:
17644.code
17645save_in_file:
17646 driver = manualroute
17647 route_list = \
17648 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
17649 *.saved.domain2.example \
17650 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
17651 batch_pipe
17652.endd
17653.vindex "&$domain$&"
17654.vindex "&$host$&"
17655The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
17656doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
17657file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
17658the address if the lookup fails.
17659
17660.next
17661.cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
17662Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
17663&(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
17664one way it can be done:
17665.code
17666# Transport
17667uucp:
17668 driver = pipe
17669 user = nobody
17670 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
17671 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
17672 return_fail_output = true
17673
17674# Router
17675uucphost:
17676 transport = uucp
17677 driver = manualroute
17678 route_data = \
17679 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
17680.endd
17681The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
17682.code
17683darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
17684.endd
17685It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
17686makes clear the distinction between the domain name
17687&'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
17688.endlist
17689.ecindex IIDmanrou1
17690.ecindex IIDmanrou2
17691
17692
17693
17694
17695
17696
17697
17698
17699. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17700. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17701
17702.chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
17703.scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
17704.scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
17705.cindex "routing" "by external program"
17706The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
17707and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
17708mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
17709However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
17710&%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
17711be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
17712options:
17713.cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
17714
17715.option command queryprogram string&!! unset
17716This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
17717command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
17718expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
17719&<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
17720
17721
17722.option command_group queryprogram string unset
17723.cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
17724This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
17725address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
17726uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
17727gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
17728
17729
17730.option command_user queryprogram string unset
17731.cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
17732This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
17733command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
17734it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
17735using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
17736not set, a value for the gid also.
17737
17738&*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
17739root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
17740However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
17741usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
17742is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
17743the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
17744gid.
17745
17746
17747.option current_directory queryprogram string /
17748This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
17749before running the command.
17750
17751
17752.option timeout queryprogram time 1h
17753If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
17754is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
17755timeout.
17756
17757
17758The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
17759the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
17760containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
17761the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
17762field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
17763
17764.ilist
17765&'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
17766below).
17767.next
17768&'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
17769&%no_more%& is set.
17770.next
17771&'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
17772subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
17773of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
17774included in the SMTP response.
17775.next
17776&'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
17777subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
17778included in any SMTP response.
17779.next
17780&'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
17781.next
17782&'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
17783&%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
17784.next
17785&'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
17786new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
17787or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
17788.endlist
17789
17790When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
17791number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
17792the page):
17793.code
17794ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
17795LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
17796.endd
17797The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
17798is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
17799used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
17800an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
17801
17802The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
17803As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
17804in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
17805&`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
17806(see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
17807
17808If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
17809find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
17810anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
17811goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
17812result of the lookup is the result of that call.
17813
17814.vindex "&$address_data$&"
17815If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
17816variable. For example, this return line
17817.code
17818accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
17819.endd
17820routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
17821the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
17822.ecindex IIDquerou1
17823.ecindex IIDquerou2
17824
17825
17826
17827
17828. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17829. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17830
17831.chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
17832.scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
17833.scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
17834.cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
17835.cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
17836The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
17837common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
17838(usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
17839files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
17840redirected in several different ways:
17841
17842.ilist
17843It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
17844independently.
17845.next
17846It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
17847.next
17848It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
17849.next
17850It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
17851.next
17852It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
17853.next
17854It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
17855.next
17856It can be discarded.
17857.endlist
17858
17859The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
17860However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
17861files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
17862&%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
17863
17864
17865
17866.section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
17867The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
17868expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
17869contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
17870options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
17871aliases, in a configuration like this:
17872.code
17873system_aliases:
17874 driver = redirect
17875 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
17876.endd
17877If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
17878expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
17879expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
17880cause delivery to be deferred.
17881
17882A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
17883&_.forward_& files, like this:
17884.code
17885userforward:
17886 driver = redirect
17887 check_local_user
17888 file = $home/.forward
17889 no_verify
17890.endd
17891If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
17892empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
17893is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
17894yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
17895comments.
17896
17897
17898
17899.section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
17900.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
17901It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
17902&_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
17903
17904.ilist
17905When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
17906running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
17907the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
17908practice the router may not be able to operate.
17909.next
17910However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
17911is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
17912local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
17913saves some resources.
17914.endlist
17915
17916
17917
17918
17919
17920
17921.section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
17922.cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
17923.cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
17924The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
17925can be interpreted in two different ways:
17926
17927.ilist
17928If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
17929&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
17930&'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
17931respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
17932in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
17933document is intended for use by end users.
17934.next
17935Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
17936described in the next section.
17937.endlist
17938
17939When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
17940in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
17941generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
17942configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
17943for the &(appendfile)& transport.
17944
17945
17946
17947.section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
17948.cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
17949When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
17950comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
17951addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
17952&<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
17953disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
17954depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
17955commas or newlines.
17956If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
17957quotes.
17958
17959Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
17960also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
17961next newline character is ignored.
17962
17963If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
17964double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
17965(but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
17966&"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
17967removed.
17968
17969.vindex "&$local_part$&"
17970&*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
17971and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
17972of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
17973special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
17974&'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
17975setting:
17976.code
17977data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
17978.endd
17979
17980
17981.section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
17982.cindex "routing" "loops in"
17983.cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
17984.cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
17985A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
17986consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
17987automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
17988is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
17989Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
17990as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
17991complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
17992
17993.cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
17994Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
17995filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
17996mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
17997&'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
17998.code
17999cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
18000.endd
18001.cindex "backslash in alias file"
18002.cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
18003For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
18004preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
18005it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
18006synonymously.
18007
18008If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
180092822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
18010domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
18011addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
18012force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
18013
18014Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
18015Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
18016contains:
18017.code
18018Sam.Reman: spqr
18019.endd
18020Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
18021messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
18022this forward file:
18023.code
18024Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
18025.endd
18026With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
18027&(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
18028second time round, because it has previously routed it,
18029and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
18030should really contain
18031.code
18032spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
18033.endd
18034but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
18035below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
18036&(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
18037
18038
18039
18040.section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
18041In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
18042lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
18043
18044.ilist
18045.cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
18046.cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
18047An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
18048as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
18049command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
18050Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
18051which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
18052
18053Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
18054the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
18055the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
18056in double quotes, for example:
18057.code
18058"|/some/command ready,steady,go"
18059.endd
18060since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
18061quote just the command. An item such as
18062.code
18063|"/some/command ready,steady,go"
18064.endd
18065is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
18066
18067.next
18068.cindex "file" "in redirection list"
18069.cindex "address redirection" "to file"
18070An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
18071parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
18072.code
18073/home/world/minbari
18074.endd
18075is treated as a file name, but
18076.code
18077/s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
18078.endd
18079is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
18080the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
18081forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
18082file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
18083
18084Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
18085which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
18086
18087.cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
18088However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
18089bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
18090instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
18091
18092.next
18093.cindex "included address list"
18094.cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
18095If an item is of the form
18096.code
18097:include:<path name>
18098.endd
18099a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
18100point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
18101out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
18102by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
18103item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
18104the alias name. This example is incorrect:
18105.code
18106list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
18107.endd
18108It must be given as
18109.code
18110list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
18111.endd
18112.next
18113.cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
18114Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
18115&%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
18116the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
18117.cindex "black hole"
18118.cindex "abandoning mail"
18119&':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
18120done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
18121&_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
18122
18123&*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
18124delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
18125are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
18126database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
18127&_/dev/null_&.
18128
18129.next
18130.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
18131.cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
18132.cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
18133.cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
18134.cindex "customizing" "failure message"
18135An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
18136redirection items of the form
18137.code
18138:defer:
18139:fail:
18140.endd
18141respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
18142to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
18143text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
18144associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
18145.code
18146X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
18147.endd
18148In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
18149of a
18150.cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
18151VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
18152default.
18153.cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
18154The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
18155the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
18156
18157.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18158By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
18159&':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
18160space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
18161followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
18162code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
18163incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
18164suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
18165&%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
18166ignored.
18167
18168.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
18169In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
18170default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
18171therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
18172
18173Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
18174not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
18175normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
18176as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
18177lookup and in &':include:'& files.
18178
18179During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
18180containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
18181whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
18182subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
18183deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
18184rules still apply.
18185
18186.next
18187.cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
18188Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
18189chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
18190for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
18191&':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
18192router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
18193results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
18194.endlist
18195
18196
18197.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
18198.cindex "duplicate addresses"
18199.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
18200.cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
18201Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
18202to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
18203routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
18204aliasing scheme of the type
18205.code
18206pipe: |/some/command $local_part
18207localpart1: pipe
18208localpart2: pipe
18209.endd
18210does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
18211when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
18212discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
18213such as
18214.code
18215localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
18216localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
18217.endd
18218does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
18219the pipes are distinct.
18220
18221
18222
18223.section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
18224.cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
18225.cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
18226When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
18227leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
18228afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
18229delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
18230members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
18231can be used to avoid this.
18232
18233
18234.section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
18235.cindex "address redirection" "errors"
18236If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
18237error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
18238for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
18239detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
18240deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
18241
18242
18243
18244.section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
18245
18246.cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
18247The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
18248
18249
18250.option allow_defer redirect boolean false
18251Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
18252data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
18253
18254
18255.option allow_fail redirect boolean false
18256.cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
18257If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
18258and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
18259
18260
18261.option allow_filter redirect boolean false
18262.cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
18263.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
18264Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
18265&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
18266are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
18267lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
18268
18269It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
18270the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
18271
18272
18273The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
18274&%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
18275&%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
18276files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
18277true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
18278
18279
18280
18281.option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
18282.cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
18283Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
18284This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
18285default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
18286let ordinary users do.
18287
18288
18289
18290.option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
18291This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
18292as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
18293Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
18294configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
18295for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
18296
18297When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
18298is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
18299the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
18300and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
18301domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
18302&_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
18303.code
18304\Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
18305.endd
18306Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
18307&"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
18308originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
18309(having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
18310&"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
18311&%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
18312file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
18313original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
18314
18315
18316.option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
18317When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
18318when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
18319&%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
18320&%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
18321deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
18322is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
18323&%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
18324
18325
18326
18327.option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
18328When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
18329this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
18330permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
18331option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
18332&%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
18333
18334
18335.option data redirect string&!! unset
18336This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
18337set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
18338list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
18339expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
18340has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
18341
18342When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
18343filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
18344terminated with newline characters. For example:
18345.code
18346data = #Exim filter\n\
18347 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
18348.endd
18349If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
18350you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
18351choice into a newline.
18352
18353
18354.option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
18355A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
18356ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18357specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18358configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
18359
18360
18361.option file redirect string&!! unset
18362This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
18363is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
18364use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
18365failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
18366must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
18367data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
18368entirely of comments), the router declines.
18369
18370.cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
18371If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
18372runs a check on the containing directory,
18373unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
18374If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
18375happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
18376is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
18377not, the router declines.
18378
18379
18380.option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
18381.vindex "&$address_file$&"
18382A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
18383ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18384specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18385configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
18386it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
18387
18388
18389.option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
18390When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
18391relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
18392relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
18393relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
18394
18395
18396.option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
18397If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
18398redirection list.
18399
18400
18401.option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
18402If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
18403&%allow_filter%& is true.
18404
18405
18406
18407
18408.option forbid_file redirect boolean false
18409.cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
18410.cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
18411.cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
18412If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
18413specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
18414conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
18415set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
18416locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
18417
18418
18419.option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
18420.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
18421If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18422make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
18423functions.
18424
18425.option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
18426.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
18427If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18428make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
18429
18430.option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
18431If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
18432permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
18433under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
18434&_.forward_& files).
18435
18436
18437.option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
18438If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18439to make use of &%lookup%& items.
18440
18441
18442.option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
18443This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
18444it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
18445of the embedded Perl support.
18446
18447
18448.option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
18449If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18450to make use of &%readfile%& items.
18451
18452
18453.option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
18454If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18455to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
18456
18457
18458.option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
18459If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
18460message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
18461files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
18462&%one_time%& is set.
18463
18464
18465.option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
18466If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18467to make use of &%run%& items.
18468
18469
18470.option forbid_include redirect boolean false
18471If this option is true, items of the form
18472.code
18473:include:<path name>
18474.endd
18475are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
18476
18477
18478.option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
18479.cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
18480If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
18481specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
18482forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
18483
18484
18485.option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
18486If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
18487&%allow_filter%& is true.
18488
18489
18490.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18491.option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
18492If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
18493of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
18494the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
18495
18496
18497
18498
18499.option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
18500.cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
18501If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
18502generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
18503generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
18504bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
18505bounce may well quote the generated address.
18506
18507
18508.option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
18509.cindex "EACCES"
18510If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18511EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
18512file did not exist.
18513
18514
18515.option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
18516.cindex "ENOTDIR"
18517If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18518ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
18519router behaves as if the file did not exist.
18520
18521Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
18522router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
18523(the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
18524against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
18525is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
18526is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
18527a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
18528that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
18529
18530
18531
18532.option include_directory redirect string unset
18533If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
18534redirection list must start with this directory.
18535
18536
18537.option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
18538This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
18539&%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
18540
18541
18542.option one_time redirect boolean false
18543.cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
18544.cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
18545.cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
18546.cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
18547.cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
18548Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
18549files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
18550of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
18551is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
18552but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
18553message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
18554lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
18555before they subscribed.
18556
18557If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
18558deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
18559&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
18560&"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
18561attempt.
18562
18563&*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
18564router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
18565reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
18566permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
18567
18568&*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
18569to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
18570and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
18571
18572&*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
18573&%one_time%&.
18574
18575The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
18576addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
18577addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
18578&%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
18579typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
18580expansion.
18581
18582
18583.option owners redirect "string list" unset
18584.cindex "ownership" "alias file"
18585.cindex "ownership" "forward file"
18586.cindex "alias file" "ownership"
18587.cindex "forward file" "ownership"
18588This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
18589This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
18590See &%check_owner%& above.
18591
18592
18593.option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
18594This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
18595The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
18596&%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
18597
18598
18599.option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
18600.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
18601A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
18602starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
18603transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
18604name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
18605When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
18606
18607
18608.option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
18609.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
18610If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
18611generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
18612in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
18613expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
18614to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
18615&$qualify_recipient$&.
18616
18617This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
18618but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
18619not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
18620addresses.
18621
18622.option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
18623.cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
18624.cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
18625.cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
18626If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
18627set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
18628without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
18629address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
18630&%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
18631this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
18632
18633
18634.option repeat_use redirect boolean true
18635If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
18636any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
18637the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
18638only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
18639&%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
18640
18641
18642.option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
18643A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
18644&%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
18645by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
18646transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
18647are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
18648
18649
18650.option rewrite redirect boolean true
18651.cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
18652If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
18653subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
18654and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
18655
18656
18657.option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
18658The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
18659:subaddress part of an address.
18660
18661.option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
18662The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
18663of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
18664(including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
18665
18666
18667.option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
18668.cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
18669To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
18670&%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
18671(do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
18672&%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
18673needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
18674
18675
18676
18677.option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
18678.cindex "forward file" "broken"
18679.cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
18680.cindex "alias file" "broken"
18681.cindex "broken alias or forward files"
18682.cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
18683.cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
18684.cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
18685If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
18686non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
18687&%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
18688giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
18689are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
18690&%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
18691be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
18692&%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
18693
18694If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
18695errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
18696the following routers.
18697
18698If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
18699error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
18700taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
18701so it is passed to the following routers.
18702
18703.cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
18704Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
18705action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
18706&%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
18707
18708&%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
18709lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
18710option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
18711notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
18712.code
18713userforward:
18714 driver = redirect
18715 allow_filter
18716 check_local_user
18717 file = $home/.forward
18718 file_transport = address_file
18719 pipe_transport = address_pipe
18720 reply_transport = address_reply
18721 no_verify
18722 skip_syntax_errors
18723 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
18724 syntax_errors_text = \
18725 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
18726 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
18727 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
18728 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
18729 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
18730 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
18731 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
18732 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
18733 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
18734 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
18735.endd
18736You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
18737&`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
18738put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
18739.code
18740real_localuser:
18741 driver = accept
18742 check_local_user
18743 local_part_prefix = real-
18744 transport = local_delivery
18745.endd
18746For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18747router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18748.code
18749 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18750 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18751.endd
18752
18753
18754.option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
18755See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
18756
18757
18758.option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
18759See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
18760.ecindex IIDredrou1
18761.ecindex IIDredrou2
18762
18763
18764
18765
18766
18767
18768. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18769. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18770
18771.chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
18772 "Environment for local transports"
18773.scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
18774.scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
18775.scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
18776Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
18777transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
18778in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
18779mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
18780
18781Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
18782some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
18783transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
18784&<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
18785
18786The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
18787different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
18788settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
18789or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
18790configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
18791
18792
18793
18794.section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
18795.cindex "concurrent deliveries"
18796.cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
18797If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
18798simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
18799the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
18800rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
18801time.
18802
18803However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
18804locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
18805.code
18806my_transport:
18807 driver = pipe
18808 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
18809.endd
18810This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
18811messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
18812&%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
18813file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
18814
18815
18816
18817
18818.section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
18819.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18820.cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
18821All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
18822overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
18823set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
18824delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
18825group (set by the transport). For example:
18826.code
18827# Routers ...
18828# User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
18829local_users:
18830 driver = accept
18831 check_local_user
18832 transport = group_delivery
18833
18834# Transports ...
18835# This transport overrides the group
18836group_delivery:
18837 driver = appendfile
18838 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
18839 group = mail
18840.endd
18841If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
18842address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
18843gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
18844set.
18845
18846.oindex "&%initgroups%&"
18847When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
18848function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
18849&%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
18850by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
18851for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
18852
18853.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
18854The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
18855is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
18856receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
18857original gid is also used.
18858
18859This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
18860following that is set is used:
18861
18862.ilist
18863A &%group%& setting of the transport;
18864.next
18865A &%group%& setting of the router;
18866.next
18867A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
18868&%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
18869.next
18870The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
18871.next
18872In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
18873the uid is the creator's uid;
18874.next
18875The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
18876.endlist
18877
18878If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
18879no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
18880This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
18881The first of the following that is set is used:
18882
18883.ilist
18884A &%user%& setting of the transport;
18885.next
18886In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
18887.next
18888A &%user%& setting of the router;
18889.next
18890A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
18891.next
18892The Exim uid.
18893.endlist
18894
18895Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
18896&%never_users%& list.
18897
18898
18899
18900
18901
18902.section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
18903.cindex "current directory for local transport"
18904.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18905.cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
18906.cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
18907Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
18908the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
18909However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
18910are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
18911for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
18912
18913.ilist
18914The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18915.next
18916The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18917.next
18918The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18919.next
18920The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18921.endlist
18922
18923The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
18924
18925.ilist
18926The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
18927.next
18928The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
18929.endlist
18930
18931
18932If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
18933value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
18934directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
18935
18936
18937
18938.section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
18939.vindex "&$domain$&"
18940.vindex "&$local_part$&"
18941.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
18942Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
18943variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
18944deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
18945at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
18946other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
18947never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
18948and &$original_domain$& is never set.
18949.ecindex IIDenvlotra1
18950.ecindex IIDenvlotra2
18951.ecindex IIDenvlotra3
18952
18953
18954
18955
18956
18957
18958
18959. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18960. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18961
18962.chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
18963.scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
18964.scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
18965.scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
18966The following generic options apply to all transports:
18967
18968
18969.option body_only transports boolean false
18970.cindex "transport" "body only"
18971.cindex "message" "transporting body only"
18972.cindex "body of message" "transporting"
18973If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
18974mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
18975or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
18976&%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
18977automatically suppress them.
18978
18979
18980.option current_directory transports string&!! unset
18981.cindex "transport" "current directory for"
18982This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
18983transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
18984If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18985logged, and delivery is deferred.
18986
18987
18988.option disable_logging transports boolean false
18989If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
18990deliveries by the transport or for any
18991transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
18992what you are doing.
18993
18994
18995.option debug_print transports string&!! unset
18996.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18997If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18998option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
18999transport is run.
19000If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
19001output, and Exim carries on processing.
19002This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
19003so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
19004option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
19005variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
19006one.
19007
19008
19009.option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
19010.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
19011If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
19012This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
19013header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
19014requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
19015safely be resent to other recipients.
19016
19017
19018.option driver transports string unset
19019This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
19020There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
19021
19022
19023.option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
19024.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19025If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
19026This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
19027delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
19028configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
19029address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
19030header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
19031its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
19032resent to other recipients.
19033
19034
19035.option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
19036.cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
19037This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
19038value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
19039&%user%& (see below).
19040
19041
19042.option headers_add transports string&!! unset
19043.cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
19044.cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
19045This option specifies a string of text that is expanded and added to the header
19046portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
19047&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
19048routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
19049is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
19050errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
19051
19052
19053
19054.option headers_only transports boolean false
19055.cindex "transport" "header lines only"
19056.cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
19057.cindex "header lines" "transporting"
19058If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
19059exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
19060transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
19061checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
19062
19063
19064.option headers_remove transports string&!! unset
19065.cindex "header lines" "removing"
19066.cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
19067This option specifies a string that is expanded into a list of header names;
19068these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
19069in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
19070routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
19071is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
19072errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
19073
19074
19075
19076.option headers_rewrite transports string unset
19077.cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
19078.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
19079This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
19080that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
19081option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
19082the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
19083message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
19084example,
19085.code
19086headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
19087 x@y w@z
19088.endd
19089changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
19090&'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
19091header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
19092only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
19093the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
19094filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
19095affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
19096envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
19097change envelope recipients at this time.
19098
19099
19100.option home_directory transports string&!! unset
19101.cindex "transport" "home directory for"
19102.vindex "&$home$&"
19103This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
19104overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
19105placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
19106used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
19107&%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
19108&%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
19109for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
19110deferred.
19111
19112
19113.option initgroups transports boolean false
19114.cindex "additional groups"
19115.cindex "groups" "additional"
19116.cindex "transport" "group; additional"
19117If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
19118transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
19119to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
19120
19121
19122.option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
19123.cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
19124.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
19125.cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
19126This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
19127expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
19128digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
19129including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
19130delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
19131message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
19132the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
19133ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
19134&%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
19135delivered.
19136
19137
19138
19139.option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
19140.cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
19141.cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
19142.cindex "local part" "prefix"
19143.cindex "local part" "suffix"
19144When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
19145affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
19146form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
19147that contains
19148.code
19149local_part_prefix = *-
19150.endd
19151routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
19152is delivered with
19153.code
19154RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
19155.endd
19156This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
19157recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
19158whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
19159deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
19160&(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
19161
19162
19163.option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
19164.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19165When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
19166in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
19167is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
19168deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
19169part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
19170temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
19171deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
19172
19173However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
19174as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
19175(For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
19176this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
19177
19178For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
19179the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
19180on a remote transport in the current implementation.
19181
19182
19183.option return_path transports string&!! unset
19184.cindex "envelope sender"
19185.cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
19186.cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
19187If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
19188the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
19189that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
19190designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
19191SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
19192only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
19193header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
19194
19195&*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
19196&%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
19197
19198.vindex "&$return_path$&"
19199The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
19200either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
19201&%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
19202replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
19203option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
19204section &<<SECTverp>>&.
19205
19206&*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
19207remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
19208the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
19209This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
19210&%errors_to%& in a router.
19211
19212
19213
19214.option return_path_add transports boolean false
19215.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
19216If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
19217Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
19218mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
19219have easy access to it.
19220
19221RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
19222the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
19223header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
19224option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
19225incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
19226recipients.
19227
19228
19229.option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
19230See &%shadow_transport%& below.
19231
19232
19233.option shadow_transport transports string unset
19234.cindex "shadow transport"
19235.cindex "transport" "shadow"
19236A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
19237another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
19238
19239Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
19240&%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
19241string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
19242passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
19243expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
19244cause a log line to be written.
19245
19246The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
19247subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
19248provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
19249is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
19250ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
19251of the form
19252.code
19253ST=<shadow transport name>
19254.endd
19255If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
19256parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
19257purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
19258provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
19259headers that some sites insist on.
19260
19261
19262.option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
19263.cindex "transport" "filter"
19264.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
19265This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
19266at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
19267individual users or via a system filter.
19268
19269When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
19270&%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
19271the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
19272input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
19273command must be specified as an absolute path.
19274
19275The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
19276terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
19277SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
19278lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
19279settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
19280&(pipe)& transports.
19281
19282The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
19283standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
19284destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
19285filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
19286are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
19287
19288The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
19289care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
19290test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
19291SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
19292
19293.cindex "content scanning" "per user"
19294A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
19295at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
19296message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
19297a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
19298not possible to discard a message at this stage.
19299
19300.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
19301A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
19302being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
19303support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
19304at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
19305more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
19306the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
19307additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
19308
19309.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19310The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
19311the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
19312parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
19313Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
19314section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
19315to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
19316of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
19317an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
19318&(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
19319
19320.vindex "&$host$&"
19321.vindex "&$host_address$&"
19322The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
19323transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
19324which the message is being sent. For example:
19325.code
19326transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
19327 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
19328.endd
19329
19330Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
19331generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
19332command is split up &'before'& expansion.
19333.ilist
19334If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
19335part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
19336expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
19337example:
19338.code
19339transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
19340.endd
19341This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
19342&(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
19343stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
19344the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
19345&`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
19346Exim tried to expand the first one.
19347.next
19348Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
19349expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
19350arguments. Consider this example:
19351.code
19352transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19353 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19354.endd
19355The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
19356if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
19357.code
19358transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19359 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19360.endd
19361.endlist
19362
19363The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
19364For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
19365normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
19366A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
19367serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
19368the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
19369bounced from a transport filter.
19370
19371If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
19372passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
19373message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
19374
19375
19376.option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
19377.cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
19378When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it a applies a timeout
19379that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
19380temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
19381&(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
19382way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
19383error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
19384becomes a temporary error.
19385
19386
19387.option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
19388.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19389.cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
19390This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
19391run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
19392given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
19393associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
19394option is not set.
19395
19396For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
19397specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
19398&%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
19399
19400.cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
19401For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
19402sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
19403to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
19404retry data.
19405.ecindex IIDgenoptra1
19406.ecindex IIDgenoptra2
19407.ecindex IIDgenoptra3
19408
19409
19410
19411
19412
19413
19414. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19415. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19416
19417.chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
19418 "Address batching"
19419.cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
19420The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
19421one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
19422remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
19423normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
19424transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
19425copy of the message is delivered each time.
19426
19427.cindex "batched local delivery"
19428.oindex "&%batch_max%&"
19429.oindex "&%batch_id%&"
19430In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
19431local transport, for example:
19432
19433.ilist
19434In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
19435delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
19436recipients saves space.
19437.next
19438In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
19439a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
19440.next
19441In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
19442to a scanner program or
19443to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
19444acceptable.
19445.endlist
19446
19447These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
19448(&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
19449repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
19450
19451The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
19452delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
19453(no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
19454&%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
19455(that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
19456to certain conditions:
19457
19458.ilist
19459.vindex "&$local_part$&"
19460If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
19461batching is possible.
19462.next
19463.vindex "&$domain$&"
19464If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
19465addresses with the same domain are batched.
19466.next
19467.cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
19468If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
19469addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
19470customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
19471including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
19472from taking place.
19473.next
19474Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
19475delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
19476group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
19477be the same.
19478.endlist
19479
19480In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
19481both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
19482is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
19483course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
19484option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
19485&"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
19486&%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
19487.code
19488check_string = "."
19489escape_string = ".."
19490.endd
19491when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
19492given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
19493&%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
19494
19495.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19496If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
19497&'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
19498that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
19499transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
19500addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
19501
19502.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
19503.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19504If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
19505transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
19506the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
19507of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
19508argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
19509delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
19510are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
19511
19512
19513
19514
19515. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19516. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19517
19518.chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
19519.scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
19520.scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
19521.cindex "directory creation"
19522.cindex "creating directories"
19523The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
19524file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
19525files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
19526format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
19527University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
19528being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
19529to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
19530delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
19531supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
19532directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
19533
19534The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
19535default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
19536SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
19537included.
19538
19539.cindex "quota" "system"
19540Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
19541also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
19542system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
19543
19544If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
19545partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
19546modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
19547creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
19548
19549Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
19550file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
19551private options.
19552
19553The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
19554users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
19555putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
19556&"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
19557option).
19558
19559
19560
19561.section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
19562The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
19563the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
19564the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
19565normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
19566
19567.vindex "&$address_file$&"
19568.vindex "&$local_part$&"
19569However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
19570directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
19571forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
19572user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
19573the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
19574name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
19575operation. There are two cases:
19576
19577.ilist
19578If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
19579must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
19580common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
19581different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
19582default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
19583name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
19584&%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
19585.next
19586If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
19587used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
19588contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
19589.endlist
19590
19591
19592.cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
19593.cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
19594As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
19595have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
19596form:
19597.code
19598save folder23
19599.endd
19600or Sieve filter commands of the form:
19601.code
19602require "fileinto";
19603fileinto "folder23";
19604.endd
19605In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
19606must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
19607case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
19608is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
19609way of handling this requirement:
19610.code
19611file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
19612 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
19613 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
19614 {$address_file} \
19615 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
19616 }} \
19617 }
19618.endd
19619With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
19620location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
19621&_mail_& directory within the home directory.
19622
19623&*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
19624&_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
19625the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
19626you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
19627&%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
19628path to the transport.
19629
19630&*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
19631the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
19632
19633
19634
19635
19636.section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
19637.cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
19638
19639
19640
19641.option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
19642.cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
19643.cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
19644.cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
19645Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
19646regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
19647delivery is deferred.
19648
19649
19650.option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
19651.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
19652.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
19653By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
19654that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
19655are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
19656what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
19657are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
19658
19659
19660.option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
19661See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
19662However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
19663happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
19664file.
19665
19666
19667.option batch_max appendfile integer 1
19668See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
19669
19670
19671.option check_group appendfile boolean false
19672When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
19673option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
19674delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
19675file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
19676
19677
19678.option check_owner appendfile boolean true
19679When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
19680is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
19681process is running.
19682
19683
19684.option check_string appendfile string "see below"
19685.cindex "&""From""& line"
19686As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
19687matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
19688replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
19689a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
19690contains is significant.
19691
19692If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
19693are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
19694configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
19695&">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
19696&%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
19697
19698The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
19699suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
19700&"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
19701if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
19702.cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
19703.cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
19704.code
19705check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19706escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
19707message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19708message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19709.endd
19710.option create_directory appendfile boolean true
19711.cindex "directory creation"
19712When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
19713directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
19714is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
19715
19716The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
19717operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
19718example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
19719is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
19720in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
19721
19722
19723
19724.option create_file appendfile string anywhere
19725This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
19726by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
19727directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
19728delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
19729beneath.
19730
19731The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
19732&"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
19733set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
19734given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
19735names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
19736by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
19737&%file_must_exist%&.
19738
19739
19740.option directory appendfile string&!! unset
19741This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
19742or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
19743redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
19744
19745When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
19746into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
19747appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
19748(see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
19749&<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
19750
19751
19752.option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
19753.cindex "base62"
19754.vindex "&$inode$&"
19755When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
19756&%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
19757whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
19758.code
19759q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
19760.endd
19761This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
19762inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
19763option.
19764
19765
19766.option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
19767If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
19768&%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
19769
19770
19771.option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
19772See &%check_string%& above.
19773
19774
19775.option file appendfile string&!! unset
19776This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
19777&%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
19778of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
19779specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
19780&%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
19781&%file%&.
19782
19783.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
19784.cindex "locking files"
19785.cindex "lock files"
19786If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
19787mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
19788
19789The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
19790path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
19791examples:
19792.code
19793file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
19794file = /home/$local_part/inbox
19795file = $home/inbox
19796.endd
19797.cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
19798In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
19799is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
19800create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
19801deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
19802run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
19803
19804
19805
19806.option file_format appendfile string unset
19807.cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
19808This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
19809before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
19810start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
19811colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
19812second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
19813string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
19814transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
19815this added to it:
19816.code
19817file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
19818 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
19819.endd
19820Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
19821a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
19822to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
19823to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
19824is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
19825match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
19826delivery is deferred.
19827
19828
19829.option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
19830If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
19831A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
19832If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
19833
19834
19835.option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
19836.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
19837.cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
19838.cindex "locking files"
19839By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
19840when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
19841sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
19842Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
19843for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
19844deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
19845mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
19846misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
19847
19848On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
19849not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
19850is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
19851and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
19852
19853If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
19854timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
19855retries is
19856.code
19857(lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
19858.endd
19859rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
19860which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
19861&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
19862
19863You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
19864local deliveries because of errors of the form
19865.code
19866failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
19867.endd
19868
19869.option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
19870This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
19871&%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
19872&%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
19873
19874
19875.option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
19876This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
19877for details of locking.
19878
19879
19880.option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
19881This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
19882is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
19883
19884
19885.option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
19886This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
19887used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
19888
19889
19890.option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
19891.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
19892When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
19893exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
19894accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
19895
19896
19897.option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
19898.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
19899.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
19900If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
19901number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
19902followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
19903external source that maintains the data.
19904
19905
19906.option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
19907.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
19908.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
19909If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
19910size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
19911This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
19912maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
19913it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
19914
19915
19916
19917.option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
19918.cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
19919If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
19920file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
19921transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
19922&(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
19923&%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
19924directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
19925SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
19926&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
19927
19928
19929.option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
19930.cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
19931.cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
19932This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
19933a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
19934directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
19935calculation. The default value is:
19936.code
19937maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
19938.endd
19939This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
19940(directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
19941&_Trash_&
19942folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
19943.code
19944maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
19945.endd
19946This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
19947directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
19948calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
19949directly into that directory.
19950
19951
19952.option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
19953This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
19954&"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
19955
19956
19957.option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
19958This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
19959section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
19960
19961
19962.new
19963.option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
19964.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
19965The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
19966If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
19967creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
19968quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
19969value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
19970&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
19971.wen
19972
19973.option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
19974.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
19975.cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
19976The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
19977effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
19978matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
19979containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
19980delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
19981&_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
19982See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
19983
19984
19985.option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
19986.cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
19987If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
19988new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
19989SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
19990below for further details.
19991
19992
19993.option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
19994This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
19995section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
19996
19997
19998.option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
19999This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
20000section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
20001
20002
20003.option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
20004.cindex "locking files"
20005.cindex "file" "locking"
20006.cindex "file" "MBX format"
20007.cindex "MBX format, specifying"
20008This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20009set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
20010the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
20011traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
20012IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
20013
20014&*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
20015automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
20016empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
20017combination:
20018.code
20019mbx_format = true
20020message_prefix =
20021message_suffix =
20022.endd
20023If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
20024&%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
20025is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
20026&%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
20027interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
20028should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
20029going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
20030mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
20031
20032If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
20033the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
20034(this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
20035append messages to it.
20036
20037
20038.option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
20039.cindex "&""From""& line"
20040The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
20041The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
20042in which case it is:
20043.code
20044message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
20045 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
20046.endd
20047&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20048&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
20049
20050.option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
20051The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
20052The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
20053in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
20054setting
20055.code
20056message_suffix =
20057.endd
20058&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20059&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
20060
20061.option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
20062If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
20063has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
20064permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
20065if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
20066a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
20067value, and this option is ignored.
20068
20069
20070.option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
20071This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
20072mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
20073true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
20074continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
20075
20076
20077.option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
20078If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
20079successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
20080on users about incoming mail.
20081
20082
20083.option quota appendfile string&!! unset
20084.cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
20085This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
20086or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
20087is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
20088all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
20089individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
20090&%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
20091have no shell access to their mailboxes).
20092
20093As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
20094multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
20095For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
20096
20097A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
20098may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
20099If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
20100become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
20101Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
20102the obvious value which users understand most easily.
20103
20104The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
20105(decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
20106for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
20107large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
20108be handled.
20109
20110&*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
20111
20112The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
20113the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
20114be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
20115fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
20116system quota failures.
20117
20118By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
20119mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
20120last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
20121during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
20122refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
20123message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
20124changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
20125for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
20126continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
20127delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
20128
20129
20130.option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
20131This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
20132into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
20133called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
20134delivery directory.
20135
20136
20137.option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
20138This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
20139number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
20140can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
20141failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
20142&"no quota"&.
20143
20144
20145.option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
20146See &%quota%& above.
20147
20148
20149.option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
20150This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
20151for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
20152these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
20153If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
20154captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
20155file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
20156
20157This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
20158&-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
20159facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
20160the file length to the file name. For example:
20161.code
20162maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
20163quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
20164.endd
20165An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
20166number of lines in the message.
20167
20168The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
20169file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
20170sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
20171
20172Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
20173
20174
20175.option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
20176See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
20177&%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
20178.code
20179quota_warn_message = "\
20180 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
20181 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
20182 This message is automatically created \
20183 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
20184 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
20185 a warning threshold that is\n\
20186 set by the system administrator.\n"
20187.endd
20188
20189
20190.option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
20191.cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
20192.cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
20193.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20194This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
20195resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
20196size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
20197threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
20198may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
20199sign. For example:
20200.code
20201quota = 10M
20202quota_warn_threshold = 75%
20203.endd
20204If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
20205percent sign is ignored.
20206
20207The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
20208and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
20209warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
20210the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
20211can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
20212&'From:'& line, the default is:
20213.code
20214From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
20215.endd
20216.oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
20217If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
20218option.
20219
20220The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
20221are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
20222percentage.
20223
20224
20225.option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
20226.cindex "envelope sender"
20227If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
20228format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
20229you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
20230so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
20231for details of batch SMTP.
20232
20233
20234.option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
20235.cindex "carriage return"
20236.cindex "linefeed"
20237This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
20238(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
20239of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
20240of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
20241
20242&*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
20243(which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
20244in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
20245carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
20246have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
20247changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
20248
20249
20250.option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20251This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
20252exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
20253&%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
20254that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20255&%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
20256
20257
20258.option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
20259This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
20260the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
20261&[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
20262each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
20263
20264This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
20265&[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
20266where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
20267both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
20268
20269.cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
20270Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
20271have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
20272&[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
20273the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
20274error.
20275
20276&*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
20277is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
20278
20279
20280.option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
20281If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
20282appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
20283&[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
20284sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
20285&[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
20286delivering over NFS from more than one host.
20287
20288.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20289In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
20290necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
20291achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
20292file corruption.
20293
20294The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
20295It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
20296except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
20297
20298
20299.option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20300This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20301set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
20302locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
20303of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
20304are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
20305the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
20306rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
20307does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
20308
20309You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20310&%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
20311MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
20312without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
20313
20314
20315
20316
20317.section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
20318.cindex "appending to a file"
20319.cindex "file" "appending"
20320Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
20321
20322.ilist
20323If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
20324return is given.
20325
20326.next
20327.cindex "directory creation"
20328If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
20329&%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
20330&%directory_mode%& option.
20331
20332.next
20333If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
20334indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
20335transport.
20336
20337.next
20338.cindex "file" "locking"
20339.cindex "locking files"
20340.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20341If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
20342reliably over NFS, as follows:
20343
20344.olist
20345Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
20346current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
20347as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
20348.next
20349Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
20350.next
20351If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
20352Unlink the hitching post name.
20353.next
20354Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
20355then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
20356of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
20357restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
20358.next
20359If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
20360up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
20361mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
20362lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
20363existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
20364it before trying again.
20365.endlist olist
20366
20367.next
20368A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
20369so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
20370than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
20371
20372.next
20373.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20374.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20375If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
20376&%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
20377checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
20378is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
20379ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
20380directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
20381idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
20382checked.
20383
20384.next
20385If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
20386and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
20387different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
20388delivery is deferred.
20389
20390.next
20391If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
20392If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
20393is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
20394permissions.
20395
20396.next
20397The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
20398If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
20399hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
20400
20401.next
20402If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
20403changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
20404have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
20405
20406.next
20407If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
20408option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
20409directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
20410open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
20411except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
20412set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
20413the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
20414that prevents link following.
20415
20416.next
20417.cindex "loop" "while file testing"
20418If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
20419existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
20420being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
20421after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
20422
20423.next
20424If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
20425
20426.next
20427.cindex "file" "locking"
20428.cindex "locking files"
20429Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
20430are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
20431&%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
20432However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
20433file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
20434.code
20435/tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
20436.endd
20437using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
20438the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
20439the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
20440
20441If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
20442depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
20443&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
20444
20445If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
20446&%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
20447to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
20448delivery is deferred.
20449
20450If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
20451&[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
20452waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
20453immediately. It retries up to
20454.code
20455(lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
20456.endd
20457times (rounded up).
20458.endlist
20459
20460At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
20461and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
20462
20463
20464.section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
20465.cindex "delivery" "to single file"
20466.cindex "&""From""& line"
20467When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
20468delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
20469activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
20470&%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
20471router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
20472configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
20473ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
20474
20475No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
20476locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
20477separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
20478of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
20479newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
20480&%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
20481any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
20482
20483If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
20484the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
20485different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
20486deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
20487
20488
20489.cindex "maildir format"
20490.cindex "mailstore format"
20491There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
20492done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
20493&%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
20494formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
20495SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
20496
20497.cindex "directory creation"
20498In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
20499sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
20500option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
20501constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
20502the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
20503&%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
20504deferred.
20505
20506
20507
20508.section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
20509.cindex "maildir format" "description of"
20510If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
20511it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
20512directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
20513directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
20514&_new_& subdirectory.
20515
20516In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
20517<&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
20518Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
20519before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
20520file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
20521opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
20522Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
20523
20524Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
20525called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
20526do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
20527path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
20528&%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
20529contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
20530&_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
20531&_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
20532
20533These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
20534and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
20535folders. Consider this example:
20536.code
20537maildir_format = true
20538directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
20539 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
20540 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
20541maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
20542.endd
20543If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
20544delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
20545the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
20546not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
20547&_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
20548&_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
20549
20550However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
20551delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
20552does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
20553&_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
20554directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
20555
20556&*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
20557not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
20558&_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
20559
20560.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20561.cindex "maildir++"
20562If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
20563&%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
20564the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
20565Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
20566down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
20567the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
20568amount of space used.
20569
20570One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
20571computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
20572checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
20573needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
20574use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
20575of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
20576
20577
20578
20579
20580.section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
20581If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
20582When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
20583tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
20584name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
20585the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
20586
20587
20588.vindex "&$message_size$&"
20589Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
20590&%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
20591happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
20592variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
20593forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
20594be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
20595Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
20596empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
20597colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
20598maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
20599backwards compatibility).
20600
20601For one common implementation, you might set:
20602.code
20603maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
20604.endd
20605but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
20606
20607It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
20608as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
20609&[stat()]& each message file.
20610
20611
20612.section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
20613.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20614.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
20615If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
20616storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
20617within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
20618creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
20619the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
20620to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
20621
20622The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
20623messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
20624in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
20625value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
20626is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
20627need to know the quota.
20628
20629If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
20630file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
20631
20632A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
20633maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
20634See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
20635details.
20636
20637
20638.section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
20639.cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
20640If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
20641files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
20642message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
20643this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
20644contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
20645itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
20646
20647During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
20648&_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
20649&_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
20650mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
20651file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
20652the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
20653
20654The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
20655option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
20656the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
20657There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
20658greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
20659appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
20660
20661If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
20662failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
20663configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
20664&$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
20665
20666
20667.section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
20668If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
20669file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
20670messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
20671section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
20672.code
20673directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
20674.endd
20675might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
20676then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
20677expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
20678.ecindex IIDapptra1
20679.ecindex IIDapptra2
20680
20681
20682
20683
20684
20685
20686. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20687. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20688
20689.chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
20690.scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
20691.scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
20692The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
20693the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
20694automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
20695&'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
20696to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
20697
20698If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
20699&%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
20700delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
20701that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
20702another router can set up a normal message delivery.
20703
20704
20705The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
20706&"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
20707directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
20708message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
20709empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
20710
20711The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
20712by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
20713passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
20714transport is run as a consequence of a
20715&%mail%&
20716or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
20717supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
20718that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
20719case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
20720is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
20721&%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
20722
20723&(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
20724command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
20725gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
20726&<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
20727
20728There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
20729that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
20730&(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
20731address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
20732separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
20733the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
20734message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
20735
20736Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
20737message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
20738immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
20739the transport defers.
20740Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
20741controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
20742
20743If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
20744&%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
20745of the original message that is included in the generated message when
20746&%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
20747
20748.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
20749If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
20750the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
20751as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
20752is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
20753problems. They are just discarded.
20754
20755
20756
20757.section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
20758.cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
20759
20760.option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
20761This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
20762message when the message is specified by the transport.
20763
20764
20765.option cc autoreply string&!! unset
20766This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
20767when the message is specified by the transport.
20768
20769
20770.option file autoreply string&!! unset
20771The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
20772is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
20773string comes first.
20774
20775
20776.option file_expand autoreply boolean false
20777If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
20778subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
20779
20780
20781.option file_optional autoreply boolean false
20782If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
20783option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
20784
20785
20786.option from autoreply string&!! unset
20787This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
20788specified by the transport.
20789
20790
20791.option headers autoreply string&!! unset
20792This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
20793when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
20794&"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
20795
20796
20797.option log autoreply string&!! unset
20798This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
20799the message is specified by the transport.
20800
20801
20802.option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
20803If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
20804used.
20805
20806
20807.option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
20808If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
20809item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
20810discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
20811generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
20812
20813
20814
20815.option once autoreply string&!! unset
20816This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
20817recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
20818This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
20819
20820If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
20821By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
20822is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
20823However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
20824message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
20825this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
20826prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
20827infinity.
20828
20829If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
20830and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
20831greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
20832Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
20833regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
20834
20835In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
20836which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
20837be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
20838means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
20839unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
20840file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
20841
20842
20843.option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
20844See &%once%& above.
20845
20846
20847.option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
20848See &%once%& above.
20849After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
20850
20851
20852.option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
20853This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
20854specified by the transport.
20855
20856
20857.option return_message autoreply boolean false
20858If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
20859message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
20860configuration option.
20861
20862
20863.option subject autoreply string&!! unset
20864This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
20865specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
20866automatic responses. For example:
20867.code
20868subject = Re: $h_subject:
20869.endd
20870There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
20871subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
20872bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
20873non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
20874small.
20875
20876
20877
20878.option text autoreply string&!! unset
20879This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
20880message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
20881the text comes first.
20882
20883
20884.option to autoreply string&!! unset
20885This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
20886when the message is specified by the transport.
20887.ecindex IIDauttra1
20888.ecindex IIDauttra2
20889
20890
20891
20892
20893. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20894. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20895
20896.chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
20897.cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
20898.cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
20899.cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
20900.cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
20901The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
20902specified command
20903or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
20904This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
20905transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
20906implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
20907to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
20908has it commented out. You need to ensure that
20909.code
20910TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
20911.endd
20912.cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
20913is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
20914included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
20915as follows:
20916
20917.option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
20918See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20919
20920
20921.option batch_max lmtp integer 1
20922This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
20923Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
20924good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
20925batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20926
20927
20928.option command lmtp string&!! unset
20929This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
20930is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
20931arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
20932number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
20933is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
20934LMTP protocol.
20935
20936.option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
20937.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
20938If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
20939commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
20940in its response to the LHLO command.
20941
20942.option socket lmtp string&!! unset
20943This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
20944be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
20945delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
20946
20947
20948.option timeout lmtp time 5m
20949The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
20950respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
20951is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
20952LMTP transport:
20953.code
20954lmtp:
20955 driver = lmtp
20956 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
20957 batch_max = 20
20958 user = exim
20959.endd
20960This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
20961necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
20962
20963
20964
20965. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20966. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20967
20968.chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
20969.scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
20970.scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
20971The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
20972running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
20973pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
20974(such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
20975their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
20976following ways:
20977
20978.ilist
20979.vindex "&$local_part$&"
20980A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
20981transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
20982contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
20983is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
20984.next
20985.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20986If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
20987transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
20988more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
20989(because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
20990(described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
20991that are routed to the transport.
20992.next
20993.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20994A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
20995alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
20996pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If only
20997one address is being transported (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or
20998only one address was redirected to this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains
20999the local part that was redirected.
21000.endlist
21001
21002
21003The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
21004deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
21005implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
21006
21007In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
21008&_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
21009other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
21010transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
21011directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
21012details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
21013for a discussion of local delivery batching.
21014
21015
21016.section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
21017If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
21018delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
21019any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
21020write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
21021
21022
21023
21024
21025.section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
21026.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
21027If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
21028have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
21029the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
21030in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
21031later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
21032logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
21033&"local delivery failed"&.
21034
21035If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
21036the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
21037will be sent as normal.
21038
21039If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
21040script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
21041value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
21042apply in this case.
21043
21044If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
21045return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
21046asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
21047a non-existent command may be the problem.
21048
21049The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
21050set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
21051error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
21052return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
21053included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
21054similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
21055failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
21056&%temp_errors%&.
21057
21058
21059
21060.section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
21061.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
21062The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
21063by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
21064&%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
21065run.
21066
21067.cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
21068Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
21069double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
21070way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
21071
21072String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
21073traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
21074expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
21075For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
21076quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
21077.code
21078command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
21079.endd
21080will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
21081arguments. You have to write
21082.code
21083command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
21084.endd
21085to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
21086argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
21087result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
21088interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
21089generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
21090expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
21091example:
21092.code
21093command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
21094.endd
21095
21096.cindex "transport" "filter"
21097.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21098.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21099Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
21100&`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
21101place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
21102transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
21103inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
21104avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
21105&(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
21106
21107After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
21108in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
21109message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
21110standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
21111read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
21112may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
21113control what is done with it.
21114
21115Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
21116in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
21117taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
21118explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
21119where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
21120under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
21121an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
21122works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
21123as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
21124&%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
21125with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
21126
21127
21128
21129.section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
21130.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
21131.cindex "environment for pipe transport"
21132The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
21133This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
21134the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
21135environment.
21136.display
21137&`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
21138&`HOME `& the home directory, if set
21139&`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
21140&`LOCAL_PART `& see below
21141&`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
21142&`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
21143&`LOGNAME `& see below
21144&`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
21145&`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
21146&`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
21147&`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
21148&`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
21149&`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
21150&`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
21151&`USER `& see below
21152.endd
21153When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
21154router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
21155called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
21156the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
21157removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
21158LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
21159same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
21160
21161.cindex "HOST"
21162HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
21163associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
21164pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
21165the router.
21166
21167.cindex "HOME"
21168If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
21169for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
21170by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
21171user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
21172
21173
21174.section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
21175.cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
21176
21177
21178
21179.option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
21180.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
21181The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21182permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
21183permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
21184paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
21185&%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
21186in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
21187the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
21188&%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
21189otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
21190example, if
21191.code
21192allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
21193.endd
21194and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
21195&_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
21196&%use_shell%& is set.
21197
21198
21199.option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
21200See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21201
21202
21203.option batch_max pipe integer 1
21204This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21205See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21206
21207
21208.option check_string pipe string unset
21209As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
21210&%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
21211by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
21212&%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
21213any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
21214of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
21215the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
21216ignored.
21217
21218
21219.option command pipe string&!! unset
21220This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
21221obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
21222set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
21223the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
21224Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
21225&<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
21226
21227
21228.option environment pipe string&!! unset
21229.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
21230.cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
21231This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
21232command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
21233a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21234environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
21235
21236
21237.option escape_string pipe string unset
21238See &%check_string%& above.
21239
21240
21241.option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
21242.cindex "exec failure"
21243.cindex "failure of exec"
21244.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
21245Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
21246any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
21247is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
21248frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
21249
21250
21251.option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
21252.cindex "signal exit"
21253.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
21254Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
21255a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
21256frozen in Exim's queue instead.
21257
21258
21259.option ignore_status pipe boolean false
21260If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
21261run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
21262Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
21263from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
21264&%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
21265
21266&*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
21267See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
21268
21269.option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
21270.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
21271If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
21272one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
21273and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
21274
21275
21276.option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
21277If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
21278return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
21279&%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
21280written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
21281Only one of them may be set.
21282
21283
21284
21285.option log_output pipe boolean false
21286If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
21287output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
21288&%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21289
21290
21291
21292.option max_output pipe integer 20K
21293This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
21294standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
21295process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
21296catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
21297the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
21298&%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
21299exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
21300
21301
21302.option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
21303The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21304The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
21305.code
21306message_prefix = \
21307 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
21308 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
21309.endd
21310.cindex "Cyrus"
21311.cindex "&%tmail%&"
21312.cindex "&""From""& line"
21313This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
21314However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
21315or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
21316setting
21317.code
21318message_prefix =
21319.endd
21320&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21321&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21322
21323
21324.option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
21325The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21326The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
21327The suffix can be suppressed by setting
21328.code
21329message_suffix =
21330.endd
21331&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21332&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21333
21334
21335.option path pipe string "see below"
21336This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
21337variable of the subprocess. The default is:
21338.code
21339/bin:/usr/bin
21340.endd
21341If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
21342sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
21343apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
21344
21345
21346.option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
21347Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
21348a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
21349during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
21350It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
21351for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
21352resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
21353installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
21354of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
21355
21356
21357.option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
21358.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21359If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
21360process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
21361to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
21362&%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
21363accept the message is used.
21364
21365
21366.option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
21367When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
21368contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
21369in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
21370command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
21371handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
21372
21373
21374.option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
21375If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
21376return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
21377is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
21378However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
21379message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
21380&%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21381
21382
21383
21384.option return_output pipe boolean false
21385If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
21386deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
21387is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
21388However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
21389output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
21390option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
21391of them may be set.
21392
21393
21394
21395.option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
21396.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
21397This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
21398asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
21399and &%return_output%& is not set,
21400and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
21401temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
21402numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
21403codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
21404defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
21405compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
21406and 73, respectively.
21407
21408
21409.option timeout pipe time 1h
21410If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
21411causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
21412specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
21413command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
21414and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
21415if one of the processes starts a new process group.
21416
21417.option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
21418A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
21419runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
21420treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
21421is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
21422delivery to be deferred.
21423
21424.option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
21425This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
21426
21427
21428.option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
21429.cindex "envelope sender"
21430If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
21431SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
21432commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
21433you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
21434&<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
21435
21436.option use_classresources pipe boolean false
21437.cindex "class resources (BSD)"
21438This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
21439BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
21440resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
21441limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
21442class database.
21443
21444
21445.option use_crlf pipe boolean false
21446.cindex "carriage return"
21447.cindex "linefeed"
21448This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21449(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21450of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
21451of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21452
21453The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
21454written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
21455are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
21456&%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
21457values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21458
21459
21460.option use_shell pipe boolean false
21461.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21462If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
21463instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
21464&<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
21465where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
21466modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
21467&`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
21468command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
21469its &%-c%& option.
21470
21471
21472
21473.section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
21474.cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
21475.cindex "&'procmail'&"
21476.cindex "external local delivery"
21477.cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
21478.cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
21479The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
21480delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
21481this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
21482uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
21483by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
21484necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
21485appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
21486configuration for &%procmail%&:
21487.code
21488# transport
21489procmail_pipe:
21490 driver = pipe
21491 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
21492 return_path_add
21493 delivery_date_add
21494 envelope_to_add
21495 check_string = "From "
21496 escape_string = ">From "
21497 umask = 077
21498 user = $local_part
21499 group = mail
21500
21501# router
21502procmail:
21503 driver = accept
21504 check_local_user
21505 transport = procmail_pipe
21506.endd
21507In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
21508&'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
21509or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
21510user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
21511&%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
21512home directory is the user's home directory by default.
21513
21514&*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
21515.code
21516IFS=" "
21517.endd
21518as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
21519use a shell to run pipe commands.
21520
21521.cindex "Cyrus"
21522The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
21523deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
21524.code
21525# transport
21526local_delivery_cyrus:
21527 driver = pipe
21528 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
21529 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
21530 user = cyrus
21531 group = mail
21532 return_output
21533 log_output
21534 message_prefix =
21535 message_suffix =
21536
21537# router
21538local_user_cyrus:
21539 driver = accept
21540 check_local_user
21541 local_part_suffix = .*
21542 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
21543.endd
21544Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
21545&%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
21546sender.
21547.ecindex IIDpiptra1
21548.ecindex IIDpiptra2
21549
21550
21551. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21552. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21553
21554.chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
21555.scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
21556.scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
21557The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
21558or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
21559that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
21560explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
21561&<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
21562
21563
21564.section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
21565The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
21566two ways:
21567
21568.ilist
21569If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
21570routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
21571that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
21572the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
21573does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
21574value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
21575section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
21576.next
21577.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
21578When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
21579looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
21580connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
21581for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
21582process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
21583process.
21584.endlist
21585
21586
21587For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
21588incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
21589no further messages are sent over that connection.
21590
21591
21592
21593.section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
21594.vindex "&$host$&"
21595.vindex "&$host_address$&"
21596At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
21597&$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
21598passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
21599specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
21600&$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
21601that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
21602&%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
21603
21604
21605.section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
21606.vindex &$tls_cipher$&
21607.vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
21608At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_cipher$&
21609and &$tls_peerdn$& are the values that were set when the message was received.
21610These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
21611SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these two
21612variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
21613appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
21614are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
21615&%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
21616
21617
21618.section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
21619.cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
21620The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
21621
21622
21623.option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
21624.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
21625When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
21626is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
21627runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
21628reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
21629setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
21630problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
21631
21632.option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
21633.cindex "local host" "sending to"
21634.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
21635When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
21636to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
21637deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
21638the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
21639configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
21640configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
21641
21642
21643.option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
21644.cindex "Cyrus"
21645When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
21646is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
21647overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
21648forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
21649to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
21650ignored.
21651
21652The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
21653started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
21654&$tls_cipher$&, and &$tls_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
21655particular connection.
21656
21657If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
21658&%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
21659deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
21660unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
21661
21662This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
21663deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
21664&"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
21665.code
21666authenticated_sender = $local_part
21667.endd
21668This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
21669allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
21670
21671Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
21672domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
21673value.
21674
21675
21676.option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
21677If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
21678is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
21679authenticated as a client.
21680
21681
21682.option command_timeout smtp time 5m
21683This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
21684sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
21685remote host. Its value must not be zero.
21686
21687
21688.option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
21689This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
21690to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
21691several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
21692less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
21693systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
21694option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
21695
21696
21697.option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
21698.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
21699.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
21700.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
21701This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
21702over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
21703For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
21704option.
21705
21706
21707.option data_timeout smtp time 5m
21708This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
21709the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
21710of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
21711
21712
21713.option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
21714This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
21715domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
21716cutoff times.
21717
21718In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
21719them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
21720Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
21721retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
21722a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
21723unhappy at this prospect, so...
21724
21725If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
21726addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
21727IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
21728none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
21729delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
21730addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
21731continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
21732&%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
21733to them.
21734
21735
21736.option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
21737If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
21738and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
21739the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
21740in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
21741
21742
21743.option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
21744If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
21745&%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
21746See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
21747details.
21748
21749
21750
21751.option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
21752.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
21753String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
21754colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
21755port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
21756&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
21757item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
21758in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
21759
21760Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
21761addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
21762&%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
21763not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
21764&%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
21765However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
21766
21767If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
21768the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
21769transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
21770address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
21771list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
21772
21773Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
21774re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
21775addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
21776copy of the message is sent.
21777
21778The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
21779&%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
21780both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
21781from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
21782fails"& facility.
21783
21784
21785.option final_timeout smtp time 10m
21786This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
21787line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
21788zero.
21789
21790.option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
21791If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
21792being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
21793(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
21794instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
21795it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
21796
21797.option gnutls_require_kx smtp string unset
21798This option controls the key exchange mechanisms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21799client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21800
21801.option gnutls_require_mac smtp string unset
21802This option controls the MAC algorithms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21803client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21804
21805.option gnutls_require_protocols smtp string unset
21806This option controls the protocols when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21807client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21808
21809.option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
21810This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
21811server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
21812implementations of TLS.
21813
21814.option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
21815.cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
21816.cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
21817.cindex "LHLO argument setting"
21818The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
21819been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
21820command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
21821option is:
21822.code
21823$primary_hostname
21824.endd
21825During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
21826the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
21827&$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
21828used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
21829servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
21830that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
21831interface address, you could use this:
21832.code
21833helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
21834 {$primary_hostname}}
21835.endd
21836The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
21837callouts.
21838
21839.option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
21840Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
21841finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
21842&(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
21843email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
21844all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
21845
21846The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
21847processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
21848&%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
21849&%hosts_override%& is set.
21850
21851The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
21852list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
21853separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
21854&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
21855item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
21856in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
21857of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
21858
21859If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
21860the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
21861well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
21862address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
21863&[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
21864&%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
21865that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
21866address are used.
21867
21868During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
21869unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
21870
21871
21872.option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
21873.cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
21874.cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
21875.cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
21876.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
21877This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
21878example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
21879matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
21880start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
21881facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
21882
21883
21884.option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
21885.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
21886Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
21887that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
21888
21889
21890.option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21891.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
21892Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
21893matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21894
21895
21896.option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
21897.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
21898.cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
21899.cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
21900.cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
21901This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
21902delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
21903&<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
21904
21905
21906.option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
21907This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
21908tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
21909why it exists.
21910
21911
21912
21913.option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21914.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
21915.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
21916.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
21917For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
21918been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
21919message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
21920explanation of when this might be needed.
21921
21922
21923.option hosts_override smtp boolean false
21924If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
21925attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
21926&%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
21927&%fallback_hosts%&.
21928
21929
21930.option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
21931.cindex "randomized host list"
21932.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
21933.cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
21934If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
21935&%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
21936were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
21937router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
21938is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
21939list can be used to do crude load sharing.
21940
21941When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
21942order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
21943behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
21944&`+`& in the host list. For example:
21945.code
21946hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
21947.endd
21948The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
21949randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
21950If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
21951
21952.option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
21953.cindex "authentication" "required by client"
21954This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
21955before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
21956servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
21957authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
21958temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
21959hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
21960&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
21961
21962
21963.option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21964.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
21965Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
21966matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21967&*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
21968incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
21969
21970.option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
21971.cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
21972This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
21973authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
21974connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
21975unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
21976&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
21977
21978.option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
21979.cindex "bind IP address"
21980.cindex "IP address" "binding"
21981.vindex "&$host$&"
21982.vindex "&$host_address$&"
21983This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
21984call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
21985&`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
21986message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
21987&$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
21988outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
21989interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
21990unknown.
21991
21992During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
21993&$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
21994during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
21995string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
21996string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
21997separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
21998.code
21999interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
22000.endd
22001The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
22002connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
22003&%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
22004interface to use if the host has more than one.
22005
22006
22007.option keepalive smtp boolean true
22008.cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
22009This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
22010connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
22011periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
22012of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
22013or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
22014that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
22015that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
22016TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
22017unreachable hosts.
22018
22019
22020.option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
22021.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22022If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
22023string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
22024has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
22025
22026.option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
22027.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
22028This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
22029SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
22030so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
22031permits this.
22032
22033
22034.option multi_domain smtp boolean true
22035.vindex "&$domain$&"
22036When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
22037addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
22038to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
22039handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
22040&$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
22041is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
22042
22043
22044.option port smtp string&!! "see below"
22045.cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
22046.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
22047This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
22048&*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
22049received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
22050The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
22051variable that contains an outgoing port.
22052
22053If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
22054otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
22055normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
22056&"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
22057is deferred.
22058
22059
22060
22061.option protocol smtp string smtp
22062.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
22063.cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
22064.cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
22065.vindex "&$port$&"
22066If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
22067the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
22068protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
22069deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
22070over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
22071
22072.new
22073If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default vaule for the &%port%& option
22074changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
22075connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
22076The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
22077.wen
22078
22079
22080.option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean true
22081Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
22082constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
22083means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
22084tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
22085addresses is not affected.
22086
22087However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
22088each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
22089the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
22090Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
22091instance of the &(smtp)& transport, set up specially to handle the dialup
22092hosts.
22093
22094
22095.option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
22096.cindex "serializing connections"
22097.cindex "host" "serializing connections"
22098Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
22099host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
22100the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
22101slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
22102Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
22103&%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
22104
22105.cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
22106Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
22107written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
22108is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
22109records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
22110guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
22111
22112If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
22113relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
22114start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
22115may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
22116are used for ETRN serialization.
22117
22118
22119.option size_addition smtp integer 1024
22120.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
22121.cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
22122.cindex "size" "of message"
22123.cindex "transport" "filter"
22124.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22125If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
22126MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
22127an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
22128sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
22129configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
22130this if a lot of text is added to messages.
22131
22132Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
22133the use of the SIZE option altogether.
22134
22135
22136.option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
22137.cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
22138.cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
22139.vindex "&$host$&"
22140.vindex "&$host_address$&"
22141The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
22142client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
22143connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
22144address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
22145details of TLS.
22146
22147&*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
22148certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
22149name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
22150assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
22151client.
22152
22153
22154.option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
22155.cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
22156.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
22157This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
22158be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
22159
22160
22161.option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
22162.cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
22163.vindex "&$host$&"
22164.vindex "&$host_address$&"
22165The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
22166client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
22167connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
22168&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22169expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
22170result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
22171the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22172
22173
22174.option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
22175.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
22176.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
22177.vindex "&$host$&"
22178.vindex "&$host_address$&"
22179The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
22180when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
22181the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
22182&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22183expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
22184is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
22185&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
22186ciphers is a preference order.
22187
22188
22189
22190.option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
22191.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
22192When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
22193setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
22194to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
22195current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
22196option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
22197response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
22198TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
22199unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
22200in clear.
22201
22202
22203.option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! unset
22204.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
22205.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
22206.vindex "&$host$&"
22207.vindex "&$host_address$&"
22208The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
22209permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
22210Alternatively, if you are using OpenSSL, you can set
22211&%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a directory containing certificate
22212files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the option must be set to the name of a
22213single file if you are using GnuTLS. The values of &$host$& and
22214&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22215expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22216
22217
22218
22219
22220.section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
22221 "SECTvalhosmax"
22222.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
22223.cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
22224There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
22225tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
22226&%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
22227
22228
22229The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
22230for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
22231option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
22232multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
22233retrying.
22234
22235Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
22236multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
22237created as a result of routing one of these domains.
22238
22239Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
22240several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
22241problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
22242&%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
22243delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
22244
22245Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
22246arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
22247limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
22248some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
22249&%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
22250that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
22251see below for an exception).
22252
22253Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
22254list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
22255If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
22256but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
22257that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
22258
22259Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
22260higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
22261hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
22262which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
22263tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
22264reached their retry times.
22265
22266However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
22267large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
22268Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
22269of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
22270time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
22271without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
22272all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
22273there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
22274the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
22275every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
22276reached.
22277
22278The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
22279particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
22280out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
22281reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
22282been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
22283take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
22284
22285The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
22286Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
22287and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
22288possible IP addresses have been tried.
22289.ecindex IIDsmttra1
22290.ecindex IIDsmttra2
22291
22292
22293
22294
22295
22296. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22297. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22298
22299.chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
22300.scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
22301There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
22302addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
22303(referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
22304abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
22305
22306Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
22307messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
22308&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
22309appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
22310locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
22311unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
22312lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
22313
22314One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
22315when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
22316such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
22317do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
22318
22319
22320.section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
22321This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
22322main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
22323&%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
22324
22325Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
22326Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
22327facility; you do not have to use it.
22328
22329The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
22330configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
22331addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
22332address to which it applies.
22333
22334Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
22335the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
22336rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
22337those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
22338by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
22339are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
22340rules.
22341
22342Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
22343applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
22344well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
22345headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
22346
22347
22348In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
22349legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
22350in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
22351used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
22352Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
22353discouraged.
22354
22355There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
22356illustrated by these examples:
22357
22358.ilist
22359The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
22360exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
22361gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
22362&'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
22363.next
22364A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
22365&'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
22366.endlist
22367
22368
22369
22370.section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
22371.cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
22372.cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
22373Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
22374message's processing.
22375
22376.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22377At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
22378by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
22379ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
22380is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
22381rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
22382rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
22383RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
22384rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
22385
22386.vindex "&$domain$&"
22387.vindex "&$local_part$&"
22388Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
22389may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
22390rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
22391from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
22392for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
22393value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
22394as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
22395SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
22396
22397As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
22398recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
22399the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
22400any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
22401.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
22402before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
22403
22404When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
22405rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
22406redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
22407
22408.cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
22409.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22410.cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
22411At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
22412specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
22413This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
22414section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
22415header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
22416applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
22417
22418The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
22419transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
22420transport time.
22421
22422
22423
22424
22425.section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
22426.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
22427.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
22428Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
22429configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
22430&%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
224312822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
22432transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
22433appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
22434envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
22435.code
22436exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
22437.endd
22438might produce the output
22439.code
22440sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22441from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22442to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22443cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22444bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22445reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22446env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22447env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22448.endd
22449which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
22450the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
22451present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
22452set for a particular transport.
22453
22454
22455.section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
22456.cindex "rewriting" "rules"
22457The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
22458rules in the form
22459.display
22460<&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
22461.endd
22462Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
22463transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
22464takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
22465any colons must be doubled, of course).
22466
22467The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
22468Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
22469case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
22470characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
22471ignored.
22472
22473For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
22474order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
22475replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
22476
22477The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
22478releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
22479received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
22480lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
22481address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
22482(or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
22483that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
22484
22485.vindex "&$domain$&"
22486.vindex "&$local_part$&"
22487The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
22488string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
22489rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
22490.code
22491*@* ${lookup ...
22492.endd
22493where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
22494refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22495
22496
22497.section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
22498.cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
22499.cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
22500The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
22501address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
22502single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
22503against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
22504you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
22505facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
22506
22507Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
22508case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
22509can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
22510
22511.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
22512After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
22513depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
22514replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
22515refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
22516numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
22517of pattern they are set as follows:
22518
22519.ilist
22520If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
22521refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
22522the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
22523pattern
22524.code
22525*queen@*.fict.example
22526.endd
22527is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
22528.code
22529$0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
22530$1 = hearts-
22531$2 = wonderland
22532.endd
22533Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
22534does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
22535
22536.next
22537If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
22538of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
22539for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
22540rewriting rule of the form
22541.display
22542&`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
22543.endd
22544and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
22545.code
22546$1 = foo
22547$2 = bar
22548$3 = baz.example
22549.endd
22550If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
22551wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
22552&$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
22553partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
22554whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
22555.endlist
22556
22557
22558.section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
22559.cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
22560If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
22561match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
22562rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
22563.code
22564hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
22565.endd
22566specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
22567&'From:'& headers.
22568
22569.vindex "&$domain$&"
22570.vindex "&$local_part$&"
22571If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
22572yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
22573&$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22574Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
22575cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
22576matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
22577the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
22578current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
22579expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
22580entry written to the panic log.
22581
22582
22583
22584.section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
22585There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
22586
22587.ilist
22588Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
22589c, f, h, r, s, t.
22590.next
22591A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
22592.next
22593Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
22594.endlist
22595
22596For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
22597E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
22598
22599
22600
22601.section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
22602 "SECID154"
22603.cindex "rewriting" "flags"
22604If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
22605&<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
22606and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
22607transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
22608rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
22609.display
22610&`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
22611&`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
22612&`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
22613&`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
22614&`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
22615&`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
22616&`h`& rewrite all headers
22617&`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
22618&`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
22619&`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
22620.endd
22621"All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
22622individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
22623other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
22624
22625You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
22626restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
22627
22628
22629.section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
22630.cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
22631.cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
22632.cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
22633The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
22634SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
22635before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
22636required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
22637data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
22638
22639.vindex "&$domain$&"
22640.vindex "&$local_part$&"
22641This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
22642compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
22643input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
22644the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
22645expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
22646original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
22647
22648
22649.section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
22650There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
22651take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
22652correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
22653
22654.ilist
22655If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
22656unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
22657absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
22658.next
22659If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
22660even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
22661expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
22662(does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
22663.next
22664The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
22665address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
22666rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
22667.next
22668.cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
22669When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
22670to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
22671left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
22672.code
22673From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
22674.endd
22675into
22676.code
22677From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
22678.endd
22679.cindex "RFC 2047"
22680Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
22681done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
22682causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
22683replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
226842822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
22685brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
22686(except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
22687is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
22688
22689When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
22690rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
22691.endlist
22692
22693
22694.section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
22695Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
22696.code
22697*@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
22698*@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
22699 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
22700.endd
22701Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
22702the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
22703has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
22704consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
22705present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
22706explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
22707at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
22708error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
22709
22710The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
22711domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
22712.code
22713root@*.hitch.fict.example *
22714.endd
22715were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
22716local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
22717
22718Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
22719&${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
22720messages that originate outside the local host:
22721.code
22722*@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
22723 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
22724.endd
22725The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
22726space.
22727
22728.cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
22729.cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
22730Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
22731an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
22732the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
22733remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
22734sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
22735components. For example, the rule
22736.code
22737\N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
22738.endd
22739rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
22740&'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
22741a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
22742method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
22743to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
22744use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
22745can be done on the rewritten addresses.
22746.ecindex IIDaddrew
22747
22748
22749
22750
22751
22752. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22753. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22754
22755.chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
22756.scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
22757.scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
22758The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
22759retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
22760be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
22761empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
22762errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
22763general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
22764line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
22765address, domain and error.
22766
22767The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
22768host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
22769Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
22770address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
22771been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
22772tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
22773log selector is set, the message
22774.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
22775&"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
22776skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
22777the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
22778
22779Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
22780in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
22781actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
22782failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
22783the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
22784added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
22785same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
22786domain are maintained independently.
22787
22788When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
22789receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
22790always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
22791behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
22792quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
22793suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
22794subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
22795the local address is reached.
22796
22797.section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
22798If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
22799whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
22800files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
22801always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
22802
22803The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
22804rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
22805record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
22806timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
22807and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
22808messages that it should now be retaining.
22809
22810
22811
22812.section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
22813.cindex "retry" "rules"
22814Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
22815separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
22816addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
22817enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
22818in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
22819present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
22820message's sender, respectively.
22821
22822
22823The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
22824&<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
22825which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
22826has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
22827list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
22828which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
22829example,
22830.code
22831lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22832.endd
22833provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
22834whereas
22835.code
22836alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22837.endd
22838applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
22839In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
22840part.
22841
22842.cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
22843&*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a routing rule pattern, it
22844must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
22845expressions work in address lists.
22846.display
22847&`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
22848&`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
22849.endd
22850
22851
22852.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
22853When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
22854example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
22855against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
22856router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
22857regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
22858A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
22859&"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
22860&%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
22861
22862Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
22863failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
22864configuration is tested against the complete address only if
22865&%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
22866local transports).
22867
22868.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
22869However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
22870suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
22871whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
22872rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
22873failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
22874recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
22875reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
22876&%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
22877lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
22878commands.
22879
22880
22881
22882.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
22883 "SECID160"
22884For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
22885example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
22886twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
22887&"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
22888the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
22889suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
22890.code
22891a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
22892 MX 6 p.q.r.example
22893 MX 7 m.n.o.example
22894.endd
22895and the retry rules are
22896.code
22897p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
22898a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
22899.endd
22900and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
22901first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
22902rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
22903to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
22904tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
22905first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
22906
22907In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
22908first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
22909&'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
22910routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
22911
22912&*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
22913However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
22914host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
22915.code
22916route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
22917.endd
22918then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
22919textual form of the IP address.
22920
22921.section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
22922.cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
22923The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
22924asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
22925
22926.vlist
22927.vitem &%auth_failed%&
22928Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
22929&%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
22930
22931.vitem &%data_4xx%&
22932A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
22933after the command, or after sending the message's data.
22934
22935.vitem &%mail_4xx%&
22936A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
22937
22938.vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
22939A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
22940.endlist
22941
22942For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
22943as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
22944recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
22945and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
22946retry rule of this form:
22947.code
22948the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
22949.endd
22950These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
22951LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
22952
22953.vlist
22954.vitem &%lost_connection%&
22955A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
22956legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
22957for the same host, it indicates something odd.
22958
22959.vitem &%refused_MX%&
22960A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
22961
22962.vitem &%refused_A%&
22963A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
22964
22965.vitem &%refused%&
22966A connection was refused.
22967
22968.vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
22969A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
22970
22971.vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
22972A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
22973
22974.vitem &%timeout_connect%&
22975A connection attempt timed out.
22976
22977.vitem &%timeout_MX%&
22978There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
22979obtained from an MX record.
22980
22981.vitem &%timeout_A%&
22982There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
22983obtained from an MX record.
22984
22985.vitem &%timeout%&
22986There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
22987
22988.vitem &%tls_required%&
22989The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
22990&(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
22991to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
22992
22993.vitem &%quota%&
22994A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
22995transport.
22996
22997.vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
22998.cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
22999.cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
23000A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
23001transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
23002&'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
23003for four days.
23004.endlist
23005
23006.cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
23007The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
23008timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
23009it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
23010However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
23011heuristic rules:
23012
23013.ilist
23014If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
23015used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
23016quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
23017.next
23018.cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
23019For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
23020subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
23021the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
23022change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
23023MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
23024time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
23025.next
23026For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
23027obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
23028.endlist
23029
23030The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
23031mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
23032when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
23033error).
23034
23035
23036
23037.section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
23038.cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
23039You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
23040specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
23041apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
23042form:
23043.display
23044&`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
23045.endd
23046The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
23047.code
23048* rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
23049.endd
23050matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
23051host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
23052For example:
23053.code
23054a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
23055.endd
23056&*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
23057(which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
23058only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
23059its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
23060all messages, not just those with specific senders.
23061
23062When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
23063&%-f%& command line option, like this:
23064.code
23065exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
23066.endd
23067If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
23068list is never matched.
23069
23070
23071
23072
23073
23074.section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
23075.cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
23076The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
23077sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
23078.display
23079<&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
23080.endd
23081The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
23082time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
23083arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
23084time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
23085relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
23086
23087.cindex "retry" "algorithms"
23088.cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
23089.cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
23090.cindex "retry" "random intervals"
23091The available algorithms are:
23092
23093.ilist
23094&'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
23095the interval.
23096.next
23097&'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
23098specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
23099is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
23100.next
23101&'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
23102retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
23103maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
23104the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
23105rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
23106members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
23107queue processing times.
23108.endlist
23109
23110When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
23111order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
23112used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
23113case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
23114current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
23115computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
23116interval is found. The main configuration variable
23117.cindex "limit" "retry interval"
23118.cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
23119.oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
23120&%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
23121cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
23122
23123A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
23124host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
23125basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
23126for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
23127generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
23128time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
23129time.
23130
23131.cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
23132Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
23133run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
23134starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
23135new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
23136If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
23137occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
23138messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
23139processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
23140your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
23141number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
23142sending everything to a smart host, for example).
23143
23144The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
23145&'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
23146&<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
23147&'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
23148are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
23149deliveries that have been deferred.
23150
23151
23152.section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
23153Here are some example retry rules:
23154.code
23155alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
23156wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
23157wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
23158lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23159* refused_A F,2h,20m;
23160* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
23161.endd
23162The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
23163&'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
23164mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
23165hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
23166parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
23167effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
23168fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
23169days.
23170
23171The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
23172happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
23173intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
23174first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
23175so on (this is a rather extreme example).
23176
23177The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
23178They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
23179all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
23180were not obtained from an MX record.
23181
23182The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
23183first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
23184not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
23185hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
231861.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
23187
23188
23189
23190.section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
23191.cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
23192.oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
23193.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
23194.cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
23195Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
23196consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
23197set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
23198been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
23199arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
23200failing for the first time.
23201
23202This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
23203backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
23204Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
23205down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
23206
23207If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
23208every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
23209message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
23210
23211
23212
23213
23214.section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
23215.cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
23216.cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
23217Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
23218that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
23219default retry rule:
23220.code
23221* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
23222.endd
23223the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
23224long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
23225failure for the recipient address that counts.
23226
23227When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
23228addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
23229causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
23230In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
23231time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
23232
23233For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
23234messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
23235post-cutoff retry time is not used.
23236
23237If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
23238.oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
23239&%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
23240default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
23241reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
23242attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
23243those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
23244the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
23245
23246In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
23247for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
23248times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
23249behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
23250to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
23251notice.
23252
23253If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23254addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
23255addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23256no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
23257words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
23258addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
23259If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
23260&%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
23261deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
23262true.
23263
23264.section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
23265.cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
23266Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
23267intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
23268its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
23269because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
23270host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
23271failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
23272reached.
23273
23274Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
23275applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
23276Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
23277examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
23278commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
23279time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
23280is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
23281time out the address.
23282
23283The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
23284the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
23285given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
23286time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
23287not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
23288considered immediately.
23289.ecindex IIDretconf1
23290.ecindex IIDregconf2
23291
23292
23293
23294
23295
23296
23297. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23298. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23299
23300.chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
23301.scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
23302.scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
23303The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
23304with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
23305described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
23306to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
23307permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
23308transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
23309other.
23310
23311.cindex "AUTH" "description of"
23312Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
23313
23314.ilist
23315The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
23316the client's EHLO command.
23317.next
23318The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
23319may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
23320.next
23321The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
23322appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
23323just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
23324any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
23325with the AUTH command.
23326.next
23327The server either accepts or denies authentication.
23328.next
23329If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
23330option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
23331mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
23332connection.
23333.next
23334If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
23335authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
23336unauthenticated connection.
23337.endlist
23338
23339If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
23340mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
23341SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
23342includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
23343.display
23344&`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
23345&`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
23346&`Connected to server.example.`&
23347&`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
23348&`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
23349&*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
23350&`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
23351&`250-SIZE 52428800`&
23352&`250-PIPELINING`&
23353&`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
23354&`250 HELP`&
23355.endd
23356The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
23357authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
23358mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
23359routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
23360controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
23361included by setting
23362.code
23363AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
23364AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
23365AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
23366AUTH_SPA=yes
23367.endd
23368in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
23369authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
23370the Cyrus SASL authentication library. The third can be configured to support
23371the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
23372not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The fourth authenticator
23373supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
23374
23375The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
23376section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
23377authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
23378authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
23379is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
23380messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
23381options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
23382
23383To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
23384&%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
23385either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
23386functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
23387to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
23388both sets of options, is required. For example:
23389.code
23390cram:
23391 driver = cram_md5
23392 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23393 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
23394 client_name = ph10
23395 client_secret = secret2
23396.endd
23397The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
23398&%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
23399
23400Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
23401The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
23402authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
23403in Exim.
23404
23405
23406
23407.section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
23408.cindex "authentication" "generic options"
23409.cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
23410
23411.option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23412When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
23413&%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
23414used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
23415encrypted by a setting such as:
23416.code
23417client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_cipher}{}}
23418.endd
23419(Older documentation incorrectly states that &$tls_cipher$& contains the cipher
23420used for incoming messages. In fact, during SMTP delivery, it contains the
23421cipher used for the delivery.)
23422
23423
23424.option driver authenticators string unset
23425This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
23426authenticators is to be used.
23427
23428
23429.option public_name authenticators string unset
23430This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
23431implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
23432contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
23433but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
23434defaults to the driver's instance name.
23435
23436
23437.option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23438When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
23439is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
23440mechanism is not advertised.
23441If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
23442forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
23443See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
23444
23445
23446.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23447This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
23448is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
23449for details.
23450
23451For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
23452authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
23453authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
23454authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
23455to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
23456error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
23457string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
23458expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
23459other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
23460the error text.
23461
23462
23463.option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
23464If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
23465command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
23466output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
23467out the values of variables.
23468If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
23469output, and Exim carries on processing.
23470
23471
23472.option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
23473.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23474When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
23475expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
23476messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
23477lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
23478configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
23479refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
23480If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
23481
23482
23483.option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23484This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
23485as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
23486driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
23487as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
23488remembered for later use.
23489How it is used is described in the following section.
23490
23491
23492
23493
23494
23495.section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
23496.cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
23497.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
23498When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
23499the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
23500message:
23501
23502.ilist
23503If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
23504than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
23505.next
23506If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
23507.next
23508.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
23509If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
23510running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
23511from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
23512&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
23513return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
23514given for the MAIL command.
23515.next
23516If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
23517is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
23518authenticated.
23519.next
23520If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
23521the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
23522&%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
23523valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
23524fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
23525&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
23526the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
23527message.
23528.endlist
23529
23530
23531When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
23532hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
23533&$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
23534process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
23535
23536.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23537Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
23538MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
23539therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
23540value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
23541ACL is run.
23542
23543
23544
23545.section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
23546.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
23547When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
23548authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
23549conditions:
23550
23551.ilist
23552The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
23553.next
23554It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
23555yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
23556.endlist
23557
23558The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
23559the mechanisms are advertised.
23560
23561Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
23562provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
23563even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
23564set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
23565You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
23566For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
23567that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
23568.code
23569auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
23570.endd
23571so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
23572
23573The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
23574authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
23575advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
23576such as:
23577.code
23578server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
23579.endd
23580.vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
23581If the session is encrypted, &$tls_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
23582yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
23583
23584When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
23585immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
23586command. This is the case if
23587
23588.ilist
23589The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
23590.next
23591No authenticators are configured with server options; or
23592.next
23593Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
23594server authenticators.
23595.endlist
23596
23597
23598Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
23599to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
23600AUTH is accepted from any client host.
23601
23602If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
23603server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
23604that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
23605the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
23606fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
23607rejected with a 504 error.
23608
23609.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
23610.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
23611When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
23612&$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
23613or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
23614public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
23615client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
23616no successful authentication.
23617
23618
23619
23620
23621.section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
23622.cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
23623.cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
23624.cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
23625Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
23626configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
23627encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
23628script:
23629.code
23630use MIME::Base64;
23631printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
23632.endd
23633.cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
23634This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
23635interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
23636some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
23637command line to run this script on such data might be
23638.code
23639encode '\0user\0password'
23640.endd
23641Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
23642backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
23643whose code value is zero.
23644
23645&*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
23646digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
23647you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
23648interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
23649
23650&*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
23651specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
23652example, a command such as
23653.code
23654encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
23655.endd
23656gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
23657
23658If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
23659base64-encoded strings is to run the command
23660.code
23661echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
23662.endd
23663The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
23664in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
23665output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
23666should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
23667
23668
23669
23670.section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
23671.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
23672The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
23673&%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
23674announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
23675of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
23676
23677.ilist
23678For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
23679they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
23680mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
23681of the authenticator.
23682.next
23683.vindex "&$host$&"
23684.vindex "&$host_address$&"
23685When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
23686variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
23687that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
23688any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
23689Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
23690delivery to be deferred.
23691.next
23692If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
23693Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
23694try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
23695usual way.
23696.next
23697If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
23698carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
23699possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
23700no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
23701what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
23702&%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
23703delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
23704turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
23705deliver the message unauthenticated.
23706.endlist
23707
23708.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
23709When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
23710parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
23711the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
23712is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
23713incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
23714allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
23715to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
23716&%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
23717&%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
23718the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
23719.ecindex IIDauthconf1
23720.ecindex IIDauthconf2
23721
23722
23723
23724
23725
23726
23727. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23728. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23729
23730.chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
23731.scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
23732.scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
23733The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
23734LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
23735plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
23736security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
23737(see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
23738use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
23739connections as you do for login accounts.
23740
23741.section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
23742.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
23743When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
23744
23745.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23746This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
23747configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
23748
23749.option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
23750The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
23751prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
23752given.
23753
23754.section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
23755.cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23756.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23757.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
23758 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23759.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
23760.cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23761
23762When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
23763expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
23764response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
23765values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
23766a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
23767are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
23768(neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
23769
23770For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
23771the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
23772variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
23773string expansions that also use them for other things.
23774
23775If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
23776supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
23777data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
23778
23779.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23780Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
23781&%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
23782authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
23783to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
23784&"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
23785expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
23786generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
23787For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
23788string as the error text.
23789
23790&*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
23791password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
23792There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
23793
23794
23795
23796.section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
23797.cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
23798.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
23799.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23800The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
23801sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
23802separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
23803subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
23804
23805The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
23806Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
23807configured as follows:
23808.code
23809fixed_plain:
23810 driver = plaintext
23811 public_name = PLAIN
23812 server_prompts = :
23813 server_condition = \
23814 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
23815 server_set_id = $auth2
23816.endd
23817Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
23818are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
23819password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
23820or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
23821
23822The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
23823the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
23824AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
23825authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
23826.code
23827250-AUTH PLAIN
23828.endd
23829and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
23830.code
23831AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
23832.endd
23833As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
23834data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
23835.code
23836AUTH PLAIN
23837.endd
23838to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
23839prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
23840
23841The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
23842when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
23843represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
23844is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
23845second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
23846
23847Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
23848realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
23849authenticating clients it could make sense.
23850
23851A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
23852&$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
23853comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
23854this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
23855This is an incorrect example:
23856.code
23857server_condition = \
23858 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
23859.endd
23860The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
23861which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
23862incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
23863non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
23864strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
23865the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
23866name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
23867.code
23868server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
23869 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
23870.endd
23871In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
23872fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
23873used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
23874always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
23875writing the test makes the logic clearer.
23876
23877
23878.section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
23879.cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
23880.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
23881The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
23882in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
23883user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
23884plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
23885.code
23886fixed_login:
23887 driver = plaintext
23888 public_name = LOGIN
23889 server_prompts = User Name : Password
23890 server_condition = \
23891 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
23892 server_set_id = $auth1
23893.endd
23894Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
23895with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
23896if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
23897strings are used to obtain two data items.
23898
23899Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
23900example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
23901&"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
23902strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
23903name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
23904.code
23905login:
23906 driver = plaintext
23907 public_name = LOGIN
23908 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
23909 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
23910 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
23911 ldapauth{user="cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
23912 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
23913 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
23914 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
23915.endd
23916We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
23917does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
23918operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
23919&%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
23920correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
23921the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
23922uninterpreted string.
23923
23924
23925.section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
23926A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
23927interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
23928traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
23929Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
23930&<<SECTexpcond>>&.
23931
23932
23933
23934
23935.section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
23936.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
23937The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
23938
23939.option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
23940If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
23941authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
23942the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
23943usual.
23944
23945.option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
23946The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
23947string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
23948string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
23949to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
23950most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
23951with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
23952way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
23953(with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
23954so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
23955&%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
23956&$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
23957
23958&*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
23959splitting takes priority and happens first.
23960
23961Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
23962the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
23963there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
23964NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
23965the string.
23966
23967This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
23968authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
23969.code
23970fixed_plain:
23971 driver = plaintext
23972 public_name = PLAIN
23973 client_send = ^username^mysecret
23974.endd
23975The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
23976command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
23977that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
23978.code
23979fixed_login:
23980 driver = plaintext
23981 public_name = LOGIN
23982 client_send = : username : mysecret
23983.endd
23984The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
23985the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
23986prompts.
23987.ecindex IIDplaiauth1
23988.ecindex IIDplaiauth2
23989
23990
23991
23992
23993. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23994. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23995
23996.chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
23997.scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
23998.scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
23999.cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
24000.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
24001The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
24002sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
24003name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
24004string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
24005is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
24006secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
24007available in plain text at either end.
24008
24009
24010.section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
24011.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
24012This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
24013authenticator as a server:
24014
24015.option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
24016.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
24017When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
24018the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
24019obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
24020that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
24021string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
24022fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
24023returned to the client.
24024
24025For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
24026in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
24027deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
24028numeric variables for other things.
24029
24030For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
24031client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
24032user name, authentication fails.
24033.code
24034fixed_cram:
24035 driver = cram_md5
24036 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24037 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
24038 server_set_id = $auth1
24039.endd
24040.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24041If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
24042name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
24043secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
24044.code
24045lookup_cram:
24046 driver = cram_md5
24047 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24048 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
24049 {$value}fail}
24050 server_set_id = $auth1
24051.endd
24052Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
24053because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
24054
24055
24056.section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
24057.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
24058When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
24059
24060
24061
24062.option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
24063This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
24064computing the response to the server's challenge.
24065
24066
24067.option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
24068This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
24069expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
24070
24071
24072.vindex "&$host$&"
24073.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24074Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
24075to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
24076expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
24077prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
24078authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
24079send the message to the current server.
24080
24081A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
24082strings, is:
24083.code
24084fixed_cram:
24085 driver = cram_md5
24086 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24087 client_name = ph10
24088 client_secret = secret
24089.endd
24090.ecindex IIDcramauth1
24091.ecindex IIDcramauth2
24092
24093
24094
24095. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24096. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24097
24098.chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
24099.scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
24100.scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
24101.cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
24102.cindex "Kerberos"
24103The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
24104Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
24105
24106The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
24107library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
24108Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
24109including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
24110directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
24111
24112The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
24113the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
24114then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
24115name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
24116
24117Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
24118or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
24119user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
24120by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
24121depending on the driver you are using.
24122
24123The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
24124be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
24125Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
24126changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
24127layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
24128implementation. For example, for Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
24129may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
24130variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
24131Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
24132
24133
24134.section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
24135The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
24136(on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
24137previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
24138use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
24139confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
24140things.
24141
24142
24143.option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
24144This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
24145library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
24146SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
24147
24148
24149.option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
24150This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
24151default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
24152you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
24153example:
24154.code
24155sasl:
24156 driver = cyrus_sasl
24157 public_name = X-ANYTHING
24158 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
24159 server_set_id = $auth1
24160.endd
24161
24162.option server_realm cyrus_sasl string unset
24163This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
24164
24165
24166.option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
24167This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
24168
24169
24170For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
24171private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
24172the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
24173PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
24174.code
24175sasl_cram_md5:
24176 driver = cyrus_sasl
24177 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24178 server_set_id = $auth1
24179
24180sasl_plain:
24181 driver = cyrus_sasl
24182 public_name = PLAIN
24183 server_set_id = $auth2
24184.endd
24185Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
24186not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
24187but it is present in many binary distributions.
24188.ecindex IIDcyrauth1
24189.ecindex IIDcyrauth2
24190
24191
24192
24193
24194. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24195. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24196.chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
24197.scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
24198.scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
24199This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
24200Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
24201If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
24202to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
24203authenticator only. There is only one option:
24204
24205.option server_socket dovecot string unset
24206
24207This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
24208authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
24209mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
24210authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
24211.code
24212dovecot_plain:
24213 driver = dovecot
24214 public_name = PLAIN
24215 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
24216 server_set_id = $auth2
24217
24218dovecot_ntlm:
24219 driver = dovecot
24220 public_name = NTLM
24221 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
24222 server_set_id = $auth1
24223.endd
24224If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
24225&$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
24226option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
24227connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
24228option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
24229who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
24230.ecindex IIDdcotauth1
24231.ecindex IIDdcotauth2
24232
24233
24234. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24235. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24236
24237.chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
24238.scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
24239.scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
24240.cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
24241.cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
24242.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
24243.cindex "NTLM authentication"
24244The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
24245Password Authentication'& mechanism,
24246which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
24247this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
24248taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
24249server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
24250follows:
24251
24252.ilist
24253After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
24254authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
24255.next
24256The server sends back a challenge.
24257.next
24258The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
24259and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
24260.endlist
24261
24262Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
24263
24264
24265
24266.section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
24267.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
24268The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
24269
24270.option server_password spa string&!! unset
24271.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
24272This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
24273authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
24274compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
24275&$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
24276it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
24277for other things. For example:
24278.code
24279spa:
24280 driver = spa
24281 public_name = NTLM
24282 server_password = \
24283 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
24284.endd
24285If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
24286failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
24287
24288
24289
24290
24291
24292.section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
24293.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
24294The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
24295
24296
24297
24298.option client_domain spa string&!! unset
24299This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
24300
24301
24302.option client_password spa string&!! unset
24303This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
24304
24305
24306.option client_username spa string&!! unset
24307This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
24308configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
24309&'msn.com'&:
24310.code
24311msn:
24312 driver = spa
24313 public_name = MSN
24314 client_username = msn/msn_username
24315 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
24316 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
24317.endd
24318.ecindex IIDspaauth1
24319.ecindex IIDspaauth2
24320
24321
24322
24323
24324
24325. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24326. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24327
24328.chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
24329 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
24330.scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
24331.scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
24332.cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
24333.cindex "OpenSSL"
24334.cindex "GnuTLS"
24335Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
24336Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
24337GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
24338cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
24339order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
24340version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
24341You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
24342level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
24343certificates are used.
24344
24345RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
24346connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
24347server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
24348mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
24349between them is encrypted.
24350
24351Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
24352and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
24353certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
24354possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
24355encryption state.
24356
24357&*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
24358disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
24359in order to get TLS to work.
24360
24361
24362
24363.section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
24364 "SECID284"
24365.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
24366.cindex "smtps protocol"
24367.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
24368.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
24369Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
24370SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
24371waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
24372port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
24373allocated for this purpose.
24374
24375This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
24376still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
24377the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
24378numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
24379.code
24380tls_on_connect_ports = 465
24381.endd
24382The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
24383via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
24384the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
24385the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
24386an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
24387defined elsewhere.
24388
24389There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
24390&%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
24391
24392
24393
24394
24395
24396
24397.section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
24398.cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
24399The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
24400followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
24401to use GnuTLS, you need to set
24402.code
24403USE_GNUTLS=yes
24404.endd
24405in Local/Makefile, in addition to
24406.code
24407SUPPORT_TLS=yes
24408.endd
24409You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
24410include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
24411
24412There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
24413
24414.ilist
24415The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must contain the name of a file, not the
24416name of a directory (for OpenSSL it can be either).
24417.next
24418The &%tls_dhparam%& option is ignored, because early versions of GnuTLS had no
24419facility for varying its Diffie-Hellman parameters. I understand that this has
24420changed, but Exim has not been updated to provide this facility.
24421.next
24422.vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
24423Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
24424separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
24425affects the value of the &$tls_peerdn$& variable.
24426.next
24427OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
24428DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS uses underscores, for example: RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is
24429more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present in a cipher list. To make
24430life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens for OpenSSL and hyphens to
24431underscores for GnuTLS when processing lists of cipher suites in the
24432&%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
24433option).
24434.next
24435The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
24436sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
24437.endlist
24438
24439
24440.section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECID181"
24441GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
24442to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
24443Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
24444&_gnutls-params_&. The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
24445its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
24446parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
24447that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
24448renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
24449this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
24450place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
24451
24452For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
24453recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
24454Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
24455values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
24456parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
24457If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
24458until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
24459a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
24460
24461The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
24462in &_gnutls-params_& in PEM format, which means that they can be generated
24463externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
24464
24465To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
24466and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
24467&(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
24468renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
24469.code
24470# rm -f new-params
24471# touch new-params
24472# chown exim:exim new-params
24473# chmod 0400 new-params
24474# certtool --generate-privkey --bits 512 >new-params
24475# echo "" >>new-params
24476# certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 1024 >> new-params
24477# mv new-params gnutls-params
24478.endd
24479If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
24480stalling is removed.
24481
24482
24483.section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
24484.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
24485.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
24486There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
24487suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
24488are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
24489DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
24490directly to this function call. The following quotation from the OpenSSL
24491documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
24492
24493.ilist
24494It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
24495.next
24496It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
24497or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
24498ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
24499SSL v3 algorithms.
24500.next
24501Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
24502the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
24503SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
24504algorithms.
24505.endlist
24506
24507Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
24508&`-`& or &`+`&.
24509.ilist
24510If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
24511ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
24512stated.
24513.next
24514If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
24515of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
24516.next
24517If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
24518option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
24519.endlist
24520
24521If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
24522a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
24523includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
24524not be moved to the end of the list.
24525.endlist
24526
24527
24528
24529.section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
24530 "SECTreqciphgnu"
24531.cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
24532.cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
24533.cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
24534.cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
24535.cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
24536.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
24537The GnuTLS library allows the caller to specify separate lists of permitted key
24538exchange methods, main cipher algorithms, MAC algorithms, and protocols.
24539Unfortunately, these lists are numerical, and the library does not have a
24540function for turning names into numbers. Consequently, lists of recognized
24541names have to be built into the application. The permitted key exchange
24542methods, ciphers, and MAC algorithms may be used in any combination to form a
24543cipher suite. This is unlike OpenSSL, where complete cipher suite names are
24544passed to its control function.
24545
24546For compatibility with OpenSSL, the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option can be set
24547to complete cipher suite names such as RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA, but for GnuTLS this
24548option controls only the cipher algorithms. Exim searches each item in the
24549list for the name of an available algorithm. For example, if the list
24550contains RSA_AES_SHA, then AES is recognized, and the behaviour is exactly
24551the same as if just AES were given.
24552
24553.oindex "&%gnutls_require_kx%&"
24554.oindex "&%gnutls_require_mac%&"
24555.oindex "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&"
24556There are additional options called &%gnutls_require_kx%&,
24557&%gnutls_require_mac%&, and &%gnutls_require_protocols%& that can be used to
24558restrict the key exchange methods, MAC algorithms, and protocols, respectively.
24559These options are ignored if OpenSSL is in use.
24560
24561All four options are available as global options, controlling how Exim
24562behaves as a server, and also as options of the &(smtp)& transport, controlling
24563how Exim behaves as a client. All the values are string expanded. After
24564expansion, the values must be colon-separated lists, though the separator
24565can be changed in the usual way.
24566
24567Each of the four lists starts out with a default set of algorithms. If the
24568first item in a list does &'not'& start with an exclamation mark, all the
24569default items are deleted. In this case, only those that are explicitly
24570specified can be used. If the first item in a list &'does'& start with an
24571exclamation mark, the defaults are left on the list.
24572
24573Then, any item that starts with an exclamation mark causes the relevant
24574entry to be removed from the list, and any item that does not start with an
24575exclamation mark causes a new entry to be added to the list. Unrecognized
24576items in the list are ignored. Thus:
24577.code
24578tls_require_ciphers = !ARCFOUR
24579.endd
24580allows all the defaults except ARCFOUR, whereas
24581.code
24582tls_require_ciphers = AES : 3DES
24583.endd
24584allows only cipher suites that use AES or 3DES.
24585
24586For &%tls_require_ciphers%& the recognized names are AES_256, AES_128, AES
24587(both of the preceding), 3DES, ARCFOUR_128, ARCFOUR_40, and ARCFOUR (both of
24588the preceding). The default list does not contain all of these; it just has
24589AES_256, AES_128, 3DES, and ARCFOUR_128.
24590
24591For &%gnutls_require_kx%&, the recognized names are DHE_RSA, RSA (which
24592includes DHE_RSA), DHE_DSS, and DHE (which includes both DHE_RSA and
24593DHE_DSS). The default list contains RSA, DHE_DSS, DHE_RSA.
24594
24595For &%gnutls_require_mac%&, the recognized names are SHA (synonym SHA1), and
24596MD5. The default list contains SHA, MD5.
24597
24598.new
24599For &%gnutls_require_protocols%&, the recognized names are TLS1.2, TLS1.1,
24600TLS1.0, (TLS1) and SSL3.
24601The default list contains TLS1.2, TLS1.1, TLS1.0, SSL3.
24602TLS1 is an alias for TLS1.0, for backwards compatibility.
24603For sufficiently old versions of the GnuTLS library, TLS1.2 or TLS1.1 might
24604not be supported and will not be recognised by Exim.
24605.wen
24606
24607In a server, the order of items in these lists is unimportant. The server
24608advertises the availability of all the relevant cipher suites. However, in a
24609client, the order in the &%tls_require_ciphers%& list specifies a preference
24610order for the cipher algorithms. The first one in the client's list that is
24611also advertised by the server is tried first. The default order is as listed
24612above.
24613
24614
24615
24616.section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
24617.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
24618When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
24619the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
24620but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
24621that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
24622need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
24623sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
24624
24625If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
24626problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
24627persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
24628with the error
24629.code
24630554 Security failure
24631.endd
24632If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
24633rejected with a 554 error code.
24634
24635To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
24636match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
24637However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
24638without some further configuration at the server end.
24639
24640It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
24641encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
24642.code
24643tls_certificate = /some/file/name
24644tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
24645.endd
24646These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
24647the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
24648contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
24649that goes with it. These files need to be readable by the Exim user, and must
24650always be given as full path names. They can be the same file if both the
24651certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
24652set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
24653is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
24654certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
24655the server's certificate.
24656
24657If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
24658source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
24659few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
24660
24661&*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
24662they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
24663Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
24664transport.
24665
24666With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
24667require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
24668this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
24669.code
24670tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
24671.endd
24672is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
24673with the parameters contained in the file. This increases the set of cipher
24674suites that the server supports. See the command
24675.code
24676openssl dhparam
24677.endd
24678for a way of generating this data. At present, &%tls_dhparam%& is used only
24679when Exim is linked with OpenSSL. It is ignored if GnuTLS is being used.
24680
24681The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
24682host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
24683for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
24684in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
24685forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
24686
24687.cindex "cipher" "logging"
24688.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
24689.vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
24690The variable &$tls_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
24691an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
24692incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
24693also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
24694&"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
24695condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
24696(For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_cipher$& is reset &-- see section
24697&<<SECID185>>&.)
24698
24699Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
24700can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
24701cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
24702example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
24703contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
24704documentation for more details.
24705
24706
24707.section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
24708.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
24709.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
24710If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
24711session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
24712&%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
24713apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
24714Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
24715contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
24716expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
24717for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
24718&%tls_verify_certificates%&.
24719
24720A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
24721directory is used
24722(OpenSSL only),
24723each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
24724of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
24725certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
24726.code
24727openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
24728.endd
24729where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
24730
24731The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
24732what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
24733does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
24734&%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
24735attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
24736dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
24737session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
24738fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
24739example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
24740relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
24741
24742.vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
24743When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
24744the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
24745&$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
24746
24747.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
24748Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
24749&'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
24750&"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
24751&%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
24752certificate is supplied, &$tls_peerdn$& is empty.
24753
24754
24755.section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
24756.cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
24757.cindex "revocation list"
24758.cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
24759Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
24760certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
24761server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
24762an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
24763of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
24764CRL in PEM format.
24765
24766
24767.section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
24768.cindex "cipher" "logging"
24769.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
24770.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
24771.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
24772The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
24773deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
24774server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
24775within the &(smtp)& transport.
24776
24777It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
24778transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
24779server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
24780this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
24781transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
24782
24783If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
24784to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
24785&%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
24786those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
24787set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
24788usual way.
24789
24790When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
24791the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
24792a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
24793session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
24794&%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
24795delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
24796it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
24797STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
24798negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24799unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24800unencrypted.
24801
24802The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
24803transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
24804if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
24805&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
24806
24807If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
24808must name a file or,
24809for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
24810expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
24811against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
24812in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
24813
24814If
24815&%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
24816list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
24817the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
24818alternative hosts, if any.
24819
24820 &*Note*&:
24821These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
24822is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
24823by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
24824client.
24825
24826.vindex "&$host$&"
24827.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24828All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
24829&$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
24830which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
24831behave as if the relevant option were unset.
24832
24833.vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24834.vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24835Before an SMTP connection is established, the &$tls_cipher$& and &$tls_peerdn$&
24836variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
24837that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
24838successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
24839outgoing connection.
24840
24841
24842
24843.section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
24844 "SECTmulmessam"
24845.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
24846.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24847Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
24848an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
24849one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
24850of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
24851connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
24852to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
24853session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
24854try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
24855if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
24856
24857The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
24858after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
24859just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
24860reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
24861successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
24862SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
24863should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
24864subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
24865and delay other deliveries to that host.
24866
24867To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
24868closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
24869closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
24870information is recorded.
24871
24872There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
24873&(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
24874connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
24875
24876
24877
24878
24879.section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
24880.cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
24881In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
24882certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
24883place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
24884myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
24885to Apache, currently at
24886.display
24887&url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
24888.endd
24889Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
24890links to further files.
24891Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
248920-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
24893Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
24894.display
24895&url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
24896.endd
24897
24898
24899.section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
24900The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
24901certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
24902sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
24903not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
24904First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
24905certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
24906intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
24907certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
24908The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
24909validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
24910root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
24911install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
24912
24913
24914.section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
24915.cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
24916You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
24917with OpenSSL, like this:
24918.code
24919openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
24920 -days 9999 -nodes
24921.endd
24922&_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
24923delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
24924specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
24925important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
24926that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
24927prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
24928this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
24929
24930A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
24931may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
24932encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
24933
24934However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
24935user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
24936certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
24937must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
24938authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
24939signed with that self-signed certificate.
24940
24941For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
24942user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
24943Open-source PKI book, available online at
24944&url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
24945.ecindex IIDencsmtp1
24946.ecindex IIDencsmtp2
24947
24948
24949
24950. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24951. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24952
24953.chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
24954.scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
24955.cindex "control of incoming mail"
24956.cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
24957.cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
24958Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
24959configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
24960name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
24961one very small ACL:
24962.code
24963begin acl
24964small_acl:
24965 accept hosts = one.host.only
24966.endd
24967You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
24968which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
24969
24970The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
24971certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
24972when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
24973option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
24974in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
24975local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
24976a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
24977&<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
24978
24979
24980.section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
24981The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
24982configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
24983The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
24984relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
24985
24986
24987
24988.section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
24989.cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
24990In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
24991options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
24992.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
24993.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
24994.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
24995.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
24996.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
24997.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
24998.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
24999.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
25000.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
25001.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
25002.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
25003.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
25004.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
25005.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
25006
25007.table2 140pt
25008.irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
25009.irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
25010.irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
25011.irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
25012.irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
25013.irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
25014.irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
25015.irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
25016.irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
25017.irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
25018.irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
25019.irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
25020.irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
25021.irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
25022.irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
25023.irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
25024.irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
25025.irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
25026.endtable
25027
25028For example, if you set
25029.code
25030acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
25031.endd
25032the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
25033in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
25034done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
25035sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
25036command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
25037trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
25038testing as possible at RCPT time.
25039
25040
25041.section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
25042.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
25043The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
25044apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
25045really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
25046the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
25047relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
25048are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
25049&$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
25050&$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
25051in any of these ACLs.
25052
25053The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
25054non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
25055analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
25056batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
25057result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
25058really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
25059on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
25060controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
25061.code
25062control = suppress_local_fixups
25063.endd
25064This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
25065run, it is too late.
25066
25067The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
25068content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
25069
25070The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
25071kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
25072temporary error for these kinds of message.
25073
25074
25075.section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
25076.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
25077.oindex &%smtp_banner%&
25078The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
25079session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
25080an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
25081accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
25082the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
25083&%smtp_banner%& option.
25084
25085
25086.section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
25087.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
25088.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
25089The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
25090EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
25091&%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
25092Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
25093session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
25094setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
25095
25096If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
25097modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
25098at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
25099affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
25100an EHLO response.
25101
25102
25103.section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
25104.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
25105Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
25106command, with two responses being sent to the client.
25107When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
25108is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
25109the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
25110response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
25111added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
25112are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
25113
25114You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
25115in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
25116tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
25117received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
25118the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
25119associated with the DATA command.
25120
25121For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
25122error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
25123MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
25124before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
25125and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
25126your resources.
25127
25128
25129.section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
25130The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
25131enabled (which is the default).
25132
25133The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
25134received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
25135otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
25136
25137For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHID12>>&.
25138
25139
25140.section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
25141The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
25142content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
25143
25144
25145.section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
25146.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
25147The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
25148does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
25149does not in fact control any access. For this reason, the only verbs that are
25150permitted are &%accept%& and &%warn%&.
25151
25152This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
25153session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
25154messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
25155more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
25156
25157&*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
25158the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
25159
25160You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
25161&%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
25162response to QUIT.
25163
25164This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
25165failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
25166because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
25167client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
25168connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
25169
25170
25171.section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
25172.vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
25173The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
25174an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is is bad
25175trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
25176because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
25177situation even worse.
25178
25179Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
25180logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
25181modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
25182and &%warn%&.
25183
25184.vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
25185When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
25186to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
25187connection. The possible values are:
25188.table2
25189.irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
25190.irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
25191.irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
25192.irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
25193.irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
25194.irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
25195.irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
25196.irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
25197.irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
25198.irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
25199.endtable
25200In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
25201Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
25202With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
25203overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
25204&%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
25205used.
25206
25207
25208.section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
25209.cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
25210The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
25211you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
25212.code
25213acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
25214 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
25215.endd
25216In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
25217providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
25218non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
25219expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
25220more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
25221
25222The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
25223configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
25224string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
25225
25226.ilist
25227If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
25228contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
25229Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
25230lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
25231If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
25232causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
25233.code
25234acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
25235 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
25236 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
25237.endd
25238This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
25239back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
25240file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
25241can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
25242.next
25243If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
25244Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
25245matches the string.
25246.next
25247If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
25248the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
25249want to have something like
25250.code
25251acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
25252.endd
25253in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
25254newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
25255.endlist
25256
25257
25258
25259
25260.section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
25261.cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
25262Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
25263section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
25264&"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
25265database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
25266return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
25267&"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
25268This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
25269
25270For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
25271&"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
25272submitters of non-SMTP messages.
25273
25274
25275ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
25276has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
25277individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
25278blackholing facility. Use it with care.
25279
25280If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
25281ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
25282RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
25283recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
25284run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
25285remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
25286&%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
25287
25288
25289.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
25290The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
25291recipients; it may create new recipients.
25292
25293
25294
25295.section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
25296.cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
25297The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
25298all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
25299not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
25300reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
25301
25302For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
25303these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
25304used to accept or reject anything.
25305
25306For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
25307&%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
25308&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
25309when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
25310
25311For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
25312&%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
25313This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
25314messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
25315configuration file.
25316
25317
25318
25319
25320.section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
25321.cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
25322.vindex &$domain$&
25323.vindex &$local_part$&
25324.vindex &$sender_address$&
25325.vindex &$sender_host_address$&
25326.vindex &$smtp_command$&
25327When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
25328that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
25329&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
25330statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
25331&$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
25332is available in &$smtp_command$&.
25333
25334When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
25335contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
25336set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
25337how it is used.
25338
25339.vindex "&$message_size$&"
25340The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
25341the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
25342that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
25343the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
25344received).
25345
25346.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
25347.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
25348The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
25349The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
25350accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
25351of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
25352&$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
25353&$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
25354
25355
25356
25357
25358
25359.section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
25360.cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
25361.vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
25362.vindex &$smtp_command$&
25363When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
25364the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
25365and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
25366These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
25367here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
25368encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
25369does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
25370unencrypted connections.
25371.code
25372acl_check_auth:
25373 accept encrypted = *
25374 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
25375 {CRAM-MD5}}
25376 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
25377.endd
25378(Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
25379that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
25380encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
25381option to do this.)
25382
25383
25384
25385.section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
25386.cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
25387.cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
25388An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
25389with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
25390Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
25391set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
25392
25393If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
25394used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
25395provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
25396example:
25397.code
25398deny dnslists = list1.example
25399dnslists = list2.example
25400.endd
25401If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
25402the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
25403happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
25404all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
25405test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
25406
25407
25408.section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
25409The ACL verbs are as follows:
25410
25411.ilist
25412.cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
25413&%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
25414of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
25415appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
25416is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
25417after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
25418check a RCPT command:
25419.code
25420accept domains = +local_domains
25421endpass
25422verify = recipient
25423.endd
25424If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
25425passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
25426the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
25427fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
25428&%endpass%&.
25429
25430The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
25431use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
25432that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
25433configuration.
25434
25435.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
25436If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
25437depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
25438(when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
25439statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
25440SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
25441.display
25442&`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
25443&` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
25444.endd
25445You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
25446response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
25447same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
25448
25449If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
25450an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
25451for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
25452of &%endpass%&.
25453
25454
25455.next
25456.cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
25457&%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
25458an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
25459&%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
25460temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
25461&(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
25462be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
25463
25464
25465.next
25466.cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
25467&%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
25468the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
25469example,
25470.code
25471deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
25472.endd
25473rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
25474
25475
25476.next
25477.cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
25478&%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
25479&"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
25480that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
25481the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
25482recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
25483recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
25484message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
25485do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
25486
25487If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
25488its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
25489The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
25490
25491
25492.next
25493.cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
25494&%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
25495forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
25496.code
25497drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
25498 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
25499.endd
25500There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
25501The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
25502
25503.next
25504.cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
25505&%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
25506statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
25507example, when checking a RCPT command,
25508.code
25509require message = Sender did not verify
25510 verify = sender
25511.endd
25512passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
25513verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
25514&%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
25515discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
25516
25517.next
25518.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
25519&%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
25520&%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
25521to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
25522written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
25523message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
25524duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
25525
25526If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
25527and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
25528&%logwrite%&, and &%add_header%&) that appear before the first failing
25529condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
25530&<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
25531
25532If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
25533some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
25534This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
25535is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
25536conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
25537is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
25538onwards.
25539
25540
25541.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25542When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
25543text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
25544want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
25545.code
25546warn !verify = sender
25547 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
25548.endd
25549.endlist
25550
25551At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
25552
25553As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
25554written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
25555subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
25556continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
25557mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
25558
25559
25560
25561.section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
25562.cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
25563There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
25564can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
25565of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
25566transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
25567variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
25568an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
25569alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
25570the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
25571.ilist
25572The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
25573throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
25574while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
25575on the same SMTP connection.
25576.next
25577The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
25578while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
25579reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
25580.endlist
25581
25582When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
25583preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
25584time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
25585.code
25586accept hosts = whatever
25587 set acl_m4 = some value
25588accept authenticated = *
25589 set acl_c_auth = yes
25590.endd
25591&*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
25592be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
25593&%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
25594
25595.oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
25596What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
25597referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
25598false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
25599error is generated.
25600
25601Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
25602their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
25603
25604
25605.section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
25606.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
25607.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
25608An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
25609.code
25610deny domains = *.dom.example
25611 !verify = recipient
25612.endd
25613causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
25614&'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
25615negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
25616two statements are equivalent:
25617.code
25618deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
25619deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
25620.endd
25621However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
25622side negation of the whole condition is possible.
25623
25624The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
25625of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
25626condition is true. Consider these two statements:
25627.code
25628accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
25629 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
25630accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
25631 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
25632.endd
25633Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
25634the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
25635different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
25636condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
25637therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
25638the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
25639and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
25640
25641ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
25642specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
25643others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
25644warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
25645message is handled.
25646
25647The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement important, because the
25648processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
25649modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
25650consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
25651.code
25652require message = Can't verify sender
25653 verify = sender
25654 message = Can't verify recipient
25655 verify = recipient
25656 message = This message cannot be used
25657.endd
25658If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
25659&"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
25660so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
25661recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
25662verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
25663because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
25664
25665For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
25666modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
25667happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
25668the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
25669.code
25670deny hosts = ...
25671 !senders = *@my.domain.example
25672 message = Invalid sender from client host
25673.endd
25674The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
25675by which time Exim has set up the message.
25676
25677
25678
25679.section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
25680.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
25681The ACL modifiers are as follows:
25682
25683.vlist
25684.vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25685This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
25686incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
25687accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
25688
25689.vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25690.cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
25691.cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
25692This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
25693continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
25694the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
25695update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
25696write rather ugly lines like this:
25697.display
25698&`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
25699.endd
25700Instead, all you need is
25701.display
25702&`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
25703.endd
25704
25705.vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25706.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
25707This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
25708incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
25709lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
25710lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
25711controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
25712even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
25713
25714As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
25715separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
25716in several different ways. For example:
25717
25718. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
25719. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
25720. ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
25721. ==== way.
25722
25723.ilist
25724It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
25725.code
25726 accept ...some conditions
25727 control = queue_only
25728.endd
25729In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
25730other words, when the conditions are all true.
25731
25732.next
25733It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
25734.code
25735 accept ...some conditions...
25736 control = queue_only
25737 ...some more conditions...
25738.endd
25739If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
25740statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
25741In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
25742to be relevant.
25743
25744.next
25745It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
25746decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
25747example:
25748.code
25749 warn ...some conditions...
25750 control = freeze
25751 accept ...
25752.endd
25753This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
25754&%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
25755log entry.
25756
25757.next
25758If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
25759&%require%& verb. For example:
25760.code
25761 require control = no_multiline_responses
25762.endd
25763.endlist
25764
25765.vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
25766.cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
25767.oindex "&%-bh%&"
25768This modifier may appear in any ACL. It causes Exim to wait for the time
25769interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the &%-bh%&
25770option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is output
25771instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay happens
25772as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending output is
25773flushed before the delay is imposed.
25774
25775Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
25776example:
25777.code
25778deny ...some conditions...
25779 delay = 30s
25780.endd
25781The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
25782&"deny"&. Compare this with:
25783.code
25784deny delay = 30s
25785 ...some conditions...
25786.endd
25787which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
25788can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
25789.code
25790warn ...some conditions...
25791 delay = 2m
25792 control = freeze
25793accept ...
25794.endd
25795
25796If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
25797responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
25798they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
25799delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
25800appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
25801unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
25802using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
25803
25804
25805.vitem &*endpass*&
25806.cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
25807This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
25808&%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
25809failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
25810failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
25811confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
25812&"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
25813
25814
25815.vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25816.cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
25817This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
25818ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
25819.code
25820require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_cipher
25821 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
25822.endd
25823&%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
25824example:
25825.display
25826&`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
25827&` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
25828.endd
25829When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
25830that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
25831recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
25832message.
25833
25834The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
25835the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
25836denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
25837available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
25838variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
25839&%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
25840ignored.
25841
25842.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25843If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
25844verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
25845error message.
25846
25847If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
25848the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
25849more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
25850actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
25851of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
25852is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
25853
25854If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
25855example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
25856the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
25857logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
25858both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
25859logging rejections.
25860
25861
25862.vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
25863.cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
25864.cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
25865This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
25866about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
25867be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
25868may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
25869ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
25870.display
25871&`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
25872&` log_reject_target =`&
25873.endd
25874This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
25875permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
25876current ACL.
25877
25878
25879.vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25880.cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
25881.cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
25882This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
25883processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
25884&%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
25885access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
25886ACLs. For example:
25887.display
25888&`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
25889&` control = freeze`&
25890&` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
25891.endd
25892By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
25893with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
25894another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
25895example:
25896.code
25897logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
25898logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
25899.endd
25900
25901
25902.vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25903.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
25904This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
25905message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
25906or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
25907there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
25908&%accept%& for details.)
25909
25910The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
25911to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
25912generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
25913&%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
25914the &%hosts%& condition fails:
25915.code
25916require message = Host not recognized
25917 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
25918.endd
25919(Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
25920processed.)
25921
25922.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
25923.oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
25924For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
25925of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
25926is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
25927is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
25928overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
25929accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
25930truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
25931EHLO options.
25932
25933When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
25934consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
25935of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
25936.code
25937deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
25938 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
25939.endd
25940The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
25941by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
25942access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
259432&'xx'&.
25944
25945Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
25946the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
25947
25948The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
25949literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
25950anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
25951response.
25952
25953.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25954If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
25955specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
25956However, the original message is available in the variable
25957&$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
25958wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
25959routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
25960use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
25961
25962For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
25963is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
25964modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
25965all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
25966&%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
25967&%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
25968effect.
25969
25970
25971.vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
25972.cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
25973This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
25974&<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
25975.endlist
25976
25977
25978
25979
25980
25981.section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
25982.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
25983The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
25984
25985.vlist
25986.vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
25987This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
25988has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
25989apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
25990HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
25991really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
25992not work without it. For example:
25993.code
25994warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
25995 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
25996.endd
25997Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
25998the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
25999matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
26000mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
26001by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
26002
26003
26004.vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
26005 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
26006.cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
26007.cindex "case of local parts"
26008.vindex "&$local_part$&"
26009These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
26010(that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
26011are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
26012any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
26013for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
26014is encountered.
26015
26016These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
26017local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
26018in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
26019handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
26020configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
26021
26022This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
26023containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
26024spam score:
26025.code
26026warn control = caseful_local_part
26027 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
26028 $acl_m4 + \
26029 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
26030 }
26031 control = caselower_local_part
26032.endd
26033Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
26034is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
26035
26036
26037.vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
26038.cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
26039.cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
26040This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
26041with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
26042&'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
26043may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
26044the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
26045option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
26046contexts):
26047.code
26048 control = debug
26049 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
26050 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
26051 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
26052.endd
26053
26054
26055.vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
26056 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
26057.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
26058.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
26059These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
26060is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
26061state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
26062in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
26063
26064The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
26065connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
26066messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
26067&%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
26068before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
26069synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
26070work with.
26071
26072
26073.vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
26074.cindex "fake defer"
26075.cindex "defer, fake"
26076This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
26077except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
26078550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
26079messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
26080use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
26081
26082.vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
26083.cindex "fake rejection"
26084.cindex "rejection, fake"
26085This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
26086words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
26087message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
26088However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
26089only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
26090the same SMTP connection.
26091
26092The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
26093message is supplied, the following is used:
26094.code
26095550-Your message has been rejected but is being
26096550-kept for evaluation.
26097550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
26098550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
26099.endd
26100This facility should be used with extreme caution.
26101
26102.vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
26103.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
26104This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
26105other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
26106it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
26107current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
26108SMTP connection.
26109
26110This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
26111&%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
26112is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
26113are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
26114
26115.vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
26116.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
26117Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
26118avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
26119use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
26120disables such output flushing.
26121
26122.vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
26123.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
26124Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
26125avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
26126use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
26127that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
26128
26129.vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
26130This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
26131extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
26132of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
26133or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
26134needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
26135only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
26136the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
26137to be useful in production.
26138
26139.vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
26140.cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
26141This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
26142It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
26143SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
26144
26145If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
26146suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
26147one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
26148(&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
26149responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
26150sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
26151
26152.ilist
26153Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
26154sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
26155verification failed"&) is sent.
26156.next
26157If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
26158line is output.
26159.endlist
26160
26161The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
26162calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
26163
26164.vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
26165.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
26166This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
26167the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
26168response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
26169controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
26170&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
26171
26172.vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
26173.oindex "&%queue_only%&"
26174.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
26175This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
26176other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
26177it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
26178runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
26179effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
26180to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
26181same SMTP connection.
26182
26183.vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
26184.cindex "message" "submission"
26185.cindex "submission mode"
26186This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
26187latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
26188the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
26189operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
26190necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
26191This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
26192late (the message has already been created).
26193
26194Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
26195messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
26196submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
26197The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
26198that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
26199
26200.vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
26201.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
26202This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
26203complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
26204normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
26205
26206.ilist
26207Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
26208dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
26209.next
26210No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
26211.next
26212There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
26213.endlist ilist
26214
26215This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
26216passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
26217used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
26218and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
26219data is read.
26220
26221&*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
26222that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
26223.endlist vlist
26224
26225
26226.section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
26227All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
26228
26229.ilist
26230Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
26231.next
26232Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
26233&`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
26234.next
26235Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
26236.next
26237Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
26238.endlist
26239
26240
26241
26242.section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
26243.cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
26244.cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
26245.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
26246The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
26247to an incoming message, as in this example:
26248.code
26249warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26250 dialup.mail-abuse.org
26251 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
26252.endd
26253The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
26254MIME, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
26255receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
26256&%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
26257any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
26258RCPT ACL).
26259
26260If the data for the &%add_header%& modifier contains one or more newlines that
26261are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
26262lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
26263front of any line that is not a valid header line.
26264
26265Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
26266They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
26267However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
26268is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
26269during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
26270with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
26271lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
26272In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
26273non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
26274message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
26275are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
26276
26277.cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
26278Header lines are not visible in string expansions until they are added to the
26279message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
26280ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
26281header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
26282ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
26283passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
26284this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
26285&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
26286
26287The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately it is encountered during the
26288processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
26289.display
26290&`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
26291&` `&<&'some condition'&>
26292
26293&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
26294&` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
26295.endd
26296In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
26297condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
26298condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
26299ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
26300honoured.
26301
26302.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
26303For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
26304&%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
26305effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
26306them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
26307usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
26308are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
26309specifications.
26310
26311By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
26312header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
26313be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
26314after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
26315that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
26316
26317This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
26318&":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
26319header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
26320to be a header name first.) For example:
26321.code
26322warn add_header = \
26323 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
26324.endd
26325If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
26326each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
26327you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
26328up in reverse order.
26329
26330&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
26331added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
26332system filter or in a router or transport.
26333
26334
26335
26336
26337.section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
26338.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
26339Some of conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
26340compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
26341for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
26342content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26343
26344Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
26345senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
26346result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
26347done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
26348can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
26349same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
26350The conditions are as follows:
26351
26352
26353.vlist
26354.vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
26355.cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
26356.cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
26357.cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
26358The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
26359&%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
26360&"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
26361false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
26362condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
26363condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
26364ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
26365
26366If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
26367the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
26368&%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
26369conditions are tested.
26370
26371ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
26372loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
26373circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
26374for different local users or different local domains.
26375
26376.vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
26377.cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
26378.cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
26379.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
26380If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
26381the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
26382authentication by any authenticator, you can set
26383.code
26384authenticated = *
26385.endd
26386
26387.vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
26388.cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
26389.cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
26390.cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
26391.cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
26392This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
26393expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
26394&"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
26395number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
26396any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
26397&"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
26398ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
26399negative.
26400
26401.vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
26402.cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
26403This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26404content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
26405&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
26406If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
26407problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
26408chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26409
26410.vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
26411.cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
26412This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26413content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
26414&<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
26415
26416.vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
26417.cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
26418.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
26419.cindex "black list (DNS)"
26420.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
26421This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
26422&"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
26423use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
26424different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
26425&<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
26426
26427.vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
26428.cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
26429.cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
26430.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
26431.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
26432This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
26433of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
26434enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
26435lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
26436&%domains%& test.
26437
26438&*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
26439use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
26440
26441
26442.vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
26443.cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
26444.cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
26445.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
26446If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
26447name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
26448encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
26449.code
26450encrypted = *
26451.endd
26452
26453
26454.vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'&~host&~list'&>
26455.cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
26456.cindex "host" "ACL checking"
26457.cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
26458This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
26459name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
26460you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
26461.code
26462accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
26463.endd
26464The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
26465the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
26466and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
26467
26468The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
26469Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
26470but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
26471find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
26472opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
26473found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
26474
26475If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
26476address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
26477.code
26478accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
26479accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
26480.endd
26481The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
26482is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
26483statement can then check the IP address.
26484
26485.vindex "&$host_data$&"
26486If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
26487of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
26488allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
26489.code
26490deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
26491message = $host_data
26492.endd
26493which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
26494
26495.vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
26496.cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
26497.cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
26498.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
26499.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
26500This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
26501part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
26502enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
26503result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
26504the next &%local_parts%& test.
26505
26506.vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
26507.cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
26508.cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
26509.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
26510This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26511content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
26512viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26513
26514.vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
26515.cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
26516.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
26517This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26518content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
26519&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
26520with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
26521&<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26522
26523.vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
26524.cindex "rate limiting"
26525This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
26526messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
26527
26528.vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
26529.cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
26530.cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
26531.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
26532This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
26533recipient address against a list of recipients.
26534
26535.vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
26536.cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
26537.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
26538This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26539content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
26540non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
26541any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26542
26543.vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
26544.cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
26545.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
26546.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
26547.vindex "&$domain$&"
26548.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
26549This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
26550domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
26551&$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
26552of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
26553lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
26554RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
26555influence the sender checking.
26556
26557&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
26558relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
26559
26560.vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
26561.cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
26562.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
26563.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
26564This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
26565for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
26566.code
26567senders = :
26568.endd
26569&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
26570relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
26571
26572.vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
26573.cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
26574.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
26575This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26576content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
26577SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26578
26579.vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
26580.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26581.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
26582.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
26583.cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
26584.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
26585This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
26586certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
26587server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
26588or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26589
26590.vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
26591.cindex "CSA verification"
26592This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
26593send email. Details of how this works are given in section
26594&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
26595
26596.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
26597.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26598.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
26599.cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
26600.cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
26601.cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
26602This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
26603received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
26604&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
26605of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
26606is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
26607However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
26608that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
26609to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
26610might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
26611
26612Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
26613section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
26614&<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
26615condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
26616.code
26617deny senders = :
26618 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
26619 !verify = header_sender
26620.endd
26621
26622.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
26623.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26624.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
26625.cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
26626.cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
26627This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
26628received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
26629&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
26630lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
26631and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
26632permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
26633&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
26634appropriate.
26635
26636Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
26637ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
26638.code
26639To: @
26640.endd
26641and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
26642common as they used to be.
26643
26644.vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
26645.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26646.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
26647.cindex "HELO" "verifying"
26648.cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
26649.cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
26650.cindex "verifying" "HELO"
26651This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
26652client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
26653attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
26654condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
26655&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
26656independently of this condition.
26657
26658For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
26659option), this condition is always true.
26660
26661
26662.vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
26663.cindex "verifying" "not blind"
26664.cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
26665This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
26666Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
26667&'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
26668case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
26669&'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
26670used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
26671
26672There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
26673recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
26674
26675
26676.vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
26677.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26678.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
26679.cindex "recipient" "verifying"
26680.cindex "verifying" "recipient"
26681.vindex "&$address_data$&"
26682This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
26683recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
26684&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
26685of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
26686This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
26687verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
26688address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
26689value for the child address.
26690
26691.vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup*&
26692.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26693.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
26694.cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
26695This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
26696address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
26697was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
26698Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
26699one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
26700original IP address.
26701
26702If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
26703is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
26704
26705.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
26706.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26707.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
26708.cindex "sender" "verifying"
26709.cindex "verifying" "sender"
26710This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
26711message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
26712the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
26713condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
26714
26715.vindex "&$address_data$&"
26716.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
26717If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
26718value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
26719value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
26720statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
26721want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
26722
26723Details of verification are given later, starting at section
26724&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
26725to avoid doing it more than once per message.
26726
26727.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
26728.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26729This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
26730verified as a sender.
26731.endlist
26732
26733
26734
26735.section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
26736.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
26737.cindex "black list (DNS)"
26738.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
26739In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
26740is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
26741address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
26742domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
26743special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
26744address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
26745.code
26746deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
26747 dialups.mail-abuse.org
26748.endd
26749the following records are looked up:
26750.code
2675143.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
2675243.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
26753.endd
26754As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
26755Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
26756to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
26757use two separate conditions:
26758.code
26759deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26760 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
26761.endd
26762If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
26763behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
26764record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
26765processed.
26766
26767This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
26768(which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
26769blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
26770following special items in the list:
26771.display
26772&`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
26773&`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
26774&`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
26775.endd
26776.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
26777.cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
26778.cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
26779Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
26780.code
26781deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
26782.endd
26783Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
26784warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
26785.code
26786deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26787warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
26788 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
26789.endd
26790DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
26791so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
26792connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
26793connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
26794
26795
26796
26797.section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
26798.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
26799By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
26800of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
26801after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
26802.code
26803deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
26804.endd
26805This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
26806use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
26807MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
26808&<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
26809
26810
26811
26812
26813.section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
26814.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
26815There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
26816addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
26817&url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
26818with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
26819listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
26820.code
26821deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
26822 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
26823.endd
26824This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
26825RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
26826example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
26827up by this example is
26828.code
26829tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
26830.endd
26831A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
26832addresses. For example:
26833.code
26834deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26835 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
26836.endd
26837The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
26838name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
26839
26840
26841
26842
26843.section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
26844.cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
26845The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
26846names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
26847name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
26848As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
26849this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
26850either to double the separators like this:
26851.code
26852dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
26853.endd
26854or to change the separator character, like this:
26855.code
26856dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
26857.endd
26858If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
26859blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
26860occurs. Consider this condition:
26861.code
26862dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
26863.endd
26864The DNS lookups that occur are:
26865.code
268662.1.168.192.black.list.tld
26867a.domain.black.list.tld
26868.endd
26869Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
26870address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
26871are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
26872or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
26873only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
26874successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
26875error for a previous item.
26876
26877The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
26878syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
26879.code
26880dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
26881dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
26882.endd
26883However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
26884is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
26885.code
26886deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
26887 $sender_address_domain \
26888 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
26889 see $dnslist_text.
26890 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
26891 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
26892 $sender_address_domain} }} }
26893.endd
26894Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
26895multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
26896and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
26897of expanding the condition might be something like this:
26898.code
26899dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
26900.endd
26901Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
26902domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
26903
26904The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
26905&$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
26906
26907
26908
26909
26910.section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
26911.cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
26912DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
26913just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
26914RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
26915The values used on the RBL+ list are:
26916.display
26917127.1.0.1 RBL
26918127.1.0.2 DUL
26919127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
26920127.1.0.4 RSS
26921127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
26922127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
26923127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
26924.endd
26925Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
26926different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
26927see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
26928
26929
26930.section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
26931.cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
26932.cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
26933.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
26934.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
26935.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
26936.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
26937When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
26938the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
26939&`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
26940(for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
26941the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
26942&$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
26943cases, for example:
26944.code
26945deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
26946.endd
26947the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
26948&$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
26949For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
26950might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
26951.code
26952deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
26953.endd
26954If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
26955&`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
26956
26957If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
26958addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
26959The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
26960record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
26961very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
26962information.
26963
26964You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
26965&-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
26966expanded until after it has failed. For example:
26967.code
26968deny hosts = !+local_networks
26969 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
26970 at $dnslist_domain
26971 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
26972.endd
26973
26974
26975
26976.section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
26977.cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
26978You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
26979in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
26980For example,
26981.code
26982deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
26983.endd
26984rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
26985any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
26986that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
26987describes how multiple records are handled.
26988
26989More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
26990separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
26991&%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
26992.code
26993deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26994.endd
26995If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
26996addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
26997first. For example:
26998.code
26999deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
27000 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
27001.endd
27002
27003If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
27004listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
27005In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
27006true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
27007tested. For example:
27008.code
27009dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
27010.endd
27011matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
27012want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
27013being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
27014.code
27015dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
27016.endd
27017matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
27018an odd number.
27019
27020
27021
27022.section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
27023You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
27024condition. Whereas
27025.code
27026deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
27027.endd
27028means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
27029IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
27030.code
27031deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
27032.endd
27033means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
27034IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
27035words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
27036the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
27037
27038&*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
27039host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
27040
27041If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
27042previous example is precisely equivalent to
27043.code
27044deny dnslists = a.b.c
27045 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
27046.endd
27047However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
27048Consider this example:
27049.code
27050deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27051 list.dsbl.org : \
27052 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
27053 relays.ordb.org
27054.endd
27055Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
27056.code
27057deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27058 list.dsbl.org
27059deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
27060 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
27061deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
27062.endd
27063which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
27064
27065
27066
27067
27068.section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
27069A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
27070thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
27071is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
27072the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
27073the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
27074.code
27075dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
27076.endd
27077What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
27078127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
27079condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
27080because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
27081affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
27082additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
27083
27084.ilist
27085If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
27086IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
27087condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
27088.next
27089If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
27090looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
27091changed to:
27092.code
27093dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
27094.endd
27095and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
27096false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
27097.code
27098dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
27099.endd
27100for the condition to be true.
27101.endlist
27102
27103When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
27104the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
27105.ilist
27106If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
27107addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
27108.code
27109dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
27110.endd
27111If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
27112false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
27113.next
27114If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true there is at least one
27115looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
27116.code
27117dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
27118.endd
27119If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
27120true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
27121.code
27122dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
27123.endd
27124for the condition to be false.
27125.endlist
27126When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
27127between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
27128
27129
27130
27131
27132.section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
27133.cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
27134When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
27135the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
27136the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
27137address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
27138only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
27139can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
27140in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
27141lists.
27142
27143A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
27144two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
27145do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
27146If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
27147restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
27148a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
27149domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
27150.code
27151reject message = \
27152 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
27153 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
27154 dnslists = \
27155 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
27156 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
27157.endd
27158For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
27159&'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
27160match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
27161value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
27162record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
27163The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
27164
27165If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
27166given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
27167the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
27168.code
27169reject dnslists = \
27170 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
27171 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
27172 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
27173 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
27174.endd
27175In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
27176values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
27177done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
27178
27179
27180
27181.section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
27182.cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
27183.cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
27184If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
27185nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
271863ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
27187.code
271881.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
27189 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27190.endd
27191(split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
27192lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
27193IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
27194.code
27195*.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
27196.endd
27197is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
27198Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
27199
27200You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
27201&%condition%& condition, as in this example:
27202.code
27203deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
27204 dnslists = some.list.example
27205.endd
27206
27207.section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
27208.cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
27209.cindex "limiting client sending rates"
27210.oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
27211The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
27212which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
27213&%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
27214commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
27215works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
27216host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
27217.display
27218&`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
27219.endd
27220If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
27221period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
27222
27223As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
27224&$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
27225configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
27226of &'p'&.
27227
27228The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
27229time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
27230means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
27231parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
27232send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
27233in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
27234constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
27235changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
27236both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
27237
27238There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
27239log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
27240when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
27241instructions when it is run with no arguments.
27242
27243The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
27244sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
27245retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
27246which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
27247By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
27248of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
27249user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
27250&$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
27251example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
27252authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
27253
27254The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
27255rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
27256&`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
27257ACL.
27258
27259Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
27260specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
27261or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
27262&%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
27263using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
27264separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
27265
27266Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
27267any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
27268stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
27269remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
27270remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
27271behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
27272the &%count=%& option.
27273
27274
27275.section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
27276.cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
27277The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
27278normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
27279&%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
27280
27281The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
27282the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
27283&%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
27284&%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
27285
27286The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
27287the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
27288in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
27289used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
27290in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
27291follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
27292in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
27293
27294The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
27295accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
27296&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
27297&%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
27298ACLs the rate is updated with the total recipient count in one go. Note that
27299in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
27300recipients as a large high-speed burst.
27301
27302The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
27303number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
27304last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
27305recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
27306&%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
27307
27308The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
27309condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
27310command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
27311multiple different commands.
27312
27313The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
27314measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
27315&`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
27316increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
27317other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
27318
27319The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
27320
27321
27322.section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
27323.cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
27324You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
27325control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
27326mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
27327
27328If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
27329previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
27330
27331For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
27332it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
27333can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
27334in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
27335new rate.
27336.code
27337acl_check_connect:
27338 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
27339 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
27340 (max $sender_rate_limit)
27341# ...
27342acl_check_mail:
27343 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
27344 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
27345 (max $sender_rate_limit)
27346.endd
27347
27348If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
27349processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
27350it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
27351in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
27352same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
27353multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
27354checks.
27355
27356The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
27357use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
27358update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
27359&%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
27360next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
27361
27362
27363.section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
27364.cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
27365If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
27366engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
27367&%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
27368counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
27369rest of the ACL.
27370
27371The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
27372updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
27373client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
27374the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
27375counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
27376email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
27377is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
27378For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
27379from getting any email through.
27380
27381The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
27382updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
27383of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
27384actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
27385counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
27386pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
27387again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
27388attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
27389.code
27390 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
27391.endd
27392
27393
27394.section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
27395.cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
27396The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
27397rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
27398mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
27399sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
27400&`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
27401measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
27402options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
27403
27404For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
27405has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
27406rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
27407per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
27408go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
27409recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
27410
27411When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
27412&%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
27413rate.
27414
27415The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
27416other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
27417unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
27418required increases with larger limits.
27419
27420The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
27421will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
27422the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
27423the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
27424events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
27425times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
27426throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
27427limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
27428are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
27429as intended.
27430
27431
27432.section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
27433Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
27434when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
27435(for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
27436policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
27437message. For example:
27438.code
27439# Log all senders' rates
27440warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
27441 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
27442
27443# Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
27444# at the decimal point.
27445warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
27446 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
27447 $sender_rate_limit }s
27448
27449# Keep authenticated users under control
27450deny authenticated = *
27451 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
27452
27453# System-wide rate limit
27454defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
27455 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
27456
27457# Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
27458# set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
27459defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
27460 messages per $sender_rate_period
27461 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
27462 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
27463 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
27464.endd
27465&*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
27466especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
27467bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
27468making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
27469RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
27470this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
27471hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
27472
27473
27474
27475.section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
27476.cindex "verifying address" "options for"
27477.cindex "policy control" "address verification"
27478Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
27479&<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
27480&<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
27481The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
27482verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
27483other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
27484.code
27485verify = sender/callout
27486verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
27487.endd
27488The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
27489address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
27490difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
27491be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
27492(see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
27493The available options are as follows:
27494
27495.ilist
27496If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
27497remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
27498check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
27499.next
27500If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
27501normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
27502options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
27503verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
27504.next
27505The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
27506discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
27507.next
27508The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
27509immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
27510generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
27511discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
27512.endlist
27513
27514.cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
27515.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
27516.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
27517.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27518After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
27519error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
27520coding like this:
27521.code
27522warn !verify = sender
27523 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
27524.endd
27525If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
27526denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
27527verification failure.
27528
27529In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
27530appropriate) contains one of the following words:
27531
27532.ilist
27533&%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
27534was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
27535.next
27536&%route%&: Routing failed.
27537.next
27538&%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
27539occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
27540connection, HELO, or MAIL).
27541.next
27542&%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
27543.next
27544&%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
27545.endlist
27546
27547The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
27548rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
27549
27550
27551
27552
27553.section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
27554.cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
27555.cindex "callout" "verification"
27556.cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
27557For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
27558checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
27559the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
27560&'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
27561a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
27562address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
27563sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
27564deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
27565sender's domain.
27566
27567Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
27568request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
27569described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
27570lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
27571cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
27572caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
27573
27574Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
27575the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
27576callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
27577callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
27578on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
27579
27580If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
27581second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
27582one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
27583&(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
27584router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
27585&%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
27586&%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
27587supplies a host list.
27588
27589The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
27590remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
27591specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
27592specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
27593specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
27594the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
27595&$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
27596
27597For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
27598test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
27599following SMTP commands are sent:
27600.display
27601&`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
27602&`MAIL FROM:<>`&
27603&`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
27604&`QUIT`&
27605.endd
27606LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
27607set to &"lmtp"&.
27608
27609A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
27610for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
27611the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
27612that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
27613do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
27614&%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
27615
27616If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
27617succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
27618Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
27619hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
27620&%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
27621
27622.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
27623A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
27624output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
27625clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
27626disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
27627
27628
27629
27630
27631.section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
27632.cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
27633The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
27634optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
27635.code
27636verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
27637.endd
27638The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
27639separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
27640deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
27641
27642
27643.vlist
27644.vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
27645.cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
27646This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
27647For example:
27648.code
27649verify = sender/callout=5s
27650.endd
27651The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
27652remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
27653the &%connect%& parameter.
27654
27655
27656.vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
27657.cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
27658This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
27659for making the SMTP connection. For example:
27660.code
27661verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
27662.endd
27663If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
27664
27665.vitem &*defer_ok*&
27666.cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
27667When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
27668of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
27669updated in this circumstance.
27670
27671.vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
27672.cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
27673This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
27674&'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
27675accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
27676unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
27677
27678
27679.vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
27680.cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
27681When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
27682verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
27683sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
27684whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
27685MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
27686as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
27687(empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
27688address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
27689.code
27690require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
27691.endd
27692This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
27693
27694
27695.vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
27696.cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
27697This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
27698For example:
27699.code
27700verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
27701.endd
27702This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
27703commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
27704be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
27705very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
27706(for example, when network connections are timing out).
27707
27708
27709.vitem &*no_cache*&
27710.cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
27711.cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
27712When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
27713
27714.vitem &*postmaster*&
27715.cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
27716When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
27717check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
27718rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
27719the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
27720used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
27721made, until the cache record expires.
27722
27723.vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
27724The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
27725You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
27726For example:
27727.code
27728require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
27729.endd
27730If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
27731one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
27732.code
27733require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
27734.endd
27735&*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
27736account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
27737a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
27738postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
27739
27740
27741.vitem &*random*&
27742.cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
27743When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
27744check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
27745really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
27746&%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
27747.code
27748$primary_host_name-$tod_epoch-testing
27749.endd
27750The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
27751parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
27752specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
27753a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
27754succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
27755
27756.vitem &*use_postmaster*&
27757.cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
27758This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
27759.code
27760deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
27761.endd
27762.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
27763It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
27764performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
27765that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
27766domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
27767
27768.vitem &*use_sender*&
27769This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
27770.code
27771require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
27772.endd
27773It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
27774command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
27775need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
27776sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
27777usefulness of callout caching.
27778.endlist
27779
27780If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
27781command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
27782&%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
27783usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
27784that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
27785Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
27786these circumstances.
27787
27788However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
27789host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
27790callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
27791sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
27792callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
27793own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
27794is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
27795
27796Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
27797caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
27798by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
27799actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
27800
27801
27802
27803
27804.section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
27805.cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
27806.cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
27807.cindex "caching" "callout"
27808Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
27809used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
27810option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
27811different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
27812a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
27813entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
27814
27815When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
27816the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
27817is not available.
27818
27819The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
27820independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
27821(default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
27822
27823If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
27824commands up to and including
27825.code
27826MAIL FROM:<>
27827.endd
27828(but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
27829any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
27830domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
27831making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
27832separate expiry times for domain cache records:
27833&%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
27834&%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
27835
27836Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
27837cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
27838Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
27839ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
27840will eventually be noticed.
27841
27842The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
27843being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
27844behaviour will be the same.
27845
27846
27847
27848.section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
27849.cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
27850See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
27851verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
27852failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
27853relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
27854you might see:
27855.code
27856MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
27857250 OK
27858RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
27859550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
27860550-Called: 192.168.34.43
27861550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
27862550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
27863550 Sender verification failed
27864.endd
27865If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
27866only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
27867out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
27868&`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
27869example:
27870.code
27871verify = sender/no_details
27872.endd
27873
27874.section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
27875.cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
27876.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
27877A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
27878during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
27879or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
27880it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
27881
27882.ilist
27883When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
27884continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
27885verification also fails.
27886.next
27887When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
27888verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
27889.endlist
27890
27891This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
27892way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
27893example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
27894.code
27895A.Wol: aw123
27896aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
27897.endd
27898work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
27899redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
27900mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
27901verification to succeed.
27902
27903It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
27904redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
27905generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
27906option. For example:
27907.code
27908require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
27909.endd
27910In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
27911the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
27912
27913When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
27914redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
27915also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
27916address and a report is output for each of them.
27917
27918
27919
27920.section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
27921.cindex "CSA" "verifying"
27922Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
27923which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
27924special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
27925domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
27926Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
27927.code
27928verify = csa
27929.endd
27930This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
27931valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
27932succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
27933&$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
27934&"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
27935be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
27936
27937The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
27938detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
27939looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
27940address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
27941
27942.ilist
27943The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
27944.next
27945The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
27946.next
27947The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
27948(for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
27949.next
27950The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
27951that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
27952.endlist
27953
27954The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
27955use for the DNS query. The default is:
27956.code
27957verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
27958.endd
27959This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
27960is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
27961address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
27962the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
27963meaningful to say:
27964.code
27965verify = csa/$sender_host_address
27966.endd
27967In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
27968This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
27969&%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
27970
27971If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
27972is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
27973making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
27974using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
27975default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
27976default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
27977(&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
27978of legitimate HELO domains.
27979
27980The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
27981direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
27982search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
27983addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
27984lookup such as:
27985.code
27986${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
27987.endd
27988has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
27989The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
27990authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
27991
27992
27993
27994
27995.section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
27996.cindex "BATV, verifying"
27997Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
27998of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
27999Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
28000recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
28001bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
28002spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
28003
28004There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
28005&"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
28006the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
28007address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
28008item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
28009The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
28010&<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
28011
28012As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
28013database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
28014like this:
28015.code
28016PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
28017 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
28018 }{$value}}
28019.endd
28020Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
28021list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
28022use this:
28023.code
28024# Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
28025deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
28026 senders = :
28027 recipients = +batv_senders
28028
28029# Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
28030deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
28031 senders = :
28032 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
28033 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
28034 !condition = $prvscheck_result
28035.endd
28036The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
28037to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
28038send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
28039recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
28040the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
28041
28042A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
28043&%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
28044prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
28045the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
28046the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
28047timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
28048of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
28049
28050There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
28051you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
28052deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
28053router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
28054.code
28055batv_redirect:
28056 driver = redirect
28057 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
28058.endd
28059This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
28060of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
28061address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
28062local addresses.
28063
28064To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
28065can be used:
28066.code
28067external_smtp_batv:
28068 driver = smtp
28069 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
28070 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
28071 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
28072 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
28073 {$value}fail}}}
28074.endd
28075If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
28076
28077
28078
28079.section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
28080.cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
28081.cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
28082.cindex "policy control" "relay control"
28083An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
28084delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
28085within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
28086passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
28087.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
28088but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
28089
28090Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
28091A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
28092relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
28093a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
28094with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
28095same host is fulfilling both functions,
28096. ///
28097. as illustrated in the diagram below,
28098. ///
28099but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
28100not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
28101system to arbitrary domains.
28102
28103
28104You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
28105runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
28106Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
28107example, suppose you want to do the following:
28108
28109.ilist
28110Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
28111locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
28112&'my.dom2.example'&.
28113.next
28114Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
28115These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
28116.next
28117Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
28118Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
28119.endlist
28120
28121
28122In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
28123.code
28124domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
28125domainlist relay_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
28126hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
28127.endd
28128Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
28129command:
28130.code
28131acl_check_rcpt:
28132 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
28133 accept hosts = +relay_hosts
28134.endd
28135The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
28136the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
28137statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
28138hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
28139than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
28140default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
28141in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
28142
28143
28144
28145.section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
28146.cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
28147You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
28148that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
28149the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
28150
28151For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
28152&'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
28153host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
28154will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
28155patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
28156trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
28157results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
28158.ecindex IIDacl
28159
28160
28161
28162. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28163. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28164
28165.chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
28166.scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
28167The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
28168as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
28169was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
28170maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
28171specification.
28172
28173It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
28174&[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
28175scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
28176messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
28177chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
28178
28179If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
28180Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
28181&_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
28182
28183.ilist
28184Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
28185for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
28186.next
28187Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
28188&%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
28189run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
28190.next
28191An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
28192of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
28193.next
28194Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
28195conditions.
28196.next
28197Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
28198.endlist
28199
28200There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
28201called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
28202condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
28203
28204Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
28205added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
28206changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
28207EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
28208this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
28209&_doc/experimental.txt_&.
28210
28211All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
28212temporarily created in a file called:
28213.display
28214<&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
28215.endd
28216The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
28217expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
28218first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
28219scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
28220removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
28221.code
28222control = no_mbox_unspool
28223.endd
28224has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
28225same directory by default.
28226
28227
28228
28229.section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
28230.cindex "virus scanning"
28231.cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
28232.cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
28233The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
28234It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
28235specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
28236in memory and thus are much faster.
28237
28238
28239.oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
28240You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in first part of the Exim configuration
28241file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
28242are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
28243.display
28244&`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
28245.endd
28246If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
28247.code
28248av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
28249.endd
28250If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
28251before use. The following scanner types are supported in this release:
28252
28253.vlist
28254.vitem &%aveserver%&
28255.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
28256This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
28257at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
28258which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
28259example:
28260.code
28261av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
28262.endd
28263
28264
28265.vitem &%clamd%&
28266.cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
28267This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
28268&url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
28269unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
28270in the MIME ACL. This no longer believed to be necessary. One option is
28271required: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
28272number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
28273.code
28274av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
28275av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
28276av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
28277.endd
28278If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the local
28279keyword, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
28280to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
28281more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
28282Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
28283There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
28284you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
28285If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
28286contributing the code for this scanner.
28287
28288.vitem &%cmdline%&
28289.cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
28290This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
28291used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
28292type takes 3 mandatory options:
28293
28294.olist
28295The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
28296and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
28297
28298.next
28299A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
28300virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
28301absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
28302the &"trigger"& expression.
28303
28304.next
28305Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
28306match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
28307&"name"& expression.
28308.endlist olist
28309
28310For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
28311.code
28312Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
28313.endd
28314For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
28315name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
28316for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
28317configuration setting:
28318.code
28319av_scanner = cmdline:\
28320 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
28321 found in file:'(.+)'
28322.endd
28323.vitem &%drweb%&
28324.cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
28325The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface takes one
28326argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and port
28327separated by white space, as in these examples:
28328.code
28329av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
28330av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
28331.endd
28332If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
28333is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
28334
28335.vitem &%fsecure%&
28336.cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
28337The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
28338argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
28339.code
28340av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
28341.endd
28342If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
28343Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
28344
28345.vitem &%kavdaemon%&
28346.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
28347This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
28348Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
28349scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
28350For example:
28351.code
28352av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
28353.endd
28354The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
28355
28356.vitem &%mksd%&
28357.cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
28358This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
28359parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
28360&url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
28361the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
28362provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
28363been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
28364.code
28365av_scanner = mksd:2
28366.endd
28367You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
28368
28369.vitem &%sophie%&
28370.cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
28371Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
28372You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
28373for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
28374client communication. For example:
28375.code
28376av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
28377.endd
28378The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
28379the option.
28380.endlist
28381
28382When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
28383the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
28384ACL.
28385
28386The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
28387makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
28388The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
28389for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
28390However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
28391which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
28392message.
28393
28394The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
28395use. It can then be one of
28396
28397.ilist
28398&"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
28399The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
28400recommended usage.
28401.next
28402&"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
28403the condition fails immediately.
28404.next
28405A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
28406condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
28407expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
28408.endlist
28409
28410You can append &`/defer_ok`& to the &%malware%& condition to accept messages
28411even if there is a problem with the virus scanner. Otherwise, such a problem
28412causes the ACL to defer.
28413
28414.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
28415When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
28416&$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
28417&%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
28418logging data.
28419
28420If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
28421use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
28422&%malware%& condition.
28423
28424Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
28425imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
28426
28427Here is a very simple scanning example:
28428.code
28429deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28430 demime = *
28431 malware = *
28432.endd
28433The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
28434.code
28435deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28436 demime = *
28437 malware = */defer_ok
28438.endd
28439The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
28440aveserver. It assumes you have set:
28441.code
28442av_scanner = $acl_m0
28443.endd
28444in the main Exim configuration.
28445.code
28446deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28447 set acl_m0 = sophie
28448 malware = *
28449
28450deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28451 set acl_m0 = aveserver
28452 malware = *
28453.endd
28454
28455
28456.section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
28457.cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
28458.cindex "spam scanning"
28459.cindex "SpamAssassin"
28460The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
28461score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
28462&url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
28463installation, you can use CPAN by running:
28464.code
28465perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
28466.endd
28467SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
28468documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
28469nicely, however.
28470
28471.oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
28472After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the &%spamd%& daemon.
28473By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
28474port for &%spamd%&, you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global
28475part of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
28476.code
28477spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
28478.endd
28479You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
28480&%spamd%& also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
28481these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute file name instead of a
28482address/port pair:
28483.code
28484spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
28485.endd
28486You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
28487reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
28488&%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
28489option, separated with colons:
28490.code
28491spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
28492 192.168.2.11 783 : \
28493 192.168.2.12 783
28494.endd
28495Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported. The servers are queried in a random
28496fashion. When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
28497servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
28498condition defers.
28499
28500&*Warning*&: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
28501multiple &%spamd%& servers.
28502
28503The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
28504a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
28505used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
28506expansion.
28507
28508.section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
28509Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
28510.code
28511deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28512 spam = joe
28513.endd
28514The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
28515relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
28516to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
28517default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
28518However, you must put something on the right-hand side.
28519
28520The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
28521principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
28522have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
28523&%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
28524read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
28525are not set.
28526
28527The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
28528you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
28529&"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
28530
28531
28532Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
28533large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
28534are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
28535example:
28536.code
28537deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28538 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
28539 spam = nobody
28540.endd
28541
28542The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
28543SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
28544&%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
28545it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
28546
28547.cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
28548When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
28549variables. These variables are saved with the received message, thus they are
28550available for use at delivery time.
28551
28552.vlist
28553.vitem &$spam_score$&
28554The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
28555for inclusion in log or reject messages.
28556
28557.vitem &$spam_score_int$&
28558The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
28559example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
28560because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
28561The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
28562
28563.vitem &$spam_bar$&
28564A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
28565integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
28566&$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
28567headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
28568
28569.vitem &$spam_report$&
28570A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
28571message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
28572.endlist
28573
28574The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
28575spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
28576does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
28577
28578The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
28579the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
28580failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
28581statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
28582spam condition, like this:
28583.code
28584deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28585 spam = joe/defer_ok
28586.endd
28587This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
28588
28589Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
28590condition:
28591.code
28592# put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
28593warn spam = nobody:true
28594 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
28595 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
28596
28597# add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
28598# is over threshold
28599warn spam = nobody
28600 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
28601
28602# reject spam at high scores (> 12)
28603deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
28604 spam = nobody:true
28605 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
28606.endd
28607
28608
28609
28610.section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
28611.cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
28612.cindex "MIME content scanning"
28613.oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
28614.oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
28615The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
28616each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
28617of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
28618specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
28619options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
28620cases.
28621
28622These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
28623ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
28624the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
28625message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
28626ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
28627result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
28628&%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
28629
28630You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
28631only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
28632condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
28633&%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
28634&<<SECTscanregex>>&).
28635
28636At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
28637information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
28638of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
28639parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
28640part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
28641syntax is:
28642.display
28643&`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
28644.endd
28645The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
28646the value can be:
28647
28648.olist
28649&"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
28650.next
28651The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
28652&"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
28653a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
28654full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
28655.next
28656A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
28657directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
28658is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
28659the full path and file name.
28660.next
28661If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
28662filename, and the default path is then used.
28663.endlist
28664The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
28665errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
28666a file with its original, proposed filename using
28667.code
28668decode = $mime_filename
28669.endd
28670However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
28671anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
28672automatically unlinked.
28673
28674For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
28675content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
28676as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
28677variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
28678before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
28679
28680The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
28681used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
28682respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
28683
28684.cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
28685The following list describes all expansion variables that are
28686available in the MIME ACL:
28687
28688.vlist
28689.vitem &$mime_boundary$&
28690If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
28691have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
28692has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
28693contains the empty string.
28694
28695.vitem &$mime_charset$&
28696This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
28697&'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
28698.code
28699us-ascii
28700gb2312 (Chinese)
28701iso-8859-1
28702.endd
28703Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
28704case-insensitively.
28705
28706.vitem &$mime_content_description$&
28707This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
28708header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
28709implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
28710only used for display purposes.
28711
28712.vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
28713This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
28714header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
28715
28716.vitem &$mime_content_id$&
28717This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
28718This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
28719
28720.vitem &$mime_content_size$&
28721This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
28722successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
28723size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
28724has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
28725
28726.vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
28727This variable contains the normalized content of the
28728&'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
28729type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
28730
28731.vitem &$mime_content_type$&
28732If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
28733value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
28734are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
28735.code
28736text/plain
28737text/html
28738application/octet-stream
28739image/jpeg
28740audio/midi
28741.endd
28742If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
28743empty string.
28744
28745.vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
28746This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
28747successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
28748containing the decoded data.
28749.endlist
28750
28751.cindex "RFC 2047"
28752.vlist
28753.vitem &$mime_filename$&
28754This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
28755proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
28756&'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
28757RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
28758found, this variable contains the empty string.
28759
28760.vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
28761This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
28762attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
28763content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
28764
28765The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
28766cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
28767follows:
28768
28769.olist
28770The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
28771
28772.next
28773If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
28774so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
28775
28776.next
28777If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
28778and the rest are attachments.
28779
28780.next
28781All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
28782.endlist olist
28783
28784As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
28785alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
28786coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
28787.code
28788deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
28789!condition = $mime_is_rfc822
28790condition = $mime_is_coverletter
28791condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
28792.endd
28793.vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
28794This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
28795&"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
28796Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
28797want to carry out specific actions on them.
28798
28799.vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
28800This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
28801checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
28802decoding is fully recursive.
28803
28804.vitem &$mime_part_count$&
28805This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
28806starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
28807counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
28808&$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
28809complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
28810parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
28811.endlist
28812
28813
28814
28815.section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
28816.cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
28817.cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
28818You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
28819the message, or on individual MIME parts.
28820
28821The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
28822matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
28823MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
28824linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
28825have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
28826
28827The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
28828to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
28829part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
28830is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
28831and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
2883232K characters are checked.
28833
28834The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
28835literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
28836expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
28837with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
28838Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
28839.code
28840deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
28841 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
28842.endd
28843The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
28844&$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
28845matching regular expression.
28846
28847&*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
28848CPU-intensive.
28849
28850
28851
28852
28853.section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
28854.cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
28855.cindex "MIME content scanning"
28856The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
28857extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
28858&%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
28859ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
28860condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
28861the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
28862use the &%demime%& condition.
28863
28864The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
28865errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
28866against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
28867parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
28868scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
28869antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
28870
28871On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
28872colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
28873example:
28874.code
28875deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
28876 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
28877.endd
28878If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
28879false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
28880full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
28881the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
28882
28883The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
28884conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
28885zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
28886
28887The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
28888
28889.vlist
28890.vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
28891.vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
28892When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
28893severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
28894severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
28895zero, no error occurred.
28896
28897.vitem &$demime_reason$&
28898.vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
28899When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
28900human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
28901.endlist
28902
28903.vlist
28904.vitem &$found_extension$&
28905.vindex "&$found_extension$&"
28906When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
28907extension it found.
28908.endlist
28909
28910Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
28911the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
28912
28913If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
28914condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
28915right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
28916facility:
28917.code
28918# Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
28919deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
28920 demime = *
28921 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
28922
28923# Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
28924# Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
28925deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
28926 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
28927
28928# Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
28929# examine them and eventually thaw them.
28930deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
28931 demime = exe:doc
28932 control = freeze
28933.endd
28934.ecindex IIDcosca
28935
28936
28937
28938
28939. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28940. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28941
28942.chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
28943 "Local scan function"
28944.scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
28945.cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
28946.cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
28947In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
28948want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
28949
28950The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
28951passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
28952a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
28953condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
28954non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
28955
28956To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
28957possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
28958in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
28959can of course use a little C stub to call it.
28960
28961The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
28962when Exim is just about to accept the message.
28963It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
28964well as messages arriving via SMTP.
28965
28966Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
28967option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
28968Zero means &"no timeout"&.
28969Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
28970before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
28971are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
28972incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
28973For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
28974code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
28975
28976
28977
28978.section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
28979.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
28980To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
28981function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
28982&_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
28983directory, so you might set
28984.code
28985LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
28986.endd
28987for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
28988Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
28989be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
28990function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
28991commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
28992_src/local_scan.c_.
28993
28994If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
28995for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
28996.code
28997LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
28998.endd
28999in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
29000
29001
29002
29003
29004.section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
29005.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
29006You must include this line near the start of your code:
29007.code
29008#include "local_scan.h"
29009.endd
29010This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
29011prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
29012almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
29013for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
29014It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
29015strings and pointers to character strings:
29016.code
29017#define CS (char *)
29018#define CCS (const char *)
29019#define CSS (char **)
29020#define US (unsigned char *)
29021#define CUS (const unsigned char *)
29022#define USS (unsigned char **)
29023.endd
29024The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
29025.code
29026extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
29027.endd
29028The arguments are as follows:
29029
29030.ilist
29031&%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
29032(the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
29033recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
29034
29035The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
29036character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
29037id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
29038macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
29039case this changes in some future version.
29040.next
29041&%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
29042string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
29043.endlist
29044
29045The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
29046
29047.vlist
29048.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
29049.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
29050The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
29051the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
29052newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
29053maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
29054
29055.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
29056This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
29057queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
29058
29059.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
29060This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
29061queued without immediate delivery.
29062
29063.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
29064The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
29065passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
29066they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
29067&`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
29068used.
29069
29070.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
29071The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
29072message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
29073problem"& is used.
29074
29075.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
29076This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
29077message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
29078&%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
29079&%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
29080&%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
29081same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
29082
29083.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
29084This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
29085LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
29086.endlist
29087
29088If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
29089reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
29090&%-oe%& command line options.
29091
29092
29093
29094.section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
29095.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
29096It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
29097that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
29098want to do this, you must have the line
29099.code
29100LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
29101.endd
29102in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
29103&_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
29104file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
29105to define them.
29106
29107The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
29108&`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
29109and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
29110alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
29111variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
29112entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
29113.code
29114static int my_integer_option = 42;
29115static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
29116
29117optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
29118 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
29119 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
29120};
29121
29122int local_scan_options_count =
29123 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
29124.endd
29125The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
29126configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
29127.code
29128begin local_scan
29129my_integer = 99
29130my_string = some string of text...
29131.endd
29132The available types of option data are as follows:
29133
29134.vlist
29135.vitem &*opt_bool*&
29136This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
29137variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
29138that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
29139whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
29140TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
29141values.)
29142
29143.vitem &*opt_fixed*&
29144This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
29145The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
29146multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
29147
29148.vitem &*opt_int*&
29149This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
29150&`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
29151Exim.
29152
29153.vitem &*opt_mkint*&
29154This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
29155&%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
29156printed with the suffix K or M.
29157
29158.vitem &*opt_octint*&
29159This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
29160octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
29161always output in octal.
29162
29163.vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
29164This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
29165variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
29166
29167.vitem &*opt_time*&
29168This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
29169type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
29170.endlist
29171
29172If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
29173out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
29174
29175
29176
29177.section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
29178.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
29179The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
29180are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
29181Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
29182including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
29183C variables are as follows:
29184
29185.vlist
29186.vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
29187This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
29188
29189.vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
29190This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
29191
29192.vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
29193This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
29194is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
29195&[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
29196
29197.ilist
29198The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
29199testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
29200other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
29201
29202.next
29203The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
29204by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
29205of debugging bits.
29206.endlist ilist
29207
29208Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
29209selected, you should use code like this:
29210.code
29211if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
29212 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
29213.endd
29214.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
29215After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
29216variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
29217
29218.vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
29219A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
29220discussed below.
29221
29222.vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
29223A pointer to the last of the header lines.
29224
29225.vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
29226The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
29227
29228.vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
29229This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
29230&%-bh%& command line option.
29231
29232.vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
29233The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
29234is NULL for locally submitted messages.
29235
29236.vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
29237The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
29238command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
29239specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
29240
29241.vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
29242This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
29243&$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
29244
29245.vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
29246The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
29247
29248.vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
29249The number of accepted recipients.
29250
29251.vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
29252.cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
29253.cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
29254The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
29255&%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
29256can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
29257below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
29258adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
29259&%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
29260value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
29261blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
29262and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
29263
29264.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
29265The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
29266
29267.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
29268The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
29269locally-submitted messages.
29270
29271.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
29272The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
29273was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
29274
29275.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
29276The name of the sending host, if known.
29277
29278.vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
29279The port on the sending host.
29280
29281.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
29282This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
29283
29284.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
29285This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
29286
29287.vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
29288The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
29289requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
29290.endlist
29291
29292
29293.section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
29294The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
29295You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
29296(see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
29297their type to *.
29298
29299
29300.vlist
29301.vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
29302A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
29303
29304.vitem &*int&~type*&
29305A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
29306characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
29307Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
29308with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
29309rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
29310lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
29311
29312.vitem &*int&~slen*&
29313The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
29314internal newlines.
29315
29316.vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
29317A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
29318a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
29319.endlist
29320
29321
29322
29323.section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
29324The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
29325
29326.vlist
29327.vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
29328This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
29329
29330.vitem &*int&~pno*&
29331This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
29332the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
29333and must always contain -1 at this stage.
29334
29335.vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
29336If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
29337recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
29338envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
29339router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
29340an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
29341&%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
29342is NULL for all recipients.
29343.endlist
29344
29345
29346
29347.section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
29348.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
29349The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
29350These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
29351release:
29352
29353.vlist
29354.vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
29355 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
29356
29357This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
29358&%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
29359be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
29360for the process in &%newumask%&.
29361
29362Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
29363and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
29364standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
29365descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
29366argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
29367
29368The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
29369
29370.vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
29371This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
29372seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
29373return value is as follows:
29374
29375.ilist
29376>= 0
29377
29378The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
29379ending status.
29380
29381.next
29382< 0 and > &--256
29383
29384The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
29385signal number.
29386
29387.next
29388&--256
29389
29390The process timed out.
29391.next
29392&--257
29393
29394The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
29395.endlist
29396
29397.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
29398This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
29399Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
29400want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
29401forks a subprocess that is running
29402.code
29403exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
29404.endd
29405and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
29406that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
29407of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
29408recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
29409
29410When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
29411finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
29412fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
29413addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
29414
29415
29416.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
29417 *sender_authentication)*&
29418This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
29419that it runs is:
29420.display
29421&`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
29422.endd
29423The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
29424
29425
29426.vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
29427This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
29428output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
29429calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
29430conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
29431.code
29432if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
29433 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
29434.endd
29435
29436.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
29437This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
29438expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
29439The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
29440expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
29441the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
29442block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
29443&<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
29444
29445.vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
29446This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
29447existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
29448character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
29449substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
29450if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
29451
29452.vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
29453 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
29454This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
29455chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
29456
29457If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
29458&%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
29459NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
29460matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
29461&%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
29462found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
29463marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
29464option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
29465top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
29466headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
29467.code
29468header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
29469 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
29470.endd
29471Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
29472there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
29473
29474
29475.vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
29476This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
29477occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
29478particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
29479match the specification, the function does nothing.
29480
29481
29482.vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
29483 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
29484This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
29485a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
29486colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
29487&"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
29488.code
29489if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
29490.endd
29491.vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
29492.cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
29493This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
29494The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
29495back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
29496zero-terminated.
29497
29498.vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
29499This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
29500zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
29501to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
29502string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
29503yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
29504easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
29505added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
29506
29507.vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
29508This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
29509matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
29510.display
29511&`OK `& match succeeded
29512&`FAIL `& match failed
29513&`DEFER `& match deferred
29514.endd
29515DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
29516inability to contact a database.
29517
29518.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
29519 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
29520This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
29521controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
29522&'lss_match_domain()'&.
29523
29524.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
29525 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
29526This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
29527controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
29528matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
29529
29530.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
29531 uschar&~*list)*&"
29532This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
29533expected to be
29534.code
29535lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
29536.endd
29537.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
29538An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
29539is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
29540looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
29541values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
29542returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
29543failed.
29544
29545.vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
29546 *format,&~...)*&"
29547This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
29548is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
29549&`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
29550them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
29551arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
29552contain any newlines, not even at the end.
29553
29554
29555.vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
29556This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
29557is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
29558with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
29559
29560This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
29561described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
29562the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
29563value afterwards. For example:
29564.code
29565 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
29566 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
29567 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
29568.endd
29569
29570.vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
29571This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
29572recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
29573matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
29574address.
29575.endlist
29576
29577
29578.cindex "RFC 2047"
29579.vlist
29580.vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
29581 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
29582This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
29583these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
29584from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
29585a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
29586made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
29587binary string is returned with an error message.
29588
29589The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
29590maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
29591encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
29592
29593.cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
29594.cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
29595If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
29596contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
29597not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
29598
29599The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
29600&%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
29601which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
29602
29603If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
29604argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
29605set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
29606returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
29607with translation.
29608
29609
29610.vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
29611This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
29612below.
29613
29614.vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
29615The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
29616output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
29617stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
29618SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
29619is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
29620opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
29621test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
29622is involved.
29623
29624If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
29625output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
29626
29627Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
29628must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
29629LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
29630LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
29631initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
29632to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
29633that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
29634.code
29635smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
29636return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
29637.endd
29638Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
29639the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
29640&'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
29641multiple output lines.
29642
29643The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
29644does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
29645the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
29646detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
29647you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
29648dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
29649arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
29650is an error.
29651
29652.vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
29653This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
29654chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
29655runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
29656
29657.vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
29658This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
29659permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
29660
29661.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
29662See below.
29663
29664.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
29665See below.
29666
29667.vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
29668These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
29669The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
29670number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
29671and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
29672pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
29673more discussion.
29674.endlist
29675
29676
29677
29678.section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
29679.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
29680No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
29681The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
29682recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
29683to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
29684message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
29685terminates.
29686
29687Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
29688data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
29689connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
29690one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
29691
29692If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
29693in the same SMTP connection, you should set
29694.code
29695store_pool = POOL_PERM
29696.endd
29697before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
29698restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
29699the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
29700set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
29701
29702The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
29703&'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
29704There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
29705block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
29706&%store_pool%&.
29707.ecindex IIDlosca
29708
29709
29710
29711
29712. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29713. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29714
29715.chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
29716.scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
29717.scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
29718.scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
29719The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
29720that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
29721also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
29722they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
29723
29724The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
29725is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
29726It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
29727commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
29728The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
29729
29730The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
29731is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
29732the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
29733If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
29734of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
29735prevent it happening on retries.
29736
29737.vindex "&$domain$&"
29738.vindex "&$local_part$&"
29739&*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
29740specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
29741&$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
29742you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
29743independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
29744described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
29745
29746
29747.section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
29748.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
29749.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
29750The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
29751setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
29752other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
29753&%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
29754.code
29755system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
29756system_filter_user = exim
29757.endd
29758If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
29759&%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
29760specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
29761&%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
29762&%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
29763by the &%reply%& command.
29764
29765
29766.section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
29767You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
29768filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
29769are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
29770
29771If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
29772you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
29773
29774
29775
29776.section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
29777The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
29778files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
29779mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
29780available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
29781If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
29782they cause errors.
29783
29784.cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
29785There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
29786files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
29787is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
29788&%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
29789subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
29790manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
29791
29792&*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
29793specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
29794succeed, it will not be tried again.
29795If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
29796arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
29797
29798When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
29799&$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
29800users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
29801to which users' filter files can refer.
29802
29803
29804
29805.section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
29806.vindex "&$recipients$&"
29807The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
29808of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
29809filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
29810
29811
29812
29813.section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
29814.cindex "freezing messages"
29815.cindex "message" "freezing"
29816.cindex "message" "forced failure"
29817.cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
29818.cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
29819.cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
29820There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
29821always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
29822filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
29823for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
29824word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
29825.code
29826fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
29827.endd
29828The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
29829
29830The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
29831message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
29832and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
29833delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
29834that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
29835run.
29836
29837The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
29838not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
29839filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
29840is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
29841
29842.cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
29843.cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
29844The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
29845well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
29846up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
29847log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
29848two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
29849strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
29850message. For example:
29851.code
29852fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
29853 because it contains attachments that we are \
29854 not prepared to receive."
29855.endd
29856
29857.cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
29858Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
29859the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
29860the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
29861command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
29862Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
29863use, for example
29864.code
29865if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
29866then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
29867.endd
29868though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
29869alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
29870generated by the filter.
29871
29872The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
29873&%defer%&,
29874&%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
29875set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
29876as
29877.code
29878mail ...
29879freeze
29880.endd
29881to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
29882failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
29883take place.
29884
29885
29886
29887.section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
29888.cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
29889.cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
29890.cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
29891Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
29892.code
29893headers add <string>
29894headers remove <string>
29895.endd
29896The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
29897added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
29898filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
29899space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
29900forced to fail, the command has no effect.
29901
29902You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
29903continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
29904including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
29905example:
29906.code
29907headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
29908 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
29909 X-header-2: ...."
29910.endd
29911Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
29912be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
29913space after input continuations is ignored.
29914
29915The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
29916This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
29917those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
29918&'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
29919header with the same name, they are all removed.
29920
29921The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
29922of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
29923from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
29924modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
29925Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
29926used for all recipients of the message.
29927
29928During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
29929header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
29930that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
29931routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
29932routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
29933until the message is actually being written (see section
29934&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
29935
29936If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
29937added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
29938present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
29939present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
29940message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
29941conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
29942modified more than once.
29943
29944Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
29945use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
29946For example:
29947.code
29948headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
29949headers remove "Subject"
29950headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
29951headers remove "Old-Subject"
29952.endd
29953
29954
29955
29956.section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
29957.cindex "envelope sender"
29958In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
29959.code
29960errors_to <some address>
29961.endd
29962in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
29963delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
29964user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
29965might use
29966.code
29967unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
29968.endd
29969to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
29970address if its delivery failed.
29971
29972
29973
29974.section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
29975.vindex "&$domain$&"
29976.vindex "&$local_part$&"
29977In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
29978delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
29979operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
29980such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
29981filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
29982which implements such a filter:
29983.code
29984central_filter:
29985 check_local_user
29986 driver = redirect
29987 domains = +local_domains
29988 file = /central/filters/$local_part
29989 no_verify
29990 allow_filter
29991 allow_freeze
29992.endd
29993The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
29994&%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
29995the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
29996use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
29997
29998Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
29999specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
30000its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
30001address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
30002normal way.
30003.ecindex IIDsysfil1
30004.ecindex IIDsysfil2
30005.ecindex IIDsysfil3
30006
30007
30008
30009
30010
30011
30012. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30013. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30014
30015.chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
30016.scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
30017Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
30018all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
30019these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
30020this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
30021removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
30022before it is placed on Exim's queue.
30023
30024Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
30025&"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
30026that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
30027its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
30028set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
30029
30030&*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
30031or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
30032loopback interface specially in any way.
30033
30034If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
30035that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
30036
30037
30038
30039
30040.section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
30041.cindex "message" "submission"
30042.cindex "submission mode"
30043Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
30044&%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
30045received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
30046state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
30047.code
30048control = submission
30049.endd
30050in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
30051&<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
30052a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
30053known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
30054example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
30055interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
30056.code
30057warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
30058 control = submission
30059.endd
30060.cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
30061There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
30062is used to separate options. For example:
30063.code
30064control = submission/sender_retain
30065.endd
30066Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
30067true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
30068of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
30069the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
30070authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
30071&'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
30072attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
30073
30074When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
30075domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
30076example:
30077.code
30078control = submission/domain=some.domain
30079.endd
30080The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
30081&<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
30082that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
30083&'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
30084.code
30085accept authenticated = *
30086 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
30087 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
30088 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
30089.endd
30090Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
30091option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
30092the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
30093.code
30094bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
30095.endd
30096then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
30097line would be:
30098.code
30099Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
30100.endd
30101.cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
30102By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
30103used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
30104specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
30105
30106&*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
30107ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
30108untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
30109specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
30110does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
30111spoof another's address.
30112
30113.section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
30114.cindex "line endings"
30115.cindex "carriage return"
30116.cindex "linefeed"
30117RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
30118linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
30119SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
30120conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
30121use CRLF or just CR.
30122
30123Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
30124using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
30125receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
30126Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
30127MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
30128has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
30129that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
30130other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
30131follows:
30132
30133.ilist
30134LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
30135.next
30136CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
30137is ignored.
30138.next
30139The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
30140nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
30141terminator.
30142.next
30143If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
30144the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
30145is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
30146people trying to play silly games.
30147.next
30148If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
30149bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
30150line.
30151.endlist
30152
30153
30154
30155
30156
30157.section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
30158.cindex "unqualified addresses"
30159.cindex "address" "qualification"
30160By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
30161host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
30162SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
30163messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
30164requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
30165
30166Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
30167sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
30168&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
30169cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
30170value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
30171
30172.oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
30173.oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
30174Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
30175that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
30176line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
30177are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
30178other words, such qualification is also controlled by
30179&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
30180
30181
30182
30183
30184.section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
30185.cindex "&""From""& line"
30186.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
30187.cindex "sender" "address"
30188.oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
30189.oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
30190.cindex "envelope sender"
30191.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
30192Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
30193with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
30194&"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
30195.code
30196From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
30197From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
30198.endd
30199This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
30200Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
30201via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
30202such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
30203&%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
30204and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
30205regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
30206default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
30207that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
30208
30209.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
30210When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
30211a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
30212contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
30213then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
30214qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
30215the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
30216
30217If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
30218sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
30219that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
30220
30221Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
30222treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
30223as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
30224incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
30225
30226
30227
30228.section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
30229.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
30230RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
30231&`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
30232recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
30233&'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
30234&'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
30235
30236.blockquote
30237&'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
30238processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
30239.endblockquote
30240
30241This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
30242address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
30243follows:
30244
30245.ilist
30246A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
30247is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
30248.next
30249If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
30250&%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
30251&'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
30252.next
30253For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
30254also removed.
30255.next
30256For a locally-submitted message,
30257if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
30258&'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
30259the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
30260included in log lines in this case.
30261.next
30262The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
30263&%Resent-%& header lines are present.
30264.endlist
30265
30266
30267
30268
30269.section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
30270Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
30271includes the header line:
30272.code
30273Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
30274.endd
30275
30276.section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
30277.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
30278If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
30279message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
30280extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
30281existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
30282
30283
30284.section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
30285.cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
30286If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
30287Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
30288&%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
30289
30290.section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
30291.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
30292.oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
30293&'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
30294set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
30295the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
30296in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
30297set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
30298messages.
30299
30300
30301.section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
30302.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
30303.oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
30304&'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
30305Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
30306generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
30307messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
30308(the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
30309messages.
30310
30311
30312.section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
30313.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
30314.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
30315.cindex "message" "submission"
30316.cindex "submission mode"
30317If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
30318adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
30319
30320.ilist
30321The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
30322message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
30323.next
30324.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
30325The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
30326.olist
30327.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30328If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
30329&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
30330.next
30331If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
30332part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
30333.next
30334If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
30335&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
30336.endlist
30337.endlist
30338
30339A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
30340
30341If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
30342line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
30343containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
30344are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
30345They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
30346&%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
30347&%qualify_domain%&.
30348
30349For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
30350&'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
30351user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
30352name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
30353
30354
30355.section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
30356.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
30357.cindex "message" "submission"
30358.oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
30359If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
30360&'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
30361&%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
30362to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
30363creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
30364message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
30365followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
30366in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
30367&%message_id_header_domain%& options.
30368
30369
30370.section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
30371.cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
30372A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
30373contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
30374Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
30375
30376The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
30377have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
30378line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
30379that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
30380
30381Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
30382changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
30383-H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
30384
30385
30386.section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
30387.cindex "&'References:'& header line"
30388Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
30389header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
30390section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
30391header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
30392responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
30393processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
30394than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
30395incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
3039611 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
30397
30398
30399
30400.section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
30401.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
30402.oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
30403&'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
30404it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
30405transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
30406transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
30407default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
30408
30409
30410
30411.section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
30412.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
30413.cindex "message" "submission"
30414For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
30415existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
30416these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
30417&%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
30418control setting.
30419
30420When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
30421&%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
30422control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
30423&'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
30424that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
30425&%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
30426be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
30427appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
30428line is added to the message.
30429
30430If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
30431the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
30432&%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
30433options true at the same time.
30434
30435.cindex "submission mode"
30436By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
30437received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
30438a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
30439not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
30440
30441.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
30442First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
30443authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
30444created as follows:
30445
30446.ilist
30447.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30448If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
30449&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
30450.next
30451If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
30452is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
30453.next
30454If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
30455&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
30456.endlist
30457
30458This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
30459are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
30460added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
30461by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
30462
30463.cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
30464&*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
30465the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
30466except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
30467
30468
30469
30470.section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
30471 "SECTheadersaddrem"
30472.cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
30473.cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
30474When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
30475specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
30476process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
30477modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
30478as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
30479
30480In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
30481specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
30482addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
30483changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
30484transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
30485they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
30486
30487&*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
30488the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
30489expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
30490
30491For both routers and transports, the result of expanding a &%headers_add%&
30492option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
30493newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
30494.code
30495headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
30496 X-added-second: another added header line
30497.endd
30498Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
30499
30500The result of expanding &%headers_remove%& must consist of a colon-separated
30501list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
30502often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
30503not part of the names. For example:
30504.code
30505headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
30506.endd
30507When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router, its value
30508is expanded at routing time, and then associated with all addresses that are
30509accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
30510an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
30511forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
30512
30513.oindex "&%unseen%&"
30514However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
30515the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
30516&"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
30517
30518Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
30519settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
30520dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
30521requirements.
30522
30523The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
30524with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
30525these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
30526recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
30527consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
30528names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
30529instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
30530
30531After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
30532lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
30533the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
30534header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
30535
30536This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
30537the following consequences:
30538
30539.ilist
30540The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
30541remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
30542to it, at all times.
30543.next
30544Header lines that are added by a router's
30545&%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
30546expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
30547.next
30548Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
30549in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
30550.next
30551Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
30552a later router or by a transport.
30553.next
30554An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
30555removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
30556.code
30557headers_remove = subject
30558headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
30559.endd
30560.endlist
30561
30562&*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
30563for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
30564
30565
30566
30567
30568
30569.section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
30570.cindex "address" "constructed"
30571.cindex "constructed address"
30572When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
30573the form
30574.display
30575<&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
30576.endd
30577For example:
30578.code
30579Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
30580.endd
30581The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
30582otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
30583&"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
30584ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
30585upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
30586&%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
30587The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
30588there is no password file entry.
30589
30590.cindex "RFC 2047"
30591In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
30592parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
30593characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
30594including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
30595&%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
30596characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
30597&%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
30598is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
30599
30600
30601
30602.section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
30603.cindex "case of local parts"
30604.cindex "local part" "case of"
30605RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
30606be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
30607addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
30608because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
30609routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
30610original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
30611router option.
30612
30613.cindex "mixed-case login names"
30614If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
30615assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
30616your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
30617correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
30618.code
30619correct_case:
30620 driver = redirect
30621 domains = +local_domains
30622 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
30623 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
30624 @$domain
30625.endd
30626For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
30627(&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
30628up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
30629on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
30630local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
30631
30632
30633
30634.section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
30635.cindex "dot" "in local part"
30636.cindex "local part" "dots in"
30637RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
30638part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
30639middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
30640empty components for compatibility.
30641
30642
30643
30644.section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
30645.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
30646Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
30647happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
30648in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
30649&'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
30650
30651Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
30652in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
30653routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
30654example, a header such as
30655.code
30656To: hare@teaparty
30657.endd
30658might get rewritten as
30659.code
30660To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
30661.endd
30662Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
30663does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
30664been routed.
30665
30666Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
30667addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
30668result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
30669deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
30670immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
30671routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
30672.ecindex IIDmesproc
30673
30674
30675
30676. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30677. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30678
30679.chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
30680.scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
30681.scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
30682Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
30683LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
30684closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
30685processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
30686
30687.ilist
30688SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
30689.next
30690SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
30691.next
30692Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
30693.endlist
30694
30695For mail delivery, the following are available:
30696
30697.ilist
30698SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
30699.next
30700LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
30701&"lmtp"&);
30702.next
30703LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
30704transport);
30705.next
30706Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
30707the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
30708.endlist
30709
30710&'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
30711stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
30712used to contain the envelope information.
30713
30714
30715
30716.section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
30717.cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
30718.cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
30719.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
30720.cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
30721.cindex "EHLO"
30722.cindex "HELO"
30723.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
30724Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
30725The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
30726processing is the same in both cases.
30727
30728If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
30729parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
30730command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
30731&%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
30732such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
30733.cindex "transport" "filter"
30734.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
30735transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
30736suppressed.
30737
30738If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
30739pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
30740required for the transaction.
30741
30742If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
30743was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
30744server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
30745
30746If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
30747the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
30748in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
30749
30750.cindex "carriage return"
30751.cindex "linefeed"
30752Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
30753LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
30754order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
30755line terminator.
30756
30757If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
30758characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
30759same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
30760even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
30761of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
30762they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
30763each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
30764in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
30765significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
30766
30767When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
30768message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
30769records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
30770particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
30771
30772.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
30773Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
30774a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
30775See the next section for more detail about error handling.
30776
30777.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
30778.cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
30779When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
30780looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
30781messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
30782creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
30783a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
30784so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
30785does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
30786turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
30787
30788The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
30789limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
30790
30791.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
30792The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
30793identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
30794square bracket of the IP address.
30795
30796
30797
30798
30799.section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
30800.cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
30801.cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
30802.cindex "host" "error"
30803Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
30804message errors, and recipient errors.
30805
30806.vlist
30807.vitem "&*Host errors*&"
30808A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
30809particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
30810
30811.ilist
30812Connection refused or timed out,
30813.next
30814Any error response code on connection,
30815.next
30816Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
30817.next
30818Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
30819.next
30820I/O errors at any time,
30821.next
30822Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
30823the &"."& at the end of the data.
30824.endlist ilist
30825
30826For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
30827EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
30828error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
30829host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
30830the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
30831alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
30832host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
30833made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
30834
30835.vitem "&*Message errors*&"
30836.cindex "message" "error"
30837A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
30838particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
30839message errors are:
30840
30841.ilist
30842Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
30843the data,
30844.next
30845Timeout after MAIL,
30846.next
30847Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
30848timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
30849connection at any other time.
30850.endlist ilist
30851
30852For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
30853to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
30854temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
30855addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
30856a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
30857message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
30858that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
30859time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
30860affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
30861it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
30862
30863If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
30864to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
30865over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
30866response to MAIL.
30867
30868.vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
30869.cindex "recipient" "error"
30870A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
30871recipient errors are:
30872
30873.ilist
30874Any error response to RCPT,
30875.next
30876Timeout after RCPT.
30877.endlist
30878
30879For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
30880recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
30881sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
30882address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
30883used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
30884routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
30885operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
30886to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
30887if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
30888(&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
30889have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
30890the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
30891the retry clock is reset.
30892
30893The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
30894host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
30895other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
30896in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
30897proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
30898than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
30899if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
30900through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
30901recipient's retry time.
30902.endlist
30903
30904In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
30905current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
30906tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
30907own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
30908until the next delivery attempt.
30909
30910Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
30911MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
30912would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
30913host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
30914What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
30915is created.
30916
30917The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
30918these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
30919procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
30920response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
30921it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
30922message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
30923helpful to treat this case as a message error.
30924
30925Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
30926host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
30927or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
30928the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
30929then to be treated as a host error.
30930
30931There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
30932terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
30933reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
30934should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
30935host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
30936
30937
30938
30939
30940.section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
30941.cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
30942.cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
30943.cindex "inetd"
30944.cindex "daemon"
30945Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
30946listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
30947&_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
30948.code
30949smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
30950.endd
30951Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
30952agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
30953a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
30954the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
30955with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
30956stream and exits with an error code.
30957
30958By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
30959disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
30960unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
30961&%smtp_connection%& log selector.
30962
30963.cindex "carriage return"
30964.cindex "linefeed"
30965Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
30966LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
30967order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
30968line terminator.
30969Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
30970sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
30971sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
30972
30973.cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
30974.cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
30975One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
30976HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
30977commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
30978the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
30979Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
30980match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
30981
30982.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
30983.cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
30984The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
30985a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
30986&%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
30987false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
30988&%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
30989value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
30990message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
30991
30992When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
30993its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
30994logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
30995
30996The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
30997prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
30998number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
30999&%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
31000rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
31001
31002The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
31003subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
31004for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
31005things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
31006processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
31007sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
31008it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
31009
31010When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
31011and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
31012high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
31013&%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
31014applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
31015
31016Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
31017can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
31018&%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
31019number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
31020SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
31021&%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
31022subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
31023a delivery process.
31024
31025The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
31026&%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
31027started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
31028handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
31029however, available with &'inetd'&.
31030
31031Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
31032are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
31033to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
31034section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
31035
31036Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
31037MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
31038&%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
31039
31040
31041
31042.section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
31043.cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
31044If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
31045commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
31046the error response to the last command. The default value for
31047&%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
31048abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
31049circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
31050
31051
31052.section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
31053.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
31054.cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
31055A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
31056something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
31057address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
31058sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
31059&%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
31060drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
31061default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
31062broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
31063
31064
31065
31066.section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
31067.cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
31068The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
31069DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
31070many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
31071denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
31072client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
31073defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
31074
31075When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
31076allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
31077but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
31078or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
31079starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
31080counted.
31081
31082The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
31083STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
31084RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
31085
31086You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
31087&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
31088&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
31089the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
31090specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
31091
31092
31093
31094
31095.section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
31096When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
31097runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
31098appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
31099If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
31100
31101.cindex "VRFY" "processing"
31102When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
31103called with the &%-bv%& option.
31104
31105.cindex "EXPN" "processing"
31106When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
31107EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
31108than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
31109as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
31110of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
31111VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
31112RCPT failures.
31113
31114
31115
31116.section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
31117.cindex "ETRN" "processing"
31118RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
31119overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
31120disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
31121the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
31122should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
31123
31124The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
31125delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
31126the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
31127text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
31128specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
31129the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
31130argument. For example,
31131.code
31132ETRN #brigadoon
31133.endd
31134runs the command
31135.code
31136exim -R brigadoon
31137.endd
31138which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
31139containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
31140default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
31141for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
31142a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
31143
31144.cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
31145Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
31146record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
31147the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
31148the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
31149a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
31150left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
31151Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
31152
31153.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
31154For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
31155used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
31156whatever the form of its argument. For
31157example:
31158.code
31159smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
31160 $sender_host_address
31161.endd
31162.vindex "&$domain$&"
31163The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
31164expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
31165and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
31166wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
31167under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
31168for it to change them before running the command.
31169
31170
31171
31172.section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
31173.cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
31174Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
31175standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
31176line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
31177&%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
31178messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
31179sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
31180an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
31181identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
31182runs for RCPT commands:
31183.code
31184accept hosts = :
31185.endd
31186This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
31187
31188
31189
31190.section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
31191.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
31192.cindex "batched SMTP output"
31193Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
31194batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
31195be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
31196delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
31197envelope along with the message.
31198
31199The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
31200MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
31201the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
31202HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
31203can be used to specify it.
31204
31205Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
31206one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
31207to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
31208this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
31209chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
31210
31211.vindex "&$host$&"
31212When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
31213sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
31214transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
31215router:
31216.code
31217begin routers
31218route_append:
31219 driver = manualroute
31220 transport = smtp_appendfile
31221 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
31222
31223begin transports
31224smtp_appendfile:
31225 driver = appendfile
31226 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
31227 batch_max = 1000
31228 use_bsmtp
31229 user = exim
31230.endd
31231This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
31232format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
31233message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
31234
31235
31236
31237.section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
31238.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
31239.cindex "batched SMTP input"
31240The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
31241reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
31242is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
31243sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
31244rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
31245and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
31246as NOOP; QUIT quits.
31247
31248Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
31249ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
31250
31251If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
31252the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
31253standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
31254make some use of automatically, for example:
31255.code
31256554 Unexpected end of file
31257Transaction started in line 10
31258Error detected in line 14
31259.endd
31260It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
31261file, for example:
31262.code
31263An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
31264The error message was:
31265
31266501 '>' missing at end of address
31267
31268The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
31269The error was detected in line 12.
31270The SMTP command at fault was:
31271
31272rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
31273
312741 previous message was successfully processed.
31275The rest of the batch was abandoned.
31276.endd
31277The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
31278messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
31279accepted.
31280.ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
31281.ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
31282
31283
31284
31285. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31286. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31287
31288.chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
31289 "Customizing messages"
31290When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
31291configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
31292to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
31293the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
31294string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
31295
31296The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
31297cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
31298option. Exim also adds the line
31299.code
31300Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
31301.endd
31302to all warning and bounce messages,
31303
31304
31305.section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
31306.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
31307.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
31308If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
31309message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
31310delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
31311&%bounce_message_file%& is set.
31312
31313When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
31314constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
31315separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
31316opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
31317logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
31318item.
31319
31320.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
31321.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
31322Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
31323expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
31324the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
31325&$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
31326option, rounded to a whole number.
31327
31328The items must appear in the file in the following order:
31329
31330.ilist
31331The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
31332&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
31333.next
31334The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
31335failing addresses with their error messages.
31336.next
31337The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
31338returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
31339.next
31340The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
31341as part of the error report.
31342.next
31343The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
31344truncated because it is bigger than &%return_size_limit%&.
31345.next
31346The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
31347.endlist
31348
31349The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
31350following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
31351other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
31352.code
31353Subject: Mail delivery failed
31354 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
31355 {: returning message to sender}}
31356****
31357This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
31358
31359A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
31360 {that you sent }{sent by
31361
31362<$sender_address>
31363
31364}}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
31365This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
31366****
31367The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
31368****
31369------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
31370 ------
31371****
31372------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
31373 only the first
31374------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
31375****
31376.endd
31377.section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
31378.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
31379.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
31380The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
31381warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
31382text sections:
31383
31384.ilist
31385The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
31386&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
31387.next
31388The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
31389the delayed addresses.
31390.next
31391The third item then ends the message.
31392.endlist
31393
31394The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
31395have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
31396.code
31397Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
31398 $warn_message_delay
31399****
31400This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
31401
31402A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
31403{that you sent }{sent by
31404
31405<$sender_address>
31406
31407}}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
31408more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
31409
31410The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
31411The subject of the message is: $h_subject
31412The date of the message is: $h_date
31413
31414The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
31415****
31416No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
31417continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
31418intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
31419mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
31420the message will be returned to you.
31421.endd
31422.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
31423.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
31424However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
31425appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
31426&$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
31427minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
31428of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
31429multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
31430handled them.
31431
31432
31433
31434
31435. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31436. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31437
31438.chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
31439This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
31440common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
31441
31442
31443
31444.section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
31445.cindex "smart host" "example router"
31446If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
31447should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
31448routing explicitly:
31449.code
31450send_to_smart_host:
31451 driver = manualroute
31452 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
31453 transport = remote_smtp
31454.endd
31455You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
31456If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
31457receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
31458synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
31459&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
31460
31461
31462
31463
31464.section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
31465.cindex "mailing lists"
31466Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
31467requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
31468Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
31469
31470The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
31471is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
31472independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
31473lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
31474.code
31475lists:
31476 driver = redirect
31477 domains = lists.example
31478 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
31479 forbid_pipe
31480 forbid_file
31481 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
31482 no_more
31483.endd
31484This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
31485in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
31486such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
31487routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
31488
31489The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
31490expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
31491a mailing list.
31492
31493.oindex "&%errors_to%&"
31494The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
31495taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
31496original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
31497the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
31498
31499For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
31500&'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
31501&_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
31502&'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
31503There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
31504the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
31505such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
31506or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
31507&%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
31508
31509
31510
31511.section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
31512.cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
31513If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
31514delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
31515list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
31516list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
31517addresses are not rigorously checked.
31518
31519If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
31520entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
31521&%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
31522whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
31523&%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
31524
31525
31526
31527.section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
31528.cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
31529Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
31530in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
31531recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
31532cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
31533delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
31534account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
31535the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
31536message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
31537
31538If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
31539on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
31540router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
31541&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
31542&"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
31543subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
31544failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
31545pre-existing messages.
31546
31547The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
31548addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
31549addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
31550&%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
31551one level of expansion anyway.
31552
31553
31554
31555.section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
31556.cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
31557The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
31558send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
31559from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
31560&%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
31561
31562The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
31563of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
31564.code
31565lists_request:
31566 driver = redirect
31567 domains = lists.example
31568 local_part_suffix = -request
31569 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
31570 no_more
31571
31572lists_post:
31573 driver = redirect
31574 domains = lists.example
31575 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
31576 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
31577 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
31578 forbid_pipe
31579 forbid_file
31580 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
31581 no_more
31582
31583lists_closed:
31584 driver = redirect
31585 domains = lists.example
31586 allow_fail
31587 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
31588.endd
31589All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
31590they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
31591&%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
31592mailing list.
31593
31594The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
31595checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
31596checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
31597necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
31598because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
31599not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
31600means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
31601&%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
31602&"unrouteable address"& error.
31603
31604The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
31605a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
31606the address, giving a suitable error message.
31607
31608
31609
31610
31611.section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
31612.cindex "VERP"
31613.cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
31614.cindex "envelope sender"
31615Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
31616are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
31617address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
31618the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
31619if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
31620original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
31621
31622.oindex &%errors_to%&
31623.oindex &%return_path%&
31624Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
31625facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
31626list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
31627these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
31628host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
31629of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
31630of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
31631.code
31632verp_smtp:
31633 driver = smtp
31634 max_rcpt = 1
31635 return_path = \
31636 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
31637 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
31638.endd
31639This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
31640SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
31641&"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
31642local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
31643example, that a message whose return path has been set to
31644&'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
31645&'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
31646rewritten as
31647.code
31648somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
31649.endd
31650.vindex "&$local_part$&"
31651For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
31652have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
31653achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
31654might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
31655&$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
31656
31657Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
31658probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
31659extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
31660can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
31661.code
31662dnslookup:
31663 driver = dnslookup
31664 domains = ! +local_domains
31665 transport = \
31666 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
31667 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
31668 no_more
31669.endd
31670If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
31671of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
31672routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
31673errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
31674address.
31675
31676On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
31677&(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
31678SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
31679and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
31680of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
31681.code
31682verp_dnslookup:
31683 driver = dnslookup
31684 domains = ! +local_domains
31685 transport = remote_smtp
31686 errors_to = \
31687 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
31688 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
31689 no_more
31690.endd
31691Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
31692configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
31693Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
31694router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
31695them.
31696
31697The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
31698message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
31699host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
31700a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
31701a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
31702than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
31703used).
31704
31705
31706
31707
31708
31709
31710.section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
31711.cindex "virtual domains"
31712.cindex "domain" "virtual"
31713The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
31714meanings:
31715
31716.ilist
31717A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
31718aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
31719top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
31720.next
31721One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
31722with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
31723have login accounts on that host.
31724.endlist
31725
31726The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
31727the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
31728aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
31729virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
31730whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
31731to a router of this form:
31732.code
31733virtual:
31734 driver = redirect
31735 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
31736 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
31737 no_more
31738.endd
31739The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
31740is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
31741domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
31742part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
31743setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
31744string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
31745
31746This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
31747follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
31748can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
31749a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
31750
31751The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
31752way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
31753valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
31754.code
31755my_domains:
31756 driver = accept
31757 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
31758 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
31759 transport = my_mailboxes
31760.endd
31761The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
31762can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
31763file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
31764option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
31765because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
31766follows:
31767.code
31768my_mailboxes:
31769 driver = appendfile
31770 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
31771 user = mail
31772.endd
31773This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
31774required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
31775
31776The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
31777requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
31778up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
31779information about the domains.
31780
31781
31782
31783.section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
31784.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
31785.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
31786.cindex "local part" "prefix"
31787.cindex "local part" "suffix"
31788Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
31789incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
31790allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
31791identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
31792parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
31793&%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
31794example, consider this router:
31795.code
31796userforward:
31797 driver = redirect
31798 check_local_user
31799 file = $home/.forward
31800 local_part_suffix = -*
31801 local_part_suffix_optional
31802 allow_filter
31803.endd
31804.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
31805It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
31806&'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
31807cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
31808.code
31809if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
31810save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
31811endif
31812.endd
31813If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
31814fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
31815&%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
31816control over which suffixes are valid.
31817
31818Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
31819&_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
31820another MTA:
31821.code
31822userforward:
31823 driver = redirect
31824 check_local_user
31825 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
31826 local_part_suffix = -*
31827 local_part_suffix_optional
31828 allow_filter
31829.endd
31830If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
31831example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
31832does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
31833subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
31834&_.forward_& file to use as a default.
31835
31836
31837
31838.section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
31839.cindex "vacation processing"
31840The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
31841a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
31842(see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
31843This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
31844that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
31845
31846.ilist
31847A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
31848can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
31849alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
31850&_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
31851.code
31852spqr, vacation-spqr
31853.endd
31854.next
31855The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
31856vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
31857user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
31858ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
31859to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
31860message.
31861.endlist
31862
31863Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
31864use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
31865
31866
31867
31868.section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
31869.cindex "message" "copying every"
31870Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
31871be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
31872command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
31873each day's messages.
31874
31875There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
31876messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
31877delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
31878notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
31879
31880
31881
31882.section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
31883.cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
31884It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
31885Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
31886arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
31887permanently connected.
31888
31889Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
31890particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
31891Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
31892
31893
31894.section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
31895It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
31896host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
31897approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
31898being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
31899some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
31900to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
31901resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
31902
31903A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
31904intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
31905into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
31906format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
31907destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
31908in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
31909if required.
31910
31911On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
31912you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
31913intermittent host. For example:
31914.code
31915cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
31916.endd
31917This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
31918which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
31919online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
31920options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
31921causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
31922connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
31923immediately.
31924
31925If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
31926issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
31927mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
31928used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
31929avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
31930Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
31931arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
31932
31933
31934
31935.section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
31936The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
31937increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
31938connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
31939delivered immediately.
31940
31941.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
31942.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
31943.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
31944Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
31945not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
31946possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
31947each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
31948avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
31949&%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
31950first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
31951normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
31952destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
31953single SMTP connection.
31954
31955
31956
31957. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31958. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31959
31960.chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
31961 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
31962.cindex "client, non-queueing"
31963.cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
31964On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
31965email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
31966configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
31967However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
31968configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
31969&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
31970messages this way.
31971
31972If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
31973run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
31974any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
31975continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
31976email is not desirable.
31977
31978There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
31979&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
31980any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
31981host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
31982informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
31983to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
31984to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
31985
31986There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
31987that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
31988ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
31989before sending a message to the smart host.
31990
31991Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
31992tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
31993overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
31994
31995.oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
31996There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
31997Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
31998assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
31999just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
32000compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
32001router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
32002
32003When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
32004following ways:
32005
32006.ilist
32007A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
32008In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
32009.next
32010Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
32011assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
32012&%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
32013does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
32014successful, a zero return code is given.
32015.next
32016Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
32017be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
32018the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
32019must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
32020deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
32021are.
32022.next
32023If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
32024failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
32025successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
32026.next
32027Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
32028is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
32029smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
32030the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
32031there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
32032.next
32033If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
32034connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
32035failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
32036.next
32037When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
32038(as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
32039value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
32040are ever generated.
32041.next
32042No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
32043.next
32044A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
32045true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
32046&%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
32047.endlist
32048
32049The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
32050the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
32051deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
32052privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
32053to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
32054the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
32055
32056
32057
32058
32059. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32060. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32061
32062.chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
32063.scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
32064.cindex "log" "types of"
32065Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
32066and the panic log:
32067
32068.ilist
32069.cindex "main log"
32070The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
32071line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
32072down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
32073out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
32074them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
32075they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
32076analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
32077&<<SECTmailstat>>&).
32078.next
32079.cindex "reject log"
32080The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
32081of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
32082The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
32083the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
32084is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
32085lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
32086reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
32087host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
32088can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
32089false.
32090.next
32091.cindex "panic log"
32092.cindex "system log"
32093When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
32094error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
32095are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
32096other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
32097therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
32098regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
32099panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
32100is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
32101message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
32102.endlist
32103
32104Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
32105example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
32106In the log file, this would be all on one line:
32107.code
321082001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
32109 by QUIT
32110.endd
32111By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
32112ways of changing this:
32113
32114.ilist
32115You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
32116you set
32117.code
32118timezone = UTC
32119.endd
32120the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
32121.next
32122If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
32123example:
32124.code
321252003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
32126.endd
32127.endlist
32128
32129.cindex "log" "process ids in"
32130.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
32131Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
32132request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
32133&<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
32134brackets, immediately after the time and date.
32135
32136
32137
32138
32139.section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
32140.cindex "log" "destination"
32141.cindex "log" "to file"
32142.cindex "log" "to syslog"
32143.cindex "syslog"
32144The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
32145should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
32146are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
32147arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
32148It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
32149need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
32150Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
32151
32152The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
32153&_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
32154configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
32155references to the host name:
32156.code
32157log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
32158.endd
32159It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
32160rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
32161start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
32162before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
32163configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
32164log at all.
32165
32166The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
32167list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
32168facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
32169colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
32170otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
32171point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
32172implying the use of a default path.
32173
32174When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
32175LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
32176&"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
32177mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
32178files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
32179equivalent to the setting:
32180.code
32181log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
32182.endd
32183If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
32184logs are written.
32185
32186A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
32187are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
32188
32189Here are some examples of possible settings:
32190.display
32191&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
32192&`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
32193&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
32194&`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
32195.endd
32196If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
32197error is logged.
32198
32199
32200
32201.section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
32202.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
32203.cindex "cycling logs"
32204.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
32205.cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
32206Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
32207log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
32208provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
32209main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
32210keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
32211
32212An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
32213and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
32214example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
32215message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
32216that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
32217something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
32218ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
32219&[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
32220does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
32221tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
32222for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
32223renamed.
32224
32225
32226
32227.section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
32228.cindex "log" "datestamped files"
32229Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
32230periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
32231for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
32232&_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
32233the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
32234point where the datestamp is required. For example:
32235.code
32236log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
32237log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
32238log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
32239log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
32240.endd
32241As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
32242examples of names generated by the above examples:
32243.code
32244/var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
32245/var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
32246/var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
32247/var/log/exim/main.200212
32248.endd
32249When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
32250files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
32251will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
32252run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
32253
32254The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
32255is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
32256When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
32257the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
32258non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
32259character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
32260log names:
32261.code
32262/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
32263/var/log/exim-panic.log
32264/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
32265/var/log/exim/panic
32266.endd
32267
32268
32269.section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
32270.cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
32271The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
32272except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
32273Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
32274that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
32275&"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
32276by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
32277&%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
32278SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
32279&_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
32280LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
32281the time and host name to each line.
32282The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
32283
32284.ilist
32285&'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
32286.next
32287&'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
32288.next
32289&'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
32290.endlist
32291
32292Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
32293written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
32294these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
32295by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
32296
32297Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
32298entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
32299these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
32300calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
32301870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
32302additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
32303replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
32304RFC 3164, you should set
32305.code
32306SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
32307.endd
32308in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
32309lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
32310
32311To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
32312entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
32313where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
32314components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
32315because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
32316delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
32317870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
32318&'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
32319name, and pid as added by syslog:
32320.code
32321[1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
32322[2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
32323[3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
32324[4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
32325[5/5] mple>)
32326.endd
32327The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
32328(LOG_NOTICE):
32329.code
32330[1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
32331[2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
32332[3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
32333[4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
32334[5\18] .example>)
32335[6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
32336[7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
32337[8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
32338[9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
32339[10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
32340[11\18] 09:43 +0100
32341[12\18] F From: <>
32342[13\18] Subject: this is a test header
32343[18\18] X-something: this is another header
32344[15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
32345[16\18] le>
32346[17\18] B Bcc:
32347[18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
32348.endd
32349Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
32350without modification.
32351
32352If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
32353display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
32354the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
32355where it is.
32356
32357
32358
32359.section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
32360One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
32361successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
32362picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
32363timestamp. The flags are:
32364.display
32365&`<=`& message arrival
32366&`=>`& normal message delivery
32367&`->`& additional address in same delivery
32368&`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
32369&`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
32370&`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
32371.endd
32372
32373
32374.section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
32375.cindex "log" "reception line"
32376The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
32377message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
32378several lines in order to fit it on the page:
32379.code
323802002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
32381 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
32382 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
32383.endd
32384The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
32385bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
32386generated, this is followed by an item of the form
32387.code
32388R=<message id>
32389.endd
32390which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
32391
32392.cindex "HELO"
32393.cindex "EHLO"
32394For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
32395record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
32396received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
32397host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
32398above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
32399&%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
32400by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
32401verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
32402EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
32403name in parentheses.
32404
32405Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
32406without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
32407the log containing text like these examples:
32408.code
32409H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
32410H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
32411.endd
32412This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
32413on.
32414
32415For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
32416the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
32417of Exim.
32418
32419.cindex "authentication" "logging"
32420.cindex "AUTH" "logging"
32421For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
32422message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
32423of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
32424extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
32425session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
32426suite that was used.
32427
32428The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
32429hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
32430value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
32431there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
32432was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
32433&%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
32434authenticator name.
32435
32436.cindex "size" "of message"
32437The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
32438received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
32439headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
32440message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
32441other).
32442
32443The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
32444data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
32445
32446
32447
32448.section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
32449.cindex "log" "delivery line"
32450The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
32451delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
32452deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
32453to fit it on the page:
32454.code
324552002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
32456 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
324572002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
32458 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
32459 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
32460.endd
32461For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
32462after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
32463intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
32464last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
32465fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
32466
32467If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
32468for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
32469.display
32470&`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
32471.endd
32472If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
32473parentheses afterwards.
32474
32475.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
32476When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
32477SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
32478flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
32479down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
32480lines for the second and subsequent messages.
32481
32482The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
32483&"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
32484
32485The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
32486data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
32487
32488
32489.section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
32490.cindex "discarded messages"
32491.cindex "message" "discarded"
32492.cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
32493When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
32494obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
32495.code
324962002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
32497 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
32498.endd
32499is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
32500because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
32501.code
325021999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
32503 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
32504.endd
32505
32506
32507.section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
32508When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
32509.code
325102002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
32511 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
32512.endd
32513In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
32514last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
32515written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
32516.code
325172002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
32518 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
32519.endd
32520When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
32521a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
32522appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
32523
32524
32525
32526.section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
32527.cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
32528If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
32529following form is logged:
32530.code
325311995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
32532 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
32533.endd
32534If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
32535the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
32536.code
325372002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
32538 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
32539 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
32540 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
32541 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
32542.endd
32543The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
32544used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
32545disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
32546flagged with &`**`&.
32547
32548
32549
32550.section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
32551.cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
32552If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
32553used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
32554&"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
32555
32556
32557
32558.section "Completion" "SECID257"
32559A line of the form
32560.code
325612002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
32562.endd
32563is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
32564at the end of its processing.
32565
32566
32567
32568
32569.section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
32570.cindex "log" "summary of fields"
32571A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
32572the following table:
32573.display
32574&`A `& authenticator name (and optional id)
32575&`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
32576&` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
32577&`CV `& certificate verification status
32578&`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
32579&`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
32580&`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
32581&`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
32582&`H `& host name and IP address
32583&`I `& local interface used
32584&`id `& message id for incoming message
32585&`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
32586&` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
32587&`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
32588&` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
32589&`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
32590&` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
32591&`S `& size of message
32592&`ST `& shadow transport name
32593&`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
32594&` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
32595&`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
32596&`X `& TLS cipher suite
32597.endd
32598
32599
32600.section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
32601Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
32602self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
32603
32604.ilist
32605.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
32606&'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
32607during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
32608This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
32609during the first delivery attempt.
32610.next
32611&'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
32612temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
32613for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
32614.next
32615.cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
32616&'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
32617some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
32618common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
32619&'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
32620doing.
32621.next
32622.cindex "error" "ignored"
32623&'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
32624message:
32625.olist
32626Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
32627&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
32628.next
32629A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
32630failed. The delivery was discarded.
32631.next
32632A delivery set up by a router configured with
32633. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
32634. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
32635.code
32636 errors_to = <>
32637.endd
32638failed. The delivery was discarded.
32639.endlist olist
32640.endlist ilist
32641
32642
32643
32644
32645
32646.section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
32647.cindex "log" "selectors"
32648By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
32649default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
32650&%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
32651example:
32652.code
32653log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
32654.endd
32655The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
32656selection marked by asterisks:
32657.display
32658&`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
32659&` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
32660&` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
32661&` arguments `& command line arguments
32662&`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
32663&`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
32664&` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
32665&` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
32666&`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
32667&`*etrn `& ETRN commands
32668&`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
32669&` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
32670&` incoming_interface `& incoming interface on <= lines
32671&` incoming_port `& incoming port on <= lines
32672&`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
32673&` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
32674&`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
32675&` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
32676&` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
32677&` pid `& Exim process id
32678&` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
32679&` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
32680&`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
32681&`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
32682&` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
32683&` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
32684&`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
32685&`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
32686&`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
32687&` smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
32688&` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
32689&` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
32690&` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
32691&` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
32692&` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
32693&` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
32694&` tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
32695&`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
32696&` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
32697&` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
32698
32699&` all `& all of the above
32700.endd
32701More details on each of these items follows:
32702
32703.ilist
32704.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
32705&%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
32706its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
32707this log selector is set.
32708.next
32709.cindex "log" "rewriting"
32710.cindex "rewriting" "logging"
32711&%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
32712rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
32713such users cannot access the log).
32714.next
32715.cindex "log" "full parentage"
32716&%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
32717delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
32718parentheses between them.
32719.next
32720.cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
32721.cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
32722&%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
32723to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
32724feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
32725&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
32726privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
32727that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
32728are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
32729because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
32730only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
32731between the caller and Exim.
32732.next
32733.cindex "log" "connection rejections"
32734&%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
32735connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
32736.next
32737.cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
32738.cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
32739&%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
32740started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
32741messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
32742process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
32743.next
32744.cindex "log" "delivery duration"
32745&%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
32746perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
32747.next
32748.cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
32749.cindex "size" "of message"
32750&%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
32751the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
32752.next
32753.cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
32754.cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
32755.cindex "black list (DNS)"
32756&%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
32757DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
32758.next
32759.cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
32760.cindex "ETRN" "logging"
32761&%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
32762is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
32763command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
32764selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
32765.next
32766.cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
32767&%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
32768any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
32769log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
32770routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
32771.next
32772.cindex "log" "ident timeout"
32773.cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
32774&%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
32775client's ident port times out.
32776.next
32777.cindex "log" "incoming interface"
32778.cindex "interface" "logging"
32779&%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
32780to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
32781followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
32782added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, and to
32783rejection lines.
32784.next
32785.cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
32786.cindex "port" "logging remote"
32787.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
32788.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
32789.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
32790&%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
32791added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
32792in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
32793changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
32794&$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
32795important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
32796.next
32797.cindex "log" "dropped connection"
32798&%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
32799connection is unexpectedly dropped.
32800.next
32801.cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
32802.cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
32803.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
32804&%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
32805containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
32806the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
32807number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
32808.next
32809.cindex "log" "process ids in"
32810.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
32811&%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
32812immediately after the time and date.
32813.next
32814.cindex "log" "queue run"
32815.cindex "queue runner" "logging"
32816&%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
32817.next
32818.cindex "log" "queue time"
32819&%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
32820local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
32821&`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
32822includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
32823This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
32824delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
32825message has been successfully received.
32826.next
32827&%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
32828the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
32829example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
32830message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
32831.next
32832.cindex "log" "recipients"
32833&%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
32834as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
32835that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
32836addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
32837has taken place.
32838Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
32839in the list.
32840.next
32841.cindex "log" "sender reception"
32842&%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
32843the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
32844&"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
32845.next
32846.cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
32847&%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
32848rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
32849log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
32850rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
32851.next
32852.cindex "log" "retry defer"
32853&%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
32854retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
32855message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
32856attempt.
32857.next
32858.cindex "log" "return path"
32859&%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
32860the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
32861This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
32862or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
32863.next
32864.cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
32865&%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
32866and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
32867This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
32868necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
32869.next
32870.cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
32871&%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
32872gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
32873the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
32874detail is lost.
32875.next
32876.cindex "log" "size rejection"
32877&%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
32878it is too big.
32879.next
32880.cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
32881.cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
32882&%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
32883queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
32884it.
32885.cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
32886The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
32887.next
32888.cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
32889.cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
32890&%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP dialogue for
32891outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
32892A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
32893response.
32894.next
32895.cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
32896.cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
32897&%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
32898established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
32899&%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
32900only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
32901processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
32902dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
32903not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
32904of connections unless this selector is enabled.
32905
32906For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
32907included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
32908reset if the daemon is restarted.
32909Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
32910subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
32911whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
32912match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
32913logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
32914.next
32915.cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
32916.cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
32917&%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
32918RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
32919and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
32920line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
32921.next
32922.cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
32923.cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
32924&%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
32925connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
32926the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
32927does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
32928an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
32929already have their own log lines.
32930
32931The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
32932way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
32933If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
32934an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
32935DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
32936the same logging options.
32937
32938Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
32939is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
32940.code
32941C=EHLO,QUIT
32942.endd
32943shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
32944than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
32945the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
32946setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
32947have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
32948.next
32949.cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
32950.cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
32951&%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
32952encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
32953because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
32954been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
32955it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
32956received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
32957.next
32958.cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
32959.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
32960.cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
32961.cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
32962.cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
32963&%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
32964encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
32965external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
32966using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
32967.next
32968.cindex "log" "subject"
32969.cindex "subject, logging"
32970&%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
32971preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
32972Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
32973specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
32974unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
32975.next
32976.cindex "log" "certificate verification"
32977&%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
32978when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
32979verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
32980.next
32981.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
32982.cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
32983&%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
32984connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
32985.next
32986.cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
32987.cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
32988&%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
32989connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
32990added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
32991.next
32992.cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
32993&%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
32994result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
32995.endlist
32996
32997
32998.section "Message log" "SECID260"
32999.cindex "message" "log file for"
33000.cindex "log" "message log; description of"
33001.cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
33002.oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
33003In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
33004that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
33005they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
33006message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
33007makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
33008to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
33009is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
33010only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
33011
33012On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
33013per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
33014&%message_logs%& option false.
33015.ecindex IIDloggen
33016
33017
33018
33019
33020. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33021. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33022
33023.chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
33024.scindex IIDutils "utilities"
33025A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
33026described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
33027the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
33028
33029.itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
33030.irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
33031 "list what Exim processes are doing"
33032.irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
33033.irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
33034.irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
33035.irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
33036 various criteria"
33037.irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
33038.irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
33039 "extract statistics from the log"
33040.irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
33041 "check address acceptance from given IP"
33042.irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
33043.irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
33044.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
33045.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
33046.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
33047.irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
33048.endtable
33049
33050Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
33051&'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
33052&url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
33053
33054
33055
33056
33057.section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
33058.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
33059.cindex "process, querying"
33060.cindex "SIGUSR1"
33061On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
33062(most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
33063a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
33064Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
33065processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
33066second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
33067order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
33068send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
33069
33070&*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
33071use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
33072script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
33073
33074
33075Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
33076varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
33077but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
33078system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
33079it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
33080options:
33081.display
33082&`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
33083&`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
33084&`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
33085&`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
33086.endd
33087An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
33088.code
33089164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
3309010483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
3309110492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
33092 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
3309310592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
3309410628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
33095.endd
33096The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
33097been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
33098
33099
33100
33101.section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
33102.cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
33103.cindex "queue" "grepping"
33104This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
33105.code
33106exim -bpu
33107.endd
33108to obtain a queue listing with undelivered recipients only, and then greps the
33109output to select messages that match given criteria. The following selection
33110options are available:
33111
33112.vlist
33113.vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
33114Match the sender address. The field that is tested is enclosed in angle
33115brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
33116.code
33117exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
33118.endd
33119.vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
33120Match a recipient address. The field that is tested is not enclosed in angle
33121brackets.
33122
33123.vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
33124Match against the size field.
33125
33126.vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
33127Match messages that are younger than the given time.
33128
33129.vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
33130Match messages that are older than the given time.
33131
33132.vitem &*-z*&
33133Match only frozen messages.
33134
33135.vitem &*-x*&
33136Match only non-frozen messages.
33137.endlist
33138
33139The following options control the format of the output:
33140
33141.vlist
33142.vitem &*-c*&
33143Display only the count of matching messages.
33144
33145.vitem &*-l*&
33146Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
33147the default.
33148
33149.vitem &*-i*&
33150Display message ids only.
33151
33152.vitem &*-b*&
33153Brief format &-- one line per message.
33154
33155.vitem &*-R*&
33156Display messages in reverse order.
33157.endlist
33158
33159There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
33160
33161
33162
33163.section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
33164.cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
33165.cindex "queue" "summary"
33166The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
33167-bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
33168running a command such as
33169.code
33170exim -bp | exiqsumm
33171.endd
33172The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
33173it, as in the following example:
33174.code
331753 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
33176.endd
33177Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
33178volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
33179been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
33180number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
33181
33182A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
33183domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
33184the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
33185respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
33186domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
33187separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
33188sender.
33189
33190The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
33191this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
33192generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
33193option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
33194level"& addresses).
33195
33196
33197
33198
33199.section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
33200 "SECTextspeinf"
33201.cindex "&'exigrep'&"
33202.cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
33203The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
33204files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
33205extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
33206match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
33207given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
33208The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
33209If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
33210included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
33211.display
33212&`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
33213.endd
33214If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
33215
33216The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
33217condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
33218they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
33219
33220By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
33221makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
33222large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
33223option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
33224case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
33225
33226The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
33227pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
33228regular expression.
33229
33230The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
33231if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
33232
33233If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
33234ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
33235whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
33236
33237
33238.section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
33239.cindex "&'exipick'&"
33240John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
33241lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
33242of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
33243&url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
33244the &%--help%& option.
33245
33246
33247.section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
33248.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
33249.cindex "cycling logs"
33250.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
33251The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
33252&'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
33253you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
33254&<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
33255for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
33256There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
33257.ilist
33258&%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
33259default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
33260.next
33261&%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
33262&%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
33263overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
33264configuration.
33265.endlist
33266
33267Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
33268the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
33269run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
33270&_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
33271&%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
33272logs are handled similarly.
33273
33274If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
33275&_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
33276to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
33277any existing log files.
33278
33279If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
33280the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
33281using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
33282setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
33283root &%crontab%& entry of the form
33284.code
332851 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
33286.endd
33287assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
33288&'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
33289
33290
33291
33292.section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
33293.cindex "statistics"
33294.cindex "&'eximstats'&"
33295A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
33296information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
33297Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
33298LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
33299
33300The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
33301latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
33302lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
33303various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
33304list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
33305.code
33306eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
33307.endd
33308By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
33309messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
33310both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
33311are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
33312addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
33313options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
33314also produced per user.
33315
33316The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
33317histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
33318hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
33319example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
33320as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
33321
33322Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
33323have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
33324messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
33325and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
33326recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
33327an entirely separate message.
33328
33329&'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
33330of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
33331each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
33332not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
33333least one address that failed.
33334
33335The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
33336or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
33337transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
33338(default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
33339a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
33340senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
33341and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
33342
33343The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
33344came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
33345without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
33346
33347There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
33348outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
33349by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
33350.code
33351perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
33352.endd
33353
33354.section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
33355.cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
33356.cindex "policy control" "checking access"
33357.cindex "checking access"
33358The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
33359debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
33360policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
33361familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
33362sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
33363access?"& without bothering with any further details.
33364
33365The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
33366two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
33367.code
33368exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
33369.endd
33370The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
33371given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
33372connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
33373is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
33374.code
33375Rejected:
33376550 Relay not permitted
33377.endd
33378When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
33379for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
33380options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
33381that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
33382you can use:
33383.code
33384exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
33385 -f himself@there.example
33386.endd
33387Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
33388mandatory arguments.
33389
33390Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
33391while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
33392&%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
33393
33394
33395
33396.section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
33397.cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
33398.cindex "building DBM files"
33399.cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
33400.cindex "lower casing"
33401.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
33402The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
33403the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
33404&<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
33405names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
33406can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
33407
33408A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
33409the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
33410&'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
33411strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
33412files.
33413
33414The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
33415single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
33416It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
33417well.
33418
33419.cindex "USE_DB"
33420If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
33421configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
33422names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
33423a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
33424.code
33425exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
33426.endd
33427reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
33428&_/etc/aliases.db_&.
33429
33430In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
33431Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
33432environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
33433&'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
33434when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
33435recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
33436
33437If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
33438finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
33439option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
33440this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
33441&%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
33442There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
33443&%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
33444return code is 2.
33445
33446
33447
33448
33449.section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
33450.cindex "retry" "times"
33451.cindex "&'exinext'&"
33452A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
33453fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
33454complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
33455information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
33456is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
33457output. For example:
33458.code
33459$ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
33460kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
33461 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
33462 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
33463 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
33464roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
33465 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
33466 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
33467 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
33468 past final cutoff time
33469.endd
33470You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
33471will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
33472A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
33473message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
33474suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
33475&'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
33476run very often.
33477
33478The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
33479of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
33480passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
33481configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
33482file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
33483environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
33484
33485
33486
33487.section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
33488.cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
33489.cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
33490Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
33491uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
33492arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
33493second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
33494
33495.ilist
33496&'retry'&: the database of retry information
33497.next
33498&'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
33499for remote hosts
33500.next
33501&'callout'&: the callout cache
33502.next
33503&'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
33504.next
33505&'misc'&: other hints data
33506.endlist
33507
33508The &'misc'& database is used for
33509
33510.ilist
33511Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
33512.next
33513Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
33514&(smtp)& transport)
33515.endlist
33516
33517
33518
33519.section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
33520.cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
33521The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
33522&'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
33523spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
33524.code
33525exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
33526.endd
33527Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
33528.code
33529T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
3353031-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
33531.endd
33532The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
33533of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
33534transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
33535a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
33536address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
33537transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
33538to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
33539and a textual description of the error.
33540
33541The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
33542the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
33543ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
33544exceeded.
33545
33546Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
33547consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
33548waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
33549one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
33550may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
33551may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
33552cross-references.
33553
33554
33555
33556.section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
33557.cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
33558The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
33559database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
33560days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
33561updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
33562since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
33563for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
33564updated sufficiently often.
33565
33566The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
33567followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
33568the retry database:
33569.code
33570exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
33571.endd
33572Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
33573message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
33574they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
33575are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
33576types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
33577message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
33578queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
33579&'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
33580For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
33581removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
33582whenever it removes information from the database.
33583
33584Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
33585needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
33586down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
33587first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
33588records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
33589
33590It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
33591hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
33592a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
33593work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
33594but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
33595After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
33596point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
33597tidied.
33598
33599&*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
33600databases is likely to keep on increasing.
33601
33602
33603
33604
33605.section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
33606.cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
33607The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
33608Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
33609getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
33610is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
33611key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
33612displayed.
33613
33614If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
33615except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
33616out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
33617data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
33618by new data, for example:
33619.code
33620> 4 951102:1000
33621.endd
33622resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
33623sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
33624used as optional separators.
33625
33626
33627
33628
33629.section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
33630.cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
33631.cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
33632.cindex "locking mailboxes"
33633The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
33634Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
33635&'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
33636a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
33637the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
33638argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
33639second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
33640is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
33641is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
33642
33643.vlist
33644.vitem &%-fcntl%&
33645Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
33646
33647.vitem &%-flock%&
33648Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
33649supports it.
33650
33651.vitem &%-interval%&
33652This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
33653interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
33654
33655.vitem &%-lockfile%&
33656Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
33657
33658.vitem &%-mbx%&
33659Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
33660
33661.vitem &%-q%&
33662Suppress verification output.
33663
33664.vitem &%-retries%&
33665This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
33666the lock (default 10).
33667
33668.vitem &%-restore_time%&
33669This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
33670locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
33671example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
33672subsequently sees.
33673
33674.vitem &%-timeout%&
33675This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
33676timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
33677default), a non-blocking call is used.
33678
33679.vitem &%-v%&
33680Generate verbose output.
33681.endlist
33682
33683If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
33684default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
33685mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
33686&%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
33687requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
33688file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
33689more than 30 minutes old.
33690
33691The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
33692&%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
33693to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
33694&_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
33695number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
33696can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
33697
33698The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
33699&%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
33700suppresses all output except error messages.
33701
33702A command such as
33703.code
33704exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
33705.endd
33706runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
33707.display
33708&`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
33709<&'some commands'&>
33710&`End`&
33711.endd
33712runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
33713suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
33714such as
33715.code
33716exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
33717 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
33718.endd
33719Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
33720second argument &-- hence the quotes.
33721.ecindex IIDutils
33722
33723
33724. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33725. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33726
33727.chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
33728.scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
33729.cindex "X-windows"
33730.cindex "&'eximon'&"
33731.cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
33732.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
33733The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
33734about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
33735perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
33736such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
33737monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
33738
33739
33740
33741.section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
33742The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
33743script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
33744binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
33745be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
33746&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
33747parameters are for.
33748
33749The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
33750a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
33751preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
33752.code
33753EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
33754.endd
33755(in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
33756the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
33757overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
33758&'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
33759syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
33760
33761X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
33762way. For example, a resource setting of the form
33763.code
33764Eximon*background: gray94
33765.endd
33766changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
33767stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
33768black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
33769data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
33770&"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
33771For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
33772reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
33773.code
33774xrdb -merge <<End
33775Eximon*highlight: gray
33776End
33777.endd
33778.cindex "admin user"
33779In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
33780&'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
33781
33782The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
33783more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
33784main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
33785delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
33786different parts of the display.
33787
33788
33789
33790
33791.section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
33792.cindex "stripchart"
33793The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
33794be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
33795&_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
33796configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
33797it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
33798hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
33799received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
33800period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
33801parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
33802
33803The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
33804displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
33805title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
33806For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
33807
33808It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
33809a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
33810to a single partition.
33811
33812.cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
33813This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
33814the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
33815this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
33816100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
33817SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
33818&_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
33819
33820
33821
33822
33823.section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
33824.cindex "size" "of monitor window"
33825.cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
33826.cindex "window size"
33827Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
33828to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
33829shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
33830stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
33831the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
33832in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
33833
33834When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
33835currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
33836size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
33837remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
33838
33839The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
33840stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
33841the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
33842The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
33843&'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
33844the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33845
33846Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
33847built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
33848START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33849
33850
33851
33852.section "The log display" "SECID267"
33853.cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
33854The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
33855the main log is maintained.
33856To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
33857removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
33858The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
33859syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
33860to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
33861
33862The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
33863move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
33864scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
33865LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
33866to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
33867much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
33868a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
33869only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
33870available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
33871normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
33872configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33873
33874Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
33875and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
33876respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
33877It cannot go further back up the log.
33878
33879The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
33880normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
33881by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
33882by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
33883back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
33884the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
33885
33886Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
33887There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
33888the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
33889happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
33890&"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
33891^C is typed the search is cancelled.
33892
33893The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
33894widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
33895&"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
33896eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
33897However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
33898provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
33899come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
33900unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
33901on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
33902window.
33903
33904
33905
33906.section "The queue display" "SECID268"
33907.cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
33908The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
33909are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
33910as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
33911parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
33912at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
33913the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
33914there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
33915to force an update of the queue display at any time.
33916
33917When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
33918and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
33919with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
33920pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
33921type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
33922such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
33923of the texts, the message is not displayed.
33924
33925If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
33926are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
33927example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
33928&'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
33929has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
33930cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
33931a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
33932
33933While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
33934else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
33935queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
33936pressing the &"Hide"& button.
33937
33938The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
33939time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
33940message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
33941a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
33942recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
33943listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
33944an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
33945not shown.
33946
33947.cindex "frozen messages" "display"
33948If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
33949
33950The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
33951of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
33952The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
33953available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
33954display is updated.
33955
33956
33957
33958.section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
33959.cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
33960If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
33961pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
33962line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
33963any selected text.
33964
33965If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
33966MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
33967set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
33968value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
33969run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
33970.code
33971EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
33972.endd
33973The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
33974follows:
33975
33976.ilist
33977&'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
33978in a new text window.
33979.next
33980&'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
33981information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
33982&<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
33983.next
33984&'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
33985displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
33986amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
33987option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
33988.next
33989&'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
33990delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
33991frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
33992a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
33993up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
33994.next
33995&'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
33996that the message be frozen.
33997.next
33998.cindex "thawing messages"
33999.cindex "unfreezing messages"
34000.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
34001&'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
34002that the message be thawed.
34003.next
34004.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
34005&'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
34006that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
34007for any remaining undelivered addresses.
34008.next
34009&'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
34010that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
34011message.
34012.next
34013&'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
34014be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
34015is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
34016Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
34017causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
34018additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
34019which case no action is taken.
34020.next
34021&'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
34022can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
34023is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
34024Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
34025causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
34026recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
34027case no action is taken.
34028.next
34029&'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
34030mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
34031.next
34032&'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
34033sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
34034&%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
34035in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
34036bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
34037not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
34038the address is qualified with that domain.
34039.endlist
34040
34041When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
34042other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
34043particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
34044output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
34045from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
34046&_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
34047if no output is generated.
34048
34049The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
34050thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
34051&_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
34052force an update of the display after one of these actions.
34053
34054In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
34055cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
34056and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
34057.ecindex IIDeximon
34058
34059
34060
34061
34062
34063. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34064. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34065
34066.chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
34067.scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
34068This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
34069which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
34070
34071For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
34072Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
34073existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
34074chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
34075security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
34076its security as compared with other MTAs.
34077
34078What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
34079have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
34080absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
34081as soon as possible.
34082
34083
34084.section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
34085.cindex "security" "build-time features"
34086There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
34087to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
34088Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
34089penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
34090
34091.ilist
34092ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
34093start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
34094names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
34095value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
34096&_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
34097default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
34098
34099If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
34100which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
34101into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
34102configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
34103.next
34104
34105If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
34106or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
34107file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
34108the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
34109root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
34110right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
34111reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
34112it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
34113privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
34114separate commands.
34115
34116.next
34117The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
34118with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
34119CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
34120requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
34121the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
34122but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
34123previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
34124.next
34125If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
34126is disabled.
34127.next
34128FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
34129never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
34130option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
34131to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
34132is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
34133.endlist
34134
34135
34136
34137.section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
34138.cindex "setuid"
34139.cindex "root privilege"
34140The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
34141privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
34142example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
34143may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
34144discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
34145is required for two things:
34146
34147.ilist
34148To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
34149the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
34150not required.
34151.next
34152To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
34153perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
34154configuration.
34155.endlist
34156
34157It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
34158receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
34159obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
34160For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
34161&_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
34162group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
34163is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
34164&'mail'& or another user name altogether.
34165
34166Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
34167abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
34168&[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
34169
34170After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
34171uid and gid in the following cases:
34172
34173.ilist
34174.oindex "&%-C%&"
34175.oindex "&%-D%&"
34176If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
34177the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
34178calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
34179the calling process.
34180However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
34181option may not be used at all.
34182If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
34183can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
34184user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
34185.next
34186.oindex "&%-be%&"
34187.oindex "&%-bf%&"
34188.oindex "&%-bF%&"
34189If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
34190(&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
34191calling process.
34192.next
34193If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
34194process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
34195uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
34196runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
34197testing address verification
34198.oindex "&%-bv%&"
34199.oindex "&%-bh%&"
34200(the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
34201option).
34202.next
34203For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
34204remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
34205.endlist
34206
34207The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
34208
34209.ilist
34210A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
34211user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
34212function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
34213will be used during message reception.
34214.next
34215A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
34216job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
34217.next
34218A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
34219but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
34220subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
34221deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
34222remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
34223subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
34224while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
34225generating bounce and warning messages.
34226
34227While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
34228process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
34229this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
34230gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
34231.next
34232A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
34233the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
34234.endlist
34235
34236
34237
34238
34239.section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
34240.cindex "privilege, running without"
34241.cindex "unprivileged running"
34242.cindex "root privilege" "running without"
34243Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
34244operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
34245by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
34246gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
34247(and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
34248routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
34249to any other uid.
34250
34251.cindex SIGHUP
34252.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
34253Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
34254that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
34255correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
34256
34257An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
34258to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
34259process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
34260when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
34261SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
34262
34263It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
34264stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
34265been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
34266effect.
34267
34268If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
34269set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
34270to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
34271
34272In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
34273those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
34274Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
34275that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
34276discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
34277have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
34278number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
34279address this problem at this time.
34280
34281For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
34282is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
34283&%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
34284be used in the most straightforward way.
34285
34286If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
34287number of restrictions on what you can do:
34288
34289.ilist
34290You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
34291&%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
34292normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
34293work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
34294explicit specification of another user causes an error.
34295.next
34296Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
34297not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
34298.next
34299Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
34300the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
34301and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
34302enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
34303.next
34304Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
34305some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
34306
34307.olist
34308They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
34309implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
34310mode of the mailbox files themselves.
34311.next
34312You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
34313owned by the Exim user.
34314.next
34315You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
34316on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
34317mailboxes need to be created manually.
34318.endlist olist
34319.endlist ilist
34320
34321
34322These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
34323However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
34324gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
34325gives more security at essentially no cost.
34326
34327If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
34328&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
34329
34330
34331
34332
34333.section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
34334Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
34335are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
34336
34337
34338
34339.section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
34340.cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
34341.cindex "IP source routing"
34342Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
34343some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
34344IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
34345IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
34346
34347
34348
34349.section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
34350Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
34351be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
34352
34353
34354
34355
34356.section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
34357.cindex "trusted users"
34358.cindex "admin user"
34359.cindex "privileged user"
34360.cindex "user" "trusted"
34361.cindex "user" "admin"
34362Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
34363able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
34364addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
34365local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
34366permit a remote host to be specified.
34367
34368.oindex "&%-f%&"
34369However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
34370in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
34371message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
34372but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
34373permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
34374the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
34375
34376Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
34377other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
34378the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
34379as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
34380group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
34381
34382Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
34383can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
34384them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
34385the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
34386includes the contents of files on the spool.
34387
34388.oindex "&%-M%&"
34389.oindex "&%-q%&"
34390By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
34391delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
34392restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
34393Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
34394queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
34395setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
34396
34397Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
34398the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
34399the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
34400group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
34401the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
34402unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
34403files.
34404
34405
34406
34407.section "Spool files" "SECID275"
34408.cindex "spool directory" "files"
34409Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
34410set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
34411&_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
34412any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
34413
34414
34415
34416.section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
34417Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
34418of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
34419with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
34420to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
34421this.
34422
34423
34424
34425.section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
34426The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
34427are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
34428Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
34429converted output.
34430
34431
34432
34433.section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
34434Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
34435to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
34436does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
34437arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
34438
34439
34440
34441.section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
34442Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
34443defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
34444loading it.
34445
34446
34447.section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
34448.cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
34449A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
34450&'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
34451The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
34452that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
34453conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
34454
34455The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
34456the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
34457string.
34458
34459
34460
34461.section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
34462Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
34463formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
34464the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
34465
34466
34467
34468.section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
34469These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
34470enough to hold the result.
34471.ecindex IIDsecurcon
34472
34473
34474
34475
34476. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34477. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34478
34479.chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
34480.scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
34481.scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
34482.scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
34483.cindex "spool files" "editing"
34484A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
34485followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
34486the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
34487kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
34488two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
34489is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
34490themselves are recoverable.
34491
34492Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
34493need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
34494on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
34495
34496.ilist
34497You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
34498fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
34499which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
34500place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
34501lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
34502.next
34503.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
34504If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
34505&$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
34506present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
34507will always be the case.
34508.next
34509If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
34510.next
34511If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
34512signature.
34513.endlist
34514All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
34515
34516Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
34517its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
34518files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
34519the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
34520the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
34521is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
34522file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
34523-J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
34524attempt.
34525
34526.section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
34527.cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
34528.cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
34529The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
34530process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
34531gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
34532message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
34533normally the Exim user.
34534
34535The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
34536transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
34537empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
34538in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
34539created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
34540&%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
34541leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
34542&"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
34543
34544The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
34545was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
34546start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
34547warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
34548
34549There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
34550order, and are omitted when not relevant:
34551
34552.vlist
34553.vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34554This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
34555&%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
34556recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
34557this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
34558identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
34559the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
34560the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
34561the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
34562newlines.
34563
34564.vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34565A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
34566defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
34567The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
34568starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
34569character. It may contain internal newlines.
34570
34571.vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34572A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
34573Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
34574length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
34575starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
34576character. It may contain internal newlines.
34577
34578.vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
34579This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
34580&$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
34581
34582.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
34583This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
34584lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
34585transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
34586messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
34587
34588.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
34589This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
34590(to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
34591time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
34592hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
34593
34594.vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
34595The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
34596&-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
34597
34598.vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
34599The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
34600&$authenticated_sender$& variable.
34601
34602.vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
34603This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
34604present.
34605
34606.vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
34607This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
34608present if the number is greater than zero.
34609
34610.vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
34611This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
34612file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
34613
34614.vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
34615.cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
34616The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
34617
34618.vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
34619This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
34620command.
34621
34622.vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
34623This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
34624the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
34625messages.
34626
34627.vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
34628If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
34629the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
34630&$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
34631
34632.vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
34633This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
34634address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
34635
34636.vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
34637.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
34638.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
34639This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
34640if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
34641received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
34642
34643.vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
34644For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
34645unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
34646ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
34647supplied by the remote host, if any.
34648
34649.vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
34650This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
34651which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
34652generated messages.
34653
34654.vitem &%-local%&
34655The message is from a local sender.
34656
34657.vitem &%-localerror%&
34658The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
34659
34660.vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
34661This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
34662when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
34663variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
34664
34665.vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
34666The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
34667Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
34668
34669.vitem &%-N%&
34670A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
34671actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
34672&%-N%& is assumed.
34673
34674.vitem &%-received_protocol%&
34675This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
34676the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
34677
34678.vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
34679The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
34680to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
34681
34682.vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
34683If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
34684of &$spam_score_int$&.
34685
34686.vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
34687A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
34688certificate was verified by the server.
34689
34690.vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
34691When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
34692name of the cipher suite that was used.
34693
34694.vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
34695When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
34696was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
34697certificate.
34698.endlist
34699
34700Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
34701is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
34702line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
34703is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
34704the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
34705balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
34706to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
34707original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
34708addresses are complete.
34709
34710If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
34711the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
34712Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
34713tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
34714right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
34715follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
34716.code
34717YY darcy@austen.fict.example
34718NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
34719NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34720.endd
34721After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
34722This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
34723recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
34724delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
34725example:
34726.code
347274
34728editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34729darcy@austen.fict.example
34730rdo@foundation
34731alice@wonderland.fict.example
34732.endd
34733However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
34734result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
34735line is of the following form:
34736.display
34737<&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
34738 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
34739.endd
34740The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
34741the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
34742fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
34743original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
34744envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
34745length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
34746characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
34747that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
34748
34749
34750A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
34751which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
34752when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
34753character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
34754embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
34755following:
34756
34757.table2 50pt
34758.row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
34759.row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
34760.row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
34761.row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
34762.row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
34763.row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
34764.row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
34765.row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
34766.row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
34767.row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
34768.endtable
34769
34770Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
34771purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
34772typical set of headers:
34773.code
34774111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
34775id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
34776049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
34777038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
34778042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
34779049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
34780099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
34781darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34782104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
34783darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34784038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
34785.endd
34786The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
34787&'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
34788unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
34789.ecindex IIDforspo1
34790.ecindex IIDforspo2
34791.ecindex IIDforspo3
34792
34793. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34794. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34795
34796.chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail) - RFC4871" "CHID12" &&&
34797 "DKIM Support"
34798.cindex "DKIM"
34799
34800Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
34801disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
34802
34803Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
34804.olist
34805Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
34806It can co-exist with all other Exim features, including transport filters.
34807.next
34808Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
34809ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
34810different signature contexts.
34811.endlist
34812
34813In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
34814default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
34815Exim's standard controls.
34816
34817Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
34818on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
34819exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
34820signature status. Here is an example:
34821.code
348222009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM: d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
34823.endd
34824You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
34825or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
34826control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
34827where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
34828senders).
34829
34830
34831.section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
34832.cindex "DKIM" "signing"
34833
34834Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
34835These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
34836
34837.option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
34838MANDATORY:
34839The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
34840option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
34841
34842.option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
34843MANDATORY:
34844This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
34845variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
34846variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
34847option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
34848
34849.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
34850MANDATORY:
34851This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
34852&%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
34853The result can either
34854.ilist
34855be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
34856.next
34857start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
34858the private key.
34859.next
34860be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
34861be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
34862is set.
34863.endlist
34864
34865.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
34866OPTIONAL:
34867This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
34868The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
34869The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
34870only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
34871
34872.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
34873OPTIONAL:
34874This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
34875should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
34876either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
34877unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
34878variables here.
34879
34880.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
34881OPTIONAL:
34882When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
34883list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
34884signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
34885used.
34886
34887
34888.section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
34889.cindex "DKIM" "verification"
34890
34891Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
34892&%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
34893syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
34894
34895To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
34896containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
34897runtime of the ACL.
34898
34899Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
34900more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
34901&%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
34902&%$dkim_signers%& exist.
34903
34904The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
34905list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
34906called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
34907the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
34908list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
34909&%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
34910it defaults as:
34911.code
34912dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
34913.endd
34914This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
34915DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
34916call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
34917.code
34918dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
34919.endd
34920This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
34921and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
34922You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
34923.code
34924dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
34925.endd
34926
34927If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
34928&%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
34929
34930
34931Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
34932available (from most to least important):
34933
34934
34935.vlist
34936.vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
34937The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
34938an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
34939&%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
34940.vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
34941A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
34942.ilist
34943&%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
34944identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
34945.next
34946&%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
34947More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
34948.next
34949&%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
34950available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
34951.next
34952&%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
34953.endlist
34954.vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
34955A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
34956"fail" or "invalid". One of
34957.ilist
34958&%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
34959key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
34960.next
34961&%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
34962record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
34963.next
34964&%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
34965body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
34966means that the message body was modified in transit.
34967.next
34968&%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
34969could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
34970re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
34971DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
34972.endlist
34973.vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
34974The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
34975an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
34976reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
34977.vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
34978The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
34979if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
34980identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
34981.vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
34982The key record selector string.
34983.vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
34984The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
34985.vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
34986The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
34987.vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
34988The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
34989.vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
34990A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
34991(copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
34992.vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
34993The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
34994limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
34995that this variable always expands to an integer value.
34996.vitem &%$dkim_created%&
34997UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
34998When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
34999.vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
35000UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
35001signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
35002signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
35003integer size comparisons against this value.
35004.vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
35005A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
35006.vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
35007"1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
35008.vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomaining%&
35009"1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
35010.vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
35011Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
35012in the key record.
35013.vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
35014Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
35015in the key record.
35016.vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
35017Notes from the key record (tag n=).
35018.endlist
35019
35020In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
35021
35022.vlist
35023.vitem &%dkim_signers%&
35024ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
35025for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
35026(reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
35027verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
35028
35029.code
35030# Warn when message apparently from GMail has no signature at all
35031warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
35032 sender_domains = gmail.com
35033 dkim_signers = gmail.com
35034 dkim_status = none
35035.endd
35036
35037.vitem &%dkim_status%&
35038ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
35039results agains the actual result of verification. This is typically used
35040to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, like:
35041
35042.code
35043deny message = Message from Paypal with invalid or missing signature
35044 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
35045 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
35046 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
35047.endd
35048
35049The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
35050see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
35051for more information of what they mean.
35052.endlist
35053
35054. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35055. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35056
35057.chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
35058 "Adding drivers or lookups"
35059.cindex "adding drivers"
35060.cindex "new drivers, adding"
35061.cindex "drivers" "adding new"
35062The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
35063authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
35064
35065.olist
35066Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
35067existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
35068.next
35069Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
35070.display
35071<&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
35072.endd
35073where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
35074code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
35075should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
35076.next
35077Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
35078.code
35079#define <type>_NEWDRIVER
35080.endd
35081.next
35082Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
35083and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
35084.next
35085Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
35086&_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
35087driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
35088.next
35089Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
35090&_src_&.
35091.next
35092Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
35093as for other drivers and lookups.
35094.endlist
35095
35096Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
35097proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
35098occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
35099options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
35100searched using a binary chop procedure.
35101
35102There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
35103the interface that is expected.
35104
35105
35106
35107
35108. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35109. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35110
35111. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35112. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
35113. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
35114. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
35115. processors.
35116. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35117
35118.literal xml
35119<?sdop
35120 format="newpage"
35121 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
35122 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
35123?>
35124.literal off
35125
35126.makeindex "Options index" "option"
35127.makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
35128.makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
35129
35130
35131. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35132. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////